blob: d4b05389f4931656cd6c5ee0f9df4e74a66581fd [file] [log] [blame]
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001//===--- SemaExpr.cpp - Semantic Analysis for Expressions -----------------===//
2//
3// The LLVM Compiler Infrastructure
4//
Chris Lattner0bc735f2007-12-29 19:59:25 +00005// This file is distributed under the University of Illinois Open Source
6// License. See LICENSE.TXT for details.
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00007//
8//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
9//
10// This file implements semantic analysis for expressions.
11//
12//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
13
14#include "Sema.h"
Douglas Gregor99a2e602009-12-16 01:38:02 +000015#include "SemaInit.h"
John McCall7d384dd2009-11-18 07:57:50 +000016#include "Lookup.h"
Ted Kremenekdbdbaaf2010-03-20 21:06:02 +000017#include "AnalysisBasedWarnings.h"
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +000018#include "clang/AST/ASTContext.h"
Douglas Gregorcc8a5d52010-04-29 00:18:15 +000019#include "clang/AST/CXXInheritance.h"
Daniel Dunbarc4a1dea2008-08-11 05:35:13 +000020#include "clang/AST/DeclObjC.h"
Anders Carlssond497ba72009-08-26 22:59:12 +000021#include "clang/AST/DeclTemplate.h"
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +000022#include "clang/AST/Expr.h"
Chris Lattner04421082008-04-08 04:40:51 +000023#include "clang/AST/ExprCXX.h"
Steve Narofff494b572008-05-29 21:12:08 +000024#include "clang/AST/ExprObjC.h"
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +000025#include "clang/AST/RecursiveASTVisitor.h"
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +000026#include "clang/AST/TypeLoc.h"
Anders Carlssond497ba72009-08-26 22:59:12 +000027#include "clang/Basic/PartialDiagnostic.h"
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +000028#include "clang/Basic/SourceManager.h"
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +000029#include "clang/Basic/TargetInfo.h"
Anders Carlssond497ba72009-08-26 22:59:12 +000030#include "clang/Lex/LiteralSupport.h"
31#include "clang/Lex/Preprocessor.h"
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +000032#include "clang/Parse/DeclSpec.h"
Chris Lattner418f6c72008-10-26 23:43:26 +000033#include "clang/Parse/Designator.h"
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +000034#include "clang/Parse/Scope.h"
Douglas Gregor314b97f2009-11-10 19:49:08 +000035#include "clang/Parse/Template.h"
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +000036using namespace clang;
37
David Chisnall0f436562009-08-17 16:35:33 +000038
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +000039/// \brief Determine whether the use of this declaration is valid, and
40/// emit any corresponding diagnostics.
41///
42/// This routine diagnoses various problems with referencing
43/// declarations that can occur when using a declaration. For example,
44/// it might warn if a deprecated or unavailable declaration is being
45/// used, or produce an error (and return true) if a C++0x deleted
46/// function is being used.
47///
Chris Lattner52338262009-10-25 22:31:57 +000048/// If IgnoreDeprecated is set to true, this should not want about deprecated
49/// decls.
50///
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +000051/// \returns true if there was an error (this declaration cannot be
52/// referenced), false otherwise.
Chris Lattner52338262009-10-25 22:31:57 +000053///
John McCall54abf7d2009-11-04 02:18:39 +000054bool Sema::DiagnoseUseOfDecl(NamedDecl *D, SourceLocation Loc) {
Chris Lattner76a642f2009-02-15 22:43:40 +000055 // See if the decl is deprecated.
Argyrios Kyrtzidis40b598e2009-06-30 02:34:44 +000056 if (D->getAttr<DeprecatedAttr>()) {
John McCall54abf7d2009-11-04 02:18:39 +000057 EmitDeprecationWarning(D, Loc);
Chris Lattner76a642f2009-02-15 22:43:40 +000058 }
59
Chris Lattnerffb93682009-10-25 17:21:40 +000060 // See if the decl is unavailable
61 if (D->getAttr<UnavailableAttr>()) {
Ted Kremenek042411c2010-07-21 20:43:11 +000062 Diag(Loc, diag::err_unavailable) << D->getDeclName();
Chris Lattnerffb93682009-10-25 17:21:40 +000063 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_unavailable_here) << 0;
64 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +000065
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +000066 // See if this is a deleted function.
Douglas Gregor25d944a2009-02-24 04:26:15 +000067 if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +000068 if (FD->isDeleted()) {
69 Diag(Loc, diag::err_deleted_function_use);
70 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_unavailable_here) << true;
71 return true;
72 }
Douglas Gregor25d944a2009-02-24 04:26:15 +000073 }
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +000074
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +000075 return false;
Chris Lattner76a642f2009-02-15 22:43:40 +000076}
77
Fariborz Jahanian5b530052009-05-13 18:09:35 +000078/// DiagnoseSentinelCalls - This routine checks on method dispatch calls
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +000079/// (and other functions in future), which have been declared with sentinel
Fariborz Jahanian5b530052009-05-13 18:09:35 +000080/// attribute. It warns if call does not have the sentinel argument.
81///
82void Sema::DiagnoseSentinelCalls(NamedDecl *D, SourceLocation Loc,
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +000083 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidis40b598e2009-06-30 02:34:44 +000084 const SentinelAttr *attr = D->getAttr<SentinelAttr>();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +000085 if (!attr)
Fariborz Jahanian88f1ba02009-05-13 23:20:50 +000086 return;
Douglas Gregor92e986e2010-04-22 16:44:27 +000087
88 // FIXME: In C++0x, if any of the arguments are parameter pack
89 // expansions, we can't check for the sentinel now.
Fariborz Jahanian88f1ba02009-05-13 23:20:50 +000090 int sentinelPos = attr->getSentinel();
91 int nullPos = attr->getNullPos();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +000092
Mike Stump390b4cc2009-05-16 07:39:55 +000093 // FIXME. ObjCMethodDecl and FunctionDecl need be derived from the same common
94 // base class. Then we won't be needing two versions of the same code.
Fariborz Jahanian88f1ba02009-05-13 23:20:50 +000095 unsigned int i = 0;
Fariborz Jahanian236673e2009-05-14 18:00:00 +000096 bool warnNotEnoughArgs = false;
97 int isMethod = 0;
98 if (ObjCMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<ObjCMethodDecl>(D)) {
99 // skip over named parameters.
100 ObjCMethodDecl::param_iterator P, E = MD->param_end();
101 for (P = MD->param_begin(); (P != E && i < NumArgs); ++P) {
102 if (nullPos)
103 --nullPos;
104 else
105 ++i;
106 }
107 warnNotEnoughArgs = (P != E || i >= NumArgs);
108 isMethod = 1;
Mike Stumpac5fc7c2009-08-04 21:02:39 +0000109 } else if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
Fariborz Jahanian236673e2009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000110 // skip over named parameters.
111 ObjCMethodDecl::param_iterator P, E = FD->param_end();
112 for (P = FD->param_begin(); (P != E && i < NumArgs); ++P) {
113 if (nullPos)
114 --nullPos;
115 else
116 ++i;
117 }
118 warnNotEnoughArgs = (P != E || i >= NumArgs);
Mike Stumpac5fc7c2009-08-04 21:02:39 +0000119 } else if (VarDecl *V = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
Fariborz Jahaniandaf04152009-05-15 20:33:25 +0000120 // block or function pointer call.
121 QualType Ty = V->getType();
122 if (Ty->isBlockPointerType() || Ty->isFunctionPointerType()) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000123 const FunctionType *FT = Ty->isFunctionPointerType()
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +0000124 ? Ty->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionType>()
125 : Ty->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionType>();
Fariborz Jahaniandaf04152009-05-15 20:33:25 +0000126 if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(FT)) {
127 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
128 unsigned k;
129 for (k = 0; (k != NumArgsInProto && i < NumArgs); k++) {
130 if (nullPos)
131 --nullPos;
132 else
133 ++i;
134 }
135 warnNotEnoughArgs = (k != NumArgsInProto || i >= NumArgs);
136 }
137 if (Ty->isBlockPointerType())
138 isMethod = 2;
Mike Stumpac5fc7c2009-08-04 21:02:39 +0000139 } else
Fariborz Jahaniandaf04152009-05-15 20:33:25 +0000140 return;
Mike Stumpac5fc7c2009-08-04 21:02:39 +0000141 } else
Fariborz Jahanian236673e2009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000142 return;
143
144 if (warnNotEnoughArgs) {
Fariborz Jahanian88f1ba02009-05-13 23:20:50 +0000145 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_not_enough_argument) << D->getDeclName();
Fariborz Jahanian236673e2009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000146 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_sentinel_here) << isMethod;
Fariborz Jahanian88f1ba02009-05-13 23:20:50 +0000147 return;
148 }
149 int sentinel = i;
150 while (sentinelPos > 0 && i < NumArgs-1) {
151 --sentinelPos;
152 ++i;
153 }
154 if (sentinelPos > 0) {
155 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_not_enough_argument) << D->getDeclName();
Fariborz Jahanian236673e2009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000156 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_sentinel_here) << isMethod;
Fariborz Jahanian88f1ba02009-05-13 23:20:50 +0000157 return;
158 }
159 while (i < NumArgs-1) {
160 ++i;
161 ++sentinel;
162 }
163 Expr *sentinelExpr = Args[sentinel];
John McCall8eb662e2010-05-06 23:53:00 +0000164 if (!sentinelExpr) return;
165 if (sentinelExpr->isTypeDependent()) return;
166 if (sentinelExpr->isValueDependent()) return;
Fariborz Jahanian9ccd7252010-07-14 16:37:51 +0000167 if (sentinelExpr->getType()->isAnyPointerType() &&
John McCall8eb662e2010-05-06 23:53:00 +0000168 sentinelExpr->IgnoreParenCasts()->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
169 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull))
170 return;
171
172 // Unfortunately, __null has type 'int'.
173 if (isa<GNUNullExpr>(sentinelExpr)) return;
174
175 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_missing_sentinel) << isMethod;
176 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_sentinel_here) << isMethod;
Fariborz Jahanian5b530052009-05-13 18:09:35 +0000177}
178
Douglas Gregor4b2d3f72009-02-26 21:00:50 +0000179SourceRange Sema::getExprRange(ExprTy *E) const {
180 Expr *Ex = (Expr *)E;
181 return Ex? Ex->getSourceRange() : SourceRange();
182}
183
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000184//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
185// Standard Promotions and Conversions
186//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
187
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000188/// DefaultFunctionArrayConversion (C99 6.3.2.1p3, C99 6.3.2.1p4).
189void Sema::DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(Expr *&E) {
190 QualType Ty = E->getType();
191 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "DefaultFunctionArrayConversion - missing type");
192
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000193 if (Ty->isFunctionType())
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000194 ImpCastExprToType(E, Context.getPointerType(Ty),
Anders Carlssonb633c4e2009-09-01 20:37:18 +0000195 CastExpr::CK_FunctionToPointerDecay);
Chris Lattner67d33d82008-07-25 21:33:13 +0000196 else if (Ty->isArrayType()) {
197 // In C90 mode, arrays only promote to pointers if the array expression is
198 // an lvalue. The relevant legalese is C90 6.2.2.1p3: "an lvalue that has
199 // type 'array of type' is converted to an expression that has type 'pointer
200 // to type'...". In C99 this was changed to: C99 6.3.2.1p3: "an expression
201 // that has type 'array of type' ...". The relevant change is "an lvalue"
202 // (C90) to "an expression" (C99).
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc39a3d72008-09-11 04:25:59 +0000203 //
204 // C++ 4.2p1:
205 // An lvalue or rvalue of type "array of N T" or "array of unknown bound of
206 // T" can be converted to an rvalue of type "pointer to T".
207 //
208 if (getLangOptions().C99 || getLangOptions().CPlusPlus ||
209 E->isLvalue(Context) == Expr::LV_Valid)
Anders Carlsson112a0a82009-08-07 23:48:20 +0000210 ImpCastExprToType(E, Context.getArrayDecayedType(Ty),
211 CastExpr::CK_ArrayToPointerDecay);
Chris Lattner67d33d82008-07-25 21:33:13 +0000212 }
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000213}
214
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000215void Sema::DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Expr *&E) {
216 DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(E);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000217
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000218 QualType Ty = E->getType();
219 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion - missing type");
220 if (!Ty->isDependentType() && Ty.hasQualifiers() &&
221 (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus || !Ty->isRecordType()) &&
222 E->isLvalue(Context) == Expr::LV_Valid) {
223 // C++ [conv.lval]p1:
224 // [...] If T is a non-class type, the type of the rvalue is the
225 // cv-unqualified version of T. Otherwise, the type of the
226 // rvalue is T
227 //
228 // C99 6.3.2.1p2:
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000229 // If the lvalue has qualified type, the value has the unqualified
230 // version of the type of the lvalue; otherwise, the value has the
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000231 // type of the lvalue.
232 ImpCastExprToType(E, Ty.getUnqualifiedType(), CastExpr::CK_NoOp);
233 }
234}
235
236
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000237/// UsualUnaryConversions - Performs various conversions that are common to most
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000238/// operators (C99 6.3). The conversions of array and function types are
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000239/// sometimes surpressed. For example, the array->pointer conversion doesn't
240/// apply if the array is an argument to the sizeof or address (&) operators.
241/// In these instances, this routine should *not* be called.
242Expr *Sema::UsualUnaryConversions(Expr *&Expr) {
243 QualType Ty = Expr->getType();
244 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "UsualUnaryConversions - missing type");
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000245
Douglas Gregorfc24e442009-05-01 20:41:21 +0000246 // C99 6.3.1.1p2:
247 //
248 // The following may be used in an expression wherever an int or
249 // unsigned int may be used:
250 // - an object or expression with an integer type whose integer
251 // conversion rank is less than or equal to the rank of int
252 // and unsigned int.
253 // - A bit-field of type _Bool, int, signed int, or unsigned int.
254 //
255 // If an int can represent all values of the original type, the
256 // value is converted to an int; otherwise, it is converted to an
257 // unsigned int. These are called the integer promotions. All
258 // other types are unchanged by the integer promotions.
Eli Friedman04e83572009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000259 QualType PTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(Expr);
260 if (!PTy.isNull()) {
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +0000261 ImpCastExprToType(Expr, PTy, CastExpr::CK_IntegralCast);
Eli Friedman04e83572009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000262 return Expr;
263 }
Douglas Gregorfc24e442009-05-01 20:41:21 +0000264 if (Ty->isPromotableIntegerType()) {
Eli Friedmana95d7572009-08-19 07:44:53 +0000265 QualType PT = Context.getPromotedIntegerType(Ty);
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +0000266 ImpCastExprToType(Expr, PT, CastExpr::CK_IntegralCast);
Douglas Gregorfc24e442009-05-01 20:41:21 +0000267 return Expr;
Eli Friedman04e83572009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000268 }
269
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000270 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Expr);
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000271 return Expr;
272}
273
Chris Lattner05faf172008-07-25 22:25:12 +0000274/// DefaultArgumentPromotion (C99 6.5.2.2p6). Used for function calls that
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000275/// do not have a prototype. Arguments that have type float are promoted to
Chris Lattner05faf172008-07-25 22:25:12 +0000276/// double. All other argument types are converted by UsualUnaryConversions().
277void Sema::DefaultArgumentPromotion(Expr *&Expr) {
278 QualType Ty = Expr->getType();
279 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "DefaultArgumentPromotion - missing type");
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000280
Chris Lattner05faf172008-07-25 22:25:12 +0000281 // If this is a 'float' (CVR qualified or typedef) promote to double.
Chris Lattner40378332010-05-16 04:01:30 +0000282 if (Ty->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Float))
283 return ImpCastExprToType(Expr, Context.DoubleTy,
284 CastExpr::CK_FloatingCast);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000285
Chris Lattner05faf172008-07-25 22:25:12 +0000286 UsualUnaryConversions(Expr);
287}
288
Chris Lattner312531a2009-04-12 08:11:20 +0000289/// DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion - Like DefaultArgumentPromotion, but
290/// will warn if the resulting type is not a POD type, and rejects ObjC
291/// interfaces passed by value. This returns true if the argument type is
292/// completely illegal.
Chris Lattner40378332010-05-16 04:01:30 +0000293bool Sema::DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion(Expr *&Expr, VariadicCallType CT,
294 FunctionDecl *FDecl) {
Anders Carlssondce5e2c2009-01-16 16:48:51 +0000295 DefaultArgumentPromotion(Expr);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000296
Chris Lattner40378332010-05-16 04:01:30 +0000297 // __builtin_va_start takes the second argument as a "varargs" argument, but
298 // it doesn't actually do anything with it. It doesn't need to be non-pod
299 // etc.
300 if (FDecl && FDecl->getBuiltinID() == Builtin::BI__builtin_va_start)
301 return false;
302
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +0000303 if (Expr->getType()->isObjCObjectType() &&
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +0000304 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Expr->getLocStart(),
305 PDiag(diag::err_cannot_pass_objc_interface_to_vararg)
306 << Expr->getType() << CT))
307 return true;
Douglas Gregor75b699a2009-12-12 07:25:49 +0000308
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +0000309 if (!Expr->getType()->isPODType() &&
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000310 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Expr->getLocStart(),
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +0000311 PDiag(diag::warn_cannot_pass_non_pod_arg_to_vararg)
312 << Expr->getType() << CT))
313 return true;
Chris Lattner312531a2009-04-12 08:11:20 +0000314
315 return false;
Anders Carlssondce5e2c2009-01-16 16:48:51 +0000316}
317
318
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000319/// UsualArithmeticConversions - Performs various conversions that are common to
320/// binary operators (C99 6.3.1.8). If both operands aren't arithmetic, this
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000321/// routine returns the first non-arithmetic type found. The client is
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000322/// responsible for emitting appropriate error diagnostics.
323/// FIXME: verify the conversion rules for "complex int" are consistent with
324/// GCC.
325QualType Sema::UsualArithmeticConversions(Expr *&lhsExpr, Expr *&rhsExpr,
326 bool isCompAssign) {
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +0000327 if (!isCompAssign)
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000328 UsualUnaryConversions(lhsExpr);
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +0000329
330 UsualUnaryConversions(rhsExpr);
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +0000331
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000332 // For conversion purposes, we ignore any qualifiers.
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000333 // For example, "const float" and "float" are equivalent.
Chris Lattnerb77792e2008-07-26 22:17:49 +0000334 QualType lhs =
335 Context.getCanonicalType(lhsExpr->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000336 QualType rhs =
Chris Lattnerb77792e2008-07-26 22:17:49 +0000337 Context.getCanonicalType(rhsExpr->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +0000338
339 // If both types are identical, no conversion is needed.
340 if (lhs == rhs)
341 return lhs;
342
343 // If either side is a non-arithmetic type (e.g. a pointer), we are done.
344 // The caller can deal with this (e.g. pointer + int).
345 if (!lhs->isArithmeticType() || !rhs->isArithmeticType())
346 return lhs;
347
Douglas Gregor2d833e32009-05-02 00:36:19 +0000348 // Perform bitfield promotions.
Eli Friedman04e83572009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000349 QualType LHSBitfieldPromoteTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(lhsExpr);
Douglas Gregor2d833e32009-05-02 00:36:19 +0000350 if (!LHSBitfieldPromoteTy.isNull())
351 lhs = LHSBitfieldPromoteTy;
Eli Friedman04e83572009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000352 QualType RHSBitfieldPromoteTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(rhsExpr);
Douglas Gregor2d833e32009-05-02 00:36:19 +0000353 if (!RHSBitfieldPromoteTy.isNull())
354 rhs = RHSBitfieldPromoteTy;
355
Eli Friedmana95d7572009-08-19 07:44:53 +0000356 QualType destType = Context.UsualArithmeticConversionsType(lhs, rhs);
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +0000357 if (!isCompAssign)
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +0000358 ImpCastExprToType(lhsExpr, destType, CastExpr::CK_Unknown);
359 ImpCastExprToType(rhsExpr, destType, CastExpr::CK_Unknown);
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +0000360 return destType;
361}
362
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000363//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
364// Semantic Analysis for various Expression Types
365//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
366
367
Steve Narofff69936d2007-09-16 03:34:24 +0000368/// ActOnStringLiteral - The specified tokens were lexed as pasted string
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +0000369/// fragments (e.g. "foo" "bar" L"baz"). The result string has to handle string
370/// concatenation ([C99 5.1.1.2, translation phase #6]), so it may come from
371/// multiple tokens. However, the common case is that StringToks points to one
372/// string.
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000373///
374Action::OwningExprResult
Steve Narofff69936d2007-09-16 03:34:24 +0000375Sema::ActOnStringLiteral(const Token *StringToks, unsigned NumStringToks) {
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +0000376 assert(NumStringToks && "Must have at least one string!");
377
Chris Lattnerbbee00b2009-01-16 18:51:42 +0000378 StringLiteralParser Literal(StringToks, NumStringToks, PP);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +0000379 if (Literal.hadError)
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000380 return ExprError();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +0000381
382 llvm::SmallVector<SourceLocation, 4> StringTokLocs;
383 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumStringToks; ++i)
384 StringTokLocs.push_back(StringToks[i].getLocation());
Chris Lattnera7ad98f2008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000385
Chris Lattnera7ad98f2008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000386 QualType StrTy = Context.CharTy;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis55f4b022008-08-09 17:20:01 +0000387 if (Literal.AnyWide) StrTy = Context.getWCharType();
Chris Lattnera7ad98f2008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000388 if (Literal.Pascal) StrTy = Context.UnsignedCharTy;
Douglas Gregor77a52232008-09-12 00:47:35 +0000389
390 // A C++ string literal has a const-qualified element type (C++ 2.13.4p1).
Chris Lattner7dc480f2010-06-15 18:05:34 +0000391 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus || getLangOptions().ConstStrings)
Douglas Gregor77a52232008-09-12 00:47:35 +0000392 StrTy.addConst();
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000393
Chris Lattnera7ad98f2008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000394 // Get an array type for the string, according to C99 6.4.5. This includes
395 // the nul terminator character as well as the string length for pascal
396 // strings.
397 StrTy = Context.getConstantArrayType(StrTy,
Chris Lattnerdbb1ecc2009-02-26 23:01:51 +0000398 llvm::APInt(32, Literal.GetNumStringChars()+1),
Chris Lattnera7ad98f2008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000399 ArrayType::Normal, 0);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000400
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +0000401 // Pass &StringTokLocs[0], StringTokLocs.size() to factory!
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000402 return Owned(StringLiteral::Create(Context, Literal.GetString(),
Chris Lattner2085fd62009-02-18 06:40:38 +0000403 Literal.GetStringLength(),
404 Literal.AnyWide, StrTy,
405 &StringTokLocs[0],
406 StringTokLocs.size()));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +0000407}
408
Chris Lattner639e2d32008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000409/// ShouldSnapshotBlockValueReference - Return true if a reference inside of
410/// CurBlock to VD should cause it to be snapshotted (as we do for auto
411/// variables defined outside the block) or false if this is not needed (e.g.
412/// for values inside the block or for globals).
413///
Douglas Gregor076ceb02010-03-01 20:44:28 +0000414/// This also keeps the 'hasBlockDeclRefExprs' in the BlockScopeInfo records
Chris Lattner17f3a6d2009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000415/// up-to-date.
416///
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +0000417static bool ShouldSnapshotBlockValueReference(Sema &S, BlockScopeInfo *CurBlock,
Chris Lattner639e2d32008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000418 ValueDecl *VD) {
419 // If the value is defined inside the block, we couldn't snapshot it even if
420 // we wanted to.
421 if (CurBlock->TheDecl == VD->getDeclContext())
422 return false;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000423
Chris Lattner639e2d32008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000424 // If this is an enum constant or function, it is constant, don't snapshot.
425 if (isa<EnumConstantDecl>(VD) || isa<FunctionDecl>(VD))
426 return false;
427
428 // If this is a reference to an extern, static, or global variable, no need to
429 // snapshot it.
430 // FIXME: What about 'const' variables in C++?
431 if (const VarDecl *Var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(VD))
Chris Lattner17f3a6d2009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000432 if (!Var->hasLocalStorage())
433 return false;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000434
Chris Lattner17f3a6d2009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000435 // Blocks that have these can't be constant.
436 CurBlock->hasBlockDeclRefExprs = true;
437
438 // If we have nested blocks, the decl may be declared in an outer block (in
439 // which case that outer block doesn't get "hasBlockDeclRefExprs") or it may
440 // be defined outside all of the current blocks (in which case the blocks do
441 // all get the bit). Walk the nesting chain.
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +0000442 for (unsigned I = S.FunctionScopes.size() - 1; I; --I) {
443 BlockScopeInfo *NextBlock = dyn_cast<BlockScopeInfo>(S.FunctionScopes[I]);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000444
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +0000445 if (!NextBlock)
446 continue;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000447
Chris Lattner17f3a6d2009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000448 // If we found the defining block for the variable, don't mark the block as
449 // having a reference outside it.
450 if (NextBlock->TheDecl == VD->getDeclContext())
451 break;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000452
Chris Lattner17f3a6d2009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000453 // Otherwise, the DeclRef from the inner block causes the outer one to need
454 // a snapshot as well.
455 NextBlock->hasBlockDeclRefExprs = true;
456 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000457
Chris Lattner639e2d32008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000458 return true;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000459}
460
Chris Lattner639e2d32008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000461
462
Douglas Gregora2813ce2009-10-23 18:54:35 +0000463/// BuildDeclRefExpr - Build a DeclRefExpr.
Anders Carlssone41590d2009-06-24 00:10:43 +0000464Sema::OwningExprResult
John McCalldbd872f2009-12-08 09:08:17 +0000465Sema::BuildDeclRefExpr(ValueDecl *D, QualType Ty, SourceLocation Loc,
Sebastian Redlebc07d52009-02-03 20:19:35 +0000466 const CXXScopeSpec *SS) {
Anders Carlssone2bb2242009-06-26 19:16:07 +0000467 if (Context.getCanonicalType(Ty) == Context.UndeducedAutoTy) {
468 Diag(Loc,
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000469 diag::err_auto_variable_cannot_appear_in_own_initializer)
Anders Carlssone2bb2242009-06-26 19:16:07 +0000470 << D->getDeclName();
471 return ExprError();
472 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000473
Anders Carlssone41590d2009-06-24 00:10:43 +0000474 if (const VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
Douglas Gregor15dedf02010-04-27 21:10:04 +0000475 if (isa<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(VD)) {
476 // Non-type template parameters can be referenced anywhere they are
477 // visible.
Douglas Gregor63982352010-07-13 18:40:04 +0000478 Ty = Ty.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
Douglas Gregor15dedf02010-04-27 21:10:04 +0000479 } else if (const CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(CurContext)) {
Anders Carlssone41590d2009-06-24 00:10:43 +0000480 if (const FunctionDecl *FD = MD->getParent()->isLocalClass()) {
481 if (VD->hasLocalStorage() && VD->getDeclContext() != CurContext) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000482 Diag(Loc, diag::err_reference_to_local_var_in_enclosing_function)
Anders Carlssone41590d2009-06-24 00:10:43 +0000483 << D->getIdentifier() << FD->getDeclName();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000484 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_local_variable_declared_here)
Anders Carlssone41590d2009-06-24 00:10:43 +0000485 << D->getIdentifier();
486 return ExprError();
487 }
488 }
489 }
490 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000491
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +0000492 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, D);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000493
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000494 return Owned(DeclRefExpr::Create(Context,
495 SS? (NestedNameSpecifier *)SS->getScopeRep() : 0,
496 SS? SS->getRange() : SourceRange(),
Douglas Gregor0da76df2009-11-23 11:41:28 +0000497 D, Loc, Ty));
Douglas Gregor1a49af92009-01-06 05:10:23 +0000498}
499
Douglas Gregorffb4b6e2009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000500/// \brief Given a field that represents a member of an anonymous
501/// struct/union, build the path from that field's context to the
502/// actual member.
503///
504/// Construct the sequence of field member references we'll have to
505/// perform to get to the field in the anonymous union/struct. The
506/// list of members is built from the field outward, so traverse it
507/// backwards to go from an object in the current context to the field
508/// we found.
509///
510/// \returns The variable from which the field access should begin,
511/// for an anonymous struct/union that is not a member of another
512/// class. Otherwise, returns NULL.
513VarDecl *Sema::BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberPath(FieldDecl *Field,
514 llvm::SmallVectorImpl<FieldDecl *> &Path) {
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000515 assert(Field->getDeclContext()->isRecord() &&
516 cast<RecordDecl>(Field->getDeclContext())->isAnonymousStructOrUnion()
517 && "Field must be stored inside an anonymous struct or union");
518
Douglas Gregorffb4b6e2009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000519 Path.push_back(Field);
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000520 VarDecl *BaseObject = 0;
521 DeclContext *Ctx = Field->getDeclContext();
522 do {
523 RecordDecl *Record = cast<RecordDecl>(Ctx);
John McCallbc365c52010-05-21 01:17:40 +0000524 ValueDecl *AnonObject = Record->getAnonymousStructOrUnionObject();
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000525 if (FieldDecl *AnonField = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(AnonObject))
Douglas Gregorffb4b6e2009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000526 Path.push_back(AnonField);
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000527 else {
528 BaseObject = cast<VarDecl>(AnonObject);
529 break;
530 }
531 Ctx = Ctx->getParent();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000532 } while (Ctx->isRecord() &&
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000533 cast<RecordDecl>(Ctx)->isAnonymousStructOrUnion());
Douglas Gregorffb4b6e2009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000534
535 return BaseObject;
536}
537
538Sema::OwningExprResult
539Sema::BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(SourceLocation Loc,
540 FieldDecl *Field,
541 Expr *BaseObjectExpr,
542 SourceLocation OpLoc) {
543 llvm::SmallVector<FieldDecl *, 4> AnonFields;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000544 VarDecl *BaseObject = BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberPath(Field,
Douglas Gregorffb4b6e2009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000545 AnonFields);
546
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000547 // Build the expression that refers to the base object, from
548 // which we will build a sequence of member references to each
549 // of the anonymous union objects and, eventually, the field we
550 // found via name lookup.
551 bool BaseObjectIsPointer = false;
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000552 Qualifiers BaseQuals;
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000553 if (BaseObject) {
554 // BaseObject is an anonymous struct/union variable (and is,
555 // therefore, not part of another non-anonymous record).
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +0000556 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, BaseObject);
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +0000557 BaseObjectExpr = new (Context) DeclRefExpr(BaseObject,BaseObject->getType(),
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +0000558 SourceLocation());
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000559 BaseQuals
560 = Context.getCanonicalType(BaseObject->getType()).getQualifiers();
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000561 } else if (BaseObjectExpr) {
562 // The caller provided the base object expression. Determine
563 // whether its a pointer and whether it adds any qualifiers to the
564 // anonymous struct/union fields we're looking into.
565 QualType ObjectType = BaseObjectExpr->getType();
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +0000566 if (const PointerType *ObjectPtr = ObjectType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000567 BaseObjectIsPointer = true;
568 ObjectType = ObjectPtr->getPointeeType();
569 }
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000570 BaseQuals
571 = Context.getCanonicalType(ObjectType).getQualifiers();
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000572 } else {
573 // We've found a member of an anonymous struct/union that is
574 // inside a non-anonymous struct/union, so in a well-formed
575 // program our base object expression is "this".
John McCallea1471e2010-05-20 01:18:31 +0000576 DeclContext *DC = getFunctionLevelDeclContext();
577 if (CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DC)) {
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000578 if (!MD->isStatic()) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000579 QualType AnonFieldType
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000580 = Context.getTagDeclType(
581 cast<RecordDecl>(AnonFields.back()->getDeclContext()));
582 QualType ThisType = Context.getTagDeclType(MD->getParent());
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000583 if ((Context.getCanonicalType(AnonFieldType)
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000584 == Context.getCanonicalType(ThisType)) ||
585 IsDerivedFrom(ThisType, AnonFieldType)) {
586 // Our base object expression is "this".
Douglas Gregor8aa5f402009-12-24 20:23:34 +0000587 BaseObjectExpr = new (Context) CXXThisExpr(Loc,
Douglas Gregor828a1972010-01-07 23:12:05 +0000588 MD->getThisType(Context),
589 /*isImplicit=*/true);
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000590 BaseObjectIsPointer = true;
591 }
592 } else {
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000593 return ExprError(Diag(Loc,diag::err_invalid_member_use_in_static_method)
594 << Field->getDeclName());
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000595 }
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000596 BaseQuals = Qualifiers::fromCVRMask(MD->getTypeQualifiers());
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000597 }
598
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000599 if (!BaseObjectExpr)
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000600 return ExprError(Diag(Loc, diag::err_invalid_non_static_member_use)
601 << Field->getDeclName());
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000602 }
603
604 // Build the implicit member references to the field of the
605 // anonymous struct/union.
606 Expr *Result = BaseObjectExpr;
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000607 Qualifiers ResultQuals = BaseQuals;
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000608 for (llvm::SmallVector<FieldDecl *, 4>::reverse_iterator
609 FI = AnonFields.rbegin(), FIEnd = AnonFields.rend();
610 FI != FIEnd; ++FI) {
611 QualType MemberType = (*FI)->getType();
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000612 Qualifiers MemberTypeQuals =
613 Context.getCanonicalType(MemberType).getQualifiers();
614
615 // CVR attributes from the base are picked up by members,
616 // except that 'mutable' members don't pick up 'const'.
617 if ((*FI)->isMutable())
618 ResultQuals.removeConst();
619
620 // GC attributes are never picked up by members.
621 ResultQuals.removeObjCGCAttr();
622
623 // TR 18037 does not allow fields to be declared with address spaces.
624 assert(!MemberTypeQuals.hasAddressSpace());
625
626 Qualifiers NewQuals = ResultQuals + MemberTypeQuals;
627 if (NewQuals != MemberTypeQuals)
628 MemberType = Context.getQualifiedType(MemberType, NewQuals);
629
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +0000630 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, *FI);
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +0000631 PerformObjectMemberConversion(Result, /*FIXME:Qualifier=*/0, *FI, *FI);
Douglas Gregorbd4c4ae2009-08-26 22:36:53 +0000632 // FIXME: Might this end up being a qualified name?
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +0000633 Result = new (Context) MemberExpr(Result, BaseObjectIsPointer, *FI,
634 OpLoc, MemberType);
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000635 BaseObjectIsPointer = false;
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000636 ResultQuals = NewQuals;
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000637 }
638
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000639 return Owned(Result);
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000640}
641
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000642/// Decomposes the given name into a DeclarationName, its location, and
643/// possibly a list of template arguments.
644///
645/// If this produces template arguments, it is permitted to call
646/// DecomposeTemplateName.
647///
648/// This actually loses a lot of source location information for
649/// non-standard name kinds; we should consider preserving that in
650/// some way.
651static void DecomposeUnqualifiedId(Sema &SemaRef,
652 const UnqualifiedId &Id,
653 TemplateArgumentListInfo &Buffer,
654 DeclarationName &Name,
655 SourceLocation &NameLoc,
656 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *&TemplateArgs) {
657 if (Id.getKind() == UnqualifiedId::IK_TemplateId) {
658 Buffer.setLAngleLoc(Id.TemplateId->LAngleLoc);
659 Buffer.setRAngleLoc(Id.TemplateId->RAngleLoc);
660
661 ASTTemplateArgsPtr TemplateArgsPtr(SemaRef,
662 Id.TemplateId->getTemplateArgs(),
663 Id.TemplateId->NumArgs);
664 SemaRef.translateTemplateArguments(TemplateArgsPtr, Buffer);
665 TemplateArgsPtr.release();
666
667 TemplateName TName =
668 Sema::TemplateTy::make(Id.TemplateId->Template).getAsVal<TemplateName>();
669
670 Name = SemaRef.Context.getNameForTemplate(TName);
671 NameLoc = Id.TemplateId->TemplateNameLoc;
672 TemplateArgs = &Buffer;
673 } else {
674 Name = SemaRef.GetNameFromUnqualifiedId(Id);
675 NameLoc = Id.StartLocation;
676 TemplateArgs = 0;
677 }
678}
679
John McCall4c72d3e2010-02-08 19:26:07 +0000680/// Determines whether the given record is "fully-formed" at the given
681/// location, i.e. whether a qualified lookup into it is assured of
682/// getting consistent results already.
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000683static bool IsFullyFormedScope(Sema &SemaRef, CXXRecordDecl *Record) {
John McCall4c72d3e2010-02-08 19:26:07 +0000684 if (!Record->hasDefinition())
685 return false;
686
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000687 for (CXXRecordDecl::base_class_iterator I = Record->bases_begin(),
688 E = Record->bases_end(); I != E; ++I) {
689 CanQualType BaseT = SemaRef.Context.getCanonicalType((*I).getType());
690 CanQual<RecordType> BaseRT = BaseT->getAs<RecordType>();
691 if (!BaseRT) return false;
692
693 CXXRecordDecl *BaseRecord = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(BaseRT->getDecl());
John McCall4c72d3e2010-02-08 19:26:07 +0000694 if (!BaseRecord->hasDefinition() ||
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000695 !IsFullyFormedScope(SemaRef, BaseRecord))
696 return false;
697 }
698
699 return true;
700}
701
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000702/// Determines if the given class is provably not derived from all of
703/// the prospective base classes.
704static bool IsProvablyNotDerivedFrom(Sema &SemaRef,
705 CXXRecordDecl *Record,
706 const llvm::SmallPtrSet<CXXRecordDecl*, 4> &Bases) {
John McCallb1b42562009-12-01 22:28:41 +0000707 if (Bases.count(Record->getCanonicalDecl()))
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000708 return false;
709
Douglas Gregor952b0172010-02-11 01:04:33 +0000710 RecordDecl *RD = Record->getDefinition();
John McCallb1b42562009-12-01 22:28:41 +0000711 if (!RD) return false;
712 Record = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD);
713
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000714 for (CXXRecordDecl::base_class_iterator I = Record->bases_begin(),
715 E = Record->bases_end(); I != E; ++I) {
716 CanQualType BaseT = SemaRef.Context.getCanonicalType((*I).getType());
717 CanQual<RecordType> BaseRT = BaseT->getAs<RecordType>();
718 if (!BaseRT) return false;
719
720 CXXRecordDecl *BaseRecord = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(BaseRT->getDecl());
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000721 if (!IsProvablyNotDerivedFrom(SemaRef, BaseRecord, Bases))
722 return false;
723 }
724
725 return true;
726}
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000727
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000728enum IMAKind {
729 /// The reference is definitely not an instance member access.
730 IMA_Static,
731
732 /// The reference may be an implicit instance member access.
733 IMA_Mixed,
734
735 /// The reference may be to an instance member, but it is invalid if
736 /// so, because the context is not an instance method.
737 IMA_Mixed_StaticContext,
738
739 /// The reference may be to an instance member, but it is invalid if
740 /// so, because the context is from an unrelated class.
741 IMA_Mixed_Unrelated,
742
743 /// The reference is definitely an implicit instance member access.
744 IMA_Instance,
745
746 /// The reference may be to an unresolved using declaration.
747 IMA_Unresolved,
748
749 /// The reference may be to an unresolved using declaration and the
750 /// context is not an instance method.
751 IMA_Unresolved_StaticContext,
752
753 /// The reference is to a member of an anonymous structure in a
754 /// non-class context.
755 IMA_AnonymousMember,
756
757 /// All possible referrents are instance members and the current
758 /// context is not an instance method.
759 IMA_Error_StaticContext,
760
761 /// All possible referrents are instance members of an unrelated
762 /// class.
763 IMA_Error_Unrelated
764};
765
766/// The given lookup names class member(s) and is not being used for
767/// an address-of-member expression. Classify the type of access
768/// according to whether it's possible that this reference names an
769/// instance member. This is best-effort; it is okay to
770/// conservatively answer "yes", in which case some errors will simply
771/// not be caught until template-instantiation.
772static IMAKind ClassifyImplicitMemberAccess(Sema &SemaRef,
773 const LookupResult &R) {
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +0000774 assert(!R.empty() && (*R.begin())->isCXXClassMember());
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000775
John McCallea1471e2010-05-20 01:18:31 +0000776 DeclContext *DC = SemaRef.getFunctionLevelDeclContext();
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000777 bool isStaticContext =
John McCallea1471e2010-05-20 01:18:31 +0000778 (!isa<CXXMethodDecl>(DC) ||
779 cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DC)->isStatic());
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000780
781 if (R.isUnresolvableResult())
782 return isStaticContext ? IMA_Unresolved_StaticContext : IMA_Unresolved;
783
784 // Collect all the declaring classes of instance members we find.
785 bool hasNonInstance = false;
786 llvm::SmallPtrSet<CXXRecordDecl*, 4> Classes;
787 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I) {
John McCall161755a2010-04-06 21:38:20 +0000788 NamedDecl *D = *I;
789 if (D->isCXXInstanceMember()) {
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000790 CXXRecordDecl *R = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D->getDeclContext());
791
792 // If this is a member of an anonymous record, move out to the
793 // innermost non-anonymous struct or union. If there isn't one,
794 // that's a special case.
795 while (R->isAnonymousStructOrUnion()) {
796 R = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(R->getParent());
797 if (!R) return IMA_AnonymousMember;
798 }
799 Classes.insert(R->getCanonicalDecl());
800 }
801 else
802 hasNonInstance = true;
803 }
804
805 // If we didn't find any instance members, it can't be an implicit
806 // member reference.
807 if (Classes.empty())
808 return IMA_Static;
809
810 // If the current context is not an instance method, it can't be
811 // an implicit member reference.
812 if (isStaticContext)
813 return (hasNonInstance ? IMA_Mixed_StaticContext : IMA_Error_StaticContext);
814
815 // If we can prove that the current context is unrelated to all the
816 // declaring classes, it can't be an implicit member reference (in
817 // which case it's an error if any of those members are selected).
818 if (IsProvablyNotDerivedFrom(SemaRef,
John McCallea1471e2010-05-20 01:18:31 +0000819 cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DC)->getParent(),
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000820 Classes))
821 return (hasNonInstance ? IMA_Mixed_Unrelated : IMA_Error_Unrelated);
822
823 return (hasNonInstance ? IMA_Mixed : IMA_Instance);
824}
825
826/// Diagnose a reference to a field with no object available.
827static void DiagnoseInstanceReference(Sema &SemaRef,
828 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
829 const LookupResult &R) {
830 SourceLocation Loc = R.getNameLoc();
831 SourceRange Range(Loc);
832 if (SS.isSet()) Range.setBegin(SS.getRange().getBegin());
833
834 if (R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>()) {
835 if (CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(SemaRef.CurContext)) {
836 if (MD->isStatic()) {
837 // "invalid use of member 'x' in static member function"
838 SemaRef.Diag(Loc, diag::err_invalid_member_use_in_static_method)
839 << Range << R.getLookupName();
840 return;
841 }
842 }
843
844 SemaRef.Diag(Loc, diag::err_invalid_non_static_member_use)
845 << R.getLookupName() << Range;
846 return;
847 }
848
849 SemaRef.Diag(Loc, diag::err_member_call_without_object) << Range;
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000850}
851
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000852/// Diagnose an empty lookup.
853///
854/// \return false if new lookup candidates were found
Nick Lewycky03d98c52010-07-06 19:51:49 +0000855bool Sema::DiagnoseEmptyLookup(Scope *S, CXXScopeSpec &SS, LookupResult &R,
856 CorrectTypoContext CTC) {
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000857 DeclarationName Name = R.getLookupName();
858
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000859 unsigned diagnostic = diag::err_undeclared_var_use;
Douglas Gregorbb092ba2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000860 unsigned diagnostic_suggest = diag::err_undeclared_var_use_suggest;
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000861 if (Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXOperatorName ||
862 Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXLiteralOperatorName ||
Douglas Gregorbb092ba2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000863 Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXConversionFunctionName) {
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000864 diagnostic = diag::err_undeclared_use;
Douglas Gregorbb092ba2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000865 diagnostic_suggest = diag::err_undeclared_use_suggest;
866 }
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000867
Douglas Gregorbb092ba2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000868 // If the original lookup was an unqualified lookup, fake an
869 // unqualified lookup. This is useful when (for example) the
870 // original lookup would not have found something because it was a
871 // dependent name.
Nick Lewycky03d98c52010-07-06 19:51:49 +0000872 for (DeclContext *DC = SS.isEmpty() ? CurContext : 0;
Douglas Gregorbb092ba2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000873 DC; DC = DC->getParent()) {
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000874 if (isa<CXXRecordDecl>(DC)) {
875 LookupQualifiedName(R, DC);
876
877 if (!R.empty()) {
878 // Don't give errors about ambiguities in this lookup.
879 R.suppressDiagnostics();
880
881 CXXMethodDecl *CurMethod = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(CurContext);
882 bool isInstance = CurMethod &&
883 CurMethod->isInstance() &&
884 DC == CurMethod->getParent();
885
886 // Give a code modification hint to insert 'this->'.
887 // TODO: fixit for inserting 'Base<T>::' in the other cases.
888 // Actually quite difficult!
Nick Lewycky03d98c52010-07-06 19:51:49 +0000889 if (isInstance) {
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000890 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic) << Name
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +0000891 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(R.getNameLoc(), "this->");
Nick Lewycky03d98c52010-07-06 19:51:49 +0000892
893 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE = cast<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(
894 CallsUndergoingInstantiation.back()->getCallee());
895 CXXMethodDecl *DepMethod = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(
896 CurMethod->getInstantiatedFromMemberFunction());
897 QualType DepThisType = DepMethod->getThisType(Context);
898 CXXThisExpr *DepThis = new (Context) CXXThisExpr(R.getNameLoc(),
899 DepThisType, false);
900 TemplateArgumentListInfo TList;
901 if (ULE->hasExplicitTemplateArgs())
902 ULE->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TList);
903 CXXDependentScopeMemberExpr *DepExpr =
904 CXXDependentScopeMemberExpr::Create(
905 Context, DepThis, DepThisType, true, SourceLocation(),
906 ULE->getQualifier(), ULE->getQualifierRange(), NULL, Name,
907 R.getNameLoc(), &TList);
908 CallsUndergoingInstantiation.back()->setCallee(DepExpr);
909 } else {
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000910 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic) << Name;
Nick Lewycky03d98c52010-07-06 19:51:49 +0000911 }
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000912
913 // Do we really want to note all of these?
914 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I)
915 Diag((*I)->getLocation(), diag::note_dependent_var_use);
916
917 // Tell the callee to try to recover.
918 return false;
919 }
Douglas Gregore26f0432010-08-09 22:38:14 +0000920
921 R.clear();
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000922 }
923 }
924
Douglas Gregorbb092ba2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000925 // We didn't find anything, so try to correct for a typo.
Douglas Gregoraaf87162010-04-14 20:04:41 +0000926 DeclarationName Corrected;
Daniel Dunbardc32cdf2010-06-02 15:46:52 +0000927 if (S && (Corrected = CorrectTypo(R, S, &SS, 0, false, CTC))) {
Douglas Gregoraaf87162010-04-14 20:04:41 +0000928 if (!R.empty()) {
929 if (isa<ValueDecl>(*R.begin()) || isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(*R.begin())) {
930 if (SS.isEmpty())
931 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic_suggest) << Name << R.getLookupName()
932 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(R.getNameLoc(),
933 R.getLookupName().getAsString());
934 else
935 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member_suggest)
936 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false) << R.getLookupName()
937 << SS.getRange()
938 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(R.getNameLoc(),
939 R.getLookupName().getAsString());
940 if (NamedDecl *ND = R.getAsSingle<NamedDecl>())
941 Diag(ND->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
942 << ND->getDeclName();
943
944 // Tell the callee to try to recover.
945 return false;
946 }
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +0000947
Douglas Gregoraaf87162010-04-14 20:04:41 +0000948 if (isa<TypeDecl>(*R.begin()) || isa<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(*R.begin())) {
949 // FIXME: If we ended up with a typo for a type name or
950 // Objective-C class name, we're in trouble because the parser
951 // is in the wrong place to recover. Suggest the typo
952 // correction, but don't make it a fix-it since we're not going
953 // to recover well anyway.
954 if (SS.isEmpty())
955 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic_suggest) << Name << R.getLookupName();
956 else
957 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member_suggest)
958 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false) << R.getLookupName()
959 << SS.getRange();
960
961 // Don't try to recover; it won't work.
962 return true;
963 }
964 } else {
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +0000965 // FIXME: We found a keyword. Suggest it, but don't provide a fix-it
Douglas Gregoraaf87162010-04-14 20:04:41 +0000966 // because we aren't able to recover.
Douglas Gregord203a162010-01-01 00:15:04 +0000967 if (SS.isEmpty())
Douglas Gregoraaf87162010-04-14 20:04:41 +0000968 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic_suggest) << Name << Corrected;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000969 else
Douglas Gregord203a162010-01-01 00:15:04 +0000970 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member_suggest)
Douglas Gregoraaf87162010-04-14 20:04:41 +0000971 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false) << Corrected
972 << SS.getRange();
Douglas Gregord203a162010-01-01 00:15:04 +0000973 return true;
974 }
Douglas Gregord203a162010-01-01 00:15:04 +0000975 R.clear();
Douglas Gregorbb092ba2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000976 }
977
978 // Emit a special diagnostic for failed member lookups.
979 // FIXME: computing the declaration context might fail here (?)
980 if (!SS.isEmpty()) {
981 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member)
982 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false)
983 << SS.getRange();
984 return true;
985 }
986
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000987 // Give up, we can't recover.
988 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic) << Name;
989 return true;
990}
991
Fariborz Jahanian69d56242010-07-22 23:33:21 +0000992static ObjCPropertyDecl *OkToSynthesizeProvisionalIvar(Sema &SemaRef,
Fariborz Jahanian73f666f2010-07-30 16:59:05 +0000993 IdentifierInfo *II,
994 SourceLocation NameLoc) {
Fariborz Jahanian69d56242010-07-22 23:33:21 +0000995 ObjCMethodDecl *CurMeth = SemaRef.getCurMethodDecl();
996 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IDecl = CurMeth->getClassInterface();
997 if (!IDecl)
998 return 0;
999 ObjCImplementationDecl *ClassImpDecl = IDecl->getImplementation();
1000 if (!ClassImpDecl)
1001 return 0;
1002 ObjCPropertyDecl *property = SemaRef.LookupPropertyDecl(IDecl, II);
1003 if (!property)
1004 return 0;
1005 if (ObjCPropertyImplDecl *PIDecl = ClassImpDecl->FindPropertyImplDecl(II))
1006 if (PIDecl->getPropertyImplementation() == ObjCPropertyImplDecl::Dynamic)
1007 return 0;
1008 return property;
1009}
1010
Fariborz Jahanianad51e742010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001011static ObjCIvarDecl *SynthesizeProvisionalIvar(Sema &SemaRef,
Fariborz Jahanian73f666f2010-07-30 16:59:05 +00001012 LookupResult &Lookup,
Fariborz Jahanianad51e742010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001013 IdentifierInfo *II,
1014 SourceLocation NameLoc) {
1015 ObjCMethodDecl *CurMeth = SemaRef.getCurMethodDecl();
Fariborz Jahanian73f666f2010-07-30 16:59:05 +00001016 bool LookForIvars;
1017 if (Lookup.empty())
1018 LookForIvars = true;
1019 else if (CurMeth->isClassMethod())
1020 LookForIvars = false;
1021 else
1022 LookForIvars = (Lookup.isSingleResult() &&
1023 Lookup.getFoundDecl()->isDefinedOutsideFunctionOrMethod());
1024 if (!LookForIvars)
1025 return 0;
1026
Fariborz Jahanianad51e742010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001027 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IDecl = CurMeth->getClassInterface();
1028 if (!IDecl)
1029 return 0;
1030 ObjCImplementationDecl *ClassImpDecl = IDecl->getImplementation();
Fariborz Jahanian84ef4b22010-07-19 16:14:33 +00001031 if (!ClassImpDecl)
1032 return 0;
Fariborz Jahanianad51e742010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001033 bool DynamicImplSeen = false;
1034 ObjCPropertyDecl *property = SemaRef.LookupPropertyDecl(IDecl, II);
1035 if (!property)
1036 return 0;
1037 if (ObjCPropertyImplDecl *PIDecl = ClassImpDecl->FindPropertyImplDecl(II))
1038 DynamicImplSeen =
1039 (PIDecl->getPropertyImplementation() == ObjCPropertyImplDecl::Dynamic);
1040 if (!DynamicImplSeen) {
Fariborz Jahanian84ef4b22010-07-19 16:14:33 +00001041 QualType PropType = SemaRef.Context.getCanonicalType(property->getType());
1042 ObjCIvarDecl *Ivar = ObjCIvarDecl::Create(SemaRef.Context, ClassImpDecl,
Fariborz Jahanianad51e742010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001043 NameLoc,
1044 II, PropType, /*Dinfo=*/0,
1045 ObjCIvarDecl::Protected,
1046 (Expr *)0, true);
1047 ClassImpDecl->addDecl(Ivar);
1048 IDecl->makeDeclVisibleInContext(Ivar, false);
1049 property->setPropertyIvarDecl(Ivar);
1050 return Ivar;
1051 }
1052 return 0;
1053}
1054
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001055Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnIdExpression(Scope *S,
Jeffrey Yasskin9ab14542010-04-08 16:38:48 +00001056 CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001057 UnqualifiedId &Id,
1058 bool HasTrailingLParen,
1059 bool isAddressOfOperand) {
1060 assert(!(isAddressOfOperand && HasTrailingLParen) &&
1061 "cannot be direct & operand and have a trailing lparen");
1062
1063 if (SS.isInvalid())
Douglas Gregor4c921ae2009-01-30 01:04:22 +00001064 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor5953d8b2009-03-19 17:26:29 +00001065
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001066 TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer;
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001067
1068 // Decompose the UnqualifiedId into the following data.
1069 DeclarationName Name;
1070 SourceLocation NameLoc;
1071 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs;
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001072 DecomposeUnqualifiedId(*this, Id, TemplateArgsBuffer,
1073 Name, NameLoc, TemplateArgs);
Douglas Gregor5953d8b2009-03-19 17:26:29 +00001074
Douglas Gregor10c42622008-11-18 15:03:34 +00001075 IdentifierInfo *II = Name.getAsIdentifierInfo();
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001076
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001077 // C++ [temp.dep.expr]p3:
1078 // An id-expression is type-dependent if it contains:
Douglas Gregor48026d22010-01-11 18:40:55 +00001079 // -- an identifier that was declared with a dependent type,
1080 // (note: handled after lookup)
1081 // -- a template-id that is dependent,
1082 // (note: handled in BuildTemplateIdExpr)
1083 // -- a conversion-function-id that specifies a dependent type,
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001084 // -- a nested-name-specifier that contains a class-name that
1085 // names a dependent type.
1086 // Determine whether this is a member of an unknown specialization;
1087 // we need to handle these differently.
Eli Friedman647c8b32010-08-06 23:41:47 +00001088 bool DependentID = false;
1089 if (Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXConversionFunctionName &&
1090 Name.getCXXNameType()->isDependentType()) {
1091 DependentID = true;
1092 } else if (SS.isSet()) {
1093 DeclContext *DC = computeDeclContext(SS, false);
1094 if (DC) {
1095 if (RequireCompleteDeclContext(SS, DC))
1096 return ExprError();
1097 // FIXME: We should be checking whether DC is the current instantiation.
1098 if (CXXRecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DC))
1099 DependentID = !IsFullyFormedScope(*this, RD);
1100 } else {
1101 DependentID = true;
1102 }
1103 }
1104
1105 if (DependentID) {
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001106 return ActOnDependentIdExpression(SS, Name, NameLoc,
John McCall2f841ba2009-12-02 03:53:29 +00001107 isAddressOfOperand,
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001108 TemplateArgs);
1109 }
Fariborz Jahanian69d56242010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001110 bool IvarLookupFollowUp = false;
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001111 // Perform the required lookup.
1112 LookupResult R(*this, Name, NameLoc, LookupOrdinaryName);
1113 if (TemplateArgs) {
Douglas Gregord2235f62010-05-20 20:58:56 +00001114 // Lookup the template name again to correctly establish the context in
1115 // which it was found. This is really unfortunate as we already did the
1116 // lookup to determine that it was a template name in the first place. If
1117 // this becomes a performance hit, we can work harder to preserve those
1118 // results until we get here but it's likely not worth it.
Douglas Gregor1fd6d442010-05-21 23:18:07 +00001119 bool MemberOfUnknownSpecialization;
1120 LookupTemplateName(R, S, SS, QualType(), /*EnteringContext=*/false,
1121 MemberOfUnknownSpecialization);
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001122 } else {
Fariborz Jahanian69d56242010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001123 IvarLookupFollowUp = (!SS.isSet() && II && getCurMethodDecl());
Fariborz Jahanian48c2d562010-01-12 23:58:59 +00001124 LookupParsedName(R, S, &SS, !IvarLookupFollowUp);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001125
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001126 // If this reference is in an Objective-C method, then we need to do
1127 // some special Objective-C lookup, too.
Fariborz Jahanian48c2d562010-01-12 23:58:59 +00001128 if (IvarLookupFollowUp) {
1129 OwningExprResult E(LookupInObjCMethod(R, S, II, true));
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001130 if (E.isInvalid())
1131 return ExprError();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001132
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001133 Expr *Ex = E.takeAs<Expr>();
1134 if (Ex) return Owned(Ex);
Fariborz Jahanianad51e742010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001135 // Synthesize ivars lazily
1136 if (getLangOptions().ObjCNonFragileABI2) {
Fariborz Jahanian73f666f2010-07-30 16:59:05 +00001137 if (SynthesizeProvisionalIvar(*this, R, II, NameLoc))
Fariborz Jahanianad51e742010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001138 return ActOnIdExpression(S, SS, Id, HasTrailingLParen,
1139 isAddressOfOperand);
1140 }
Steve Naroffe3e9add2008-06-02 23:03:37 +00001141 }
Chris Lattner8a934232008-03-31 00:36:02 +00001142 }
Douglas Gregorc71e28c2009-02-16 19:28:42 +00001143
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001144 if (R.isAmbiguous())
1145 return ExprError();
1146
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +00001147 // Determine whether this name might be a candidate for
1148 // argument-dependent lookup.
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001149 bool ADL = UseArgumentDependentLookup(SS, R, HasTrailingLParen);
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +00001150
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001151 if (R.empty() && !ADL) {
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001152 // Otherwise, this could be an implicitly declared function reference (legal
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001153 // in C90, extension in C99, forbidden in C++).
1154 if (HasTrailingLParen && II && !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
1155 NamedDecl *D = ImplicitlyDefineFunction(NameLoc, *II, S);
1156 if (D) R.addDecl(D);
1157 }
1158
1159 // If this name wasn't predeclared and if this is not a function
1160 // call, diagnose the problem.
1161 if (R.empty()) {
Douglas Gregor91f7ac72010-05-18 16:14:23 +00001162 if (DiagnoseEmptyLookup(S, SS, R, CTC_Unknown))
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +00001163 return ExprError();
1164
1165 assert(!R.empty() &&
1166 "DiagnoseEmptyLookup returned false but added no results");
Douglas Gregorf06cdae2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00001167
1168 // If we found an Objective-C instance variable, let
1169 // LookupInObjCMethod build the appropriate expression to
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001170 // reference the ivar.
Douglas Gregorf06cdae2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00001171 if (ObjCIvarDecl *Ivar = R.getAsSingle<ObjCIvarDecl>()) {
1172 R.clear();
1173 OwningExprResult E(LookupInObjCMethod(R, S, Ivar->getIdentifier()));
1174 assert(E.isInvalid() || E.get());
1175 return move(E);
1176 }
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001177 }
1178 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001179
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001180 // This is guaranteed from this point on.
1181 assert(!R.empty() || ADL);
1182
1183 if (VarDecl *Var = R.getAsSingle<VarDecl>()) {
Fariborz Jahanian69d56242010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001184 if (getLangOptions().ObjCNonFragileABI && IvarLookupFollowUp &&
Fariborz Jahanianb1d58e32010-07-29 16:53:53 +00001185 !getLangOptions().ObjCNonFragileABI2 &&
1186 Var->isFileVarDecl()) {
Fariborz Jahanian69d56242010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001187 ObjCPropertyDecl *Property =
1188 OkToSynthesizeProvisionalIvar(*this, II, NameLoc);
1189 if (Property) {
1190 Diag(NameLoc, diag::warn_ivar_variable_conflict) << Var->getDeclName();
1191 Diag(Property->getLocation(), diag::note_property_declare);
1192 }
1193 }
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001194 } else if (FunctionDecl *Func = R.getAsSingle<FunctionDecl>()) {
Douglas Gregor751f9a42009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001195 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && !Func->hasPrototype()) {
1196 // C99 DR 316 says that, if a function type comes from a
1197 // function definition (without a prototype), that type is only
1198 // used for checking compatibility. Therefore, when referencing
1199 // the function, we pretend that we don't have the full function
1200 // type.
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001201 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Func, NameLoc))
Douglas Gregor751f9a42009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001202 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +00001203
Douglas Gregor751f9a42009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001204 QualType T = Func->getType();
1205 QualType NoProtoType = T;
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00001206 if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto = T->getAs<FunctionProtoType>())
Eli Friedman9a0fcfe2010-05-17 02:50:18 +00001207 NoProtoType = Context.getFunctionNoProtoType(Proto->getResultType(),
1208 Proto->getExtInfo());
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001209 return BuildDeclRefExpr(Func, NoProtoType, NameLoc, &SS);
Douglas Gregor751f9a42009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001210 }
1211 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001212
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001213 // Check whether this might be a C++ implicit instance member access.
1214 // C++ [expr.prim.general]p6:
1215 // Within the definition of a non-static member function, an
1216 // identifier that names a non-static member is transformed to a
1217 // class member access expression.
1218 // But note that &SomeClass::foo is grammatically distinct, even
1219 // though we don't parse it that way.
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001220 if (!R.empty() && (*R.begin())->isCXXClassMember()) {
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001221 bool isAbstractMemberPointer = (isAddressOfOperand && !SS.isEmpty());
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001222 if (!isAbstractMemberPointer)
1223 return BuildPossibleImplicitMemberExpr(SS, R, TemplateArgs);
John McCall5b3f9132009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001224 }
1225
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001226 if (TemplateArgs)
1227 return BuildTemplateIdExpr(SS, R, ADL, *TemplateArgs);
John McCall5b3f9132009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001228
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001229 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R, ADL);
1230}
1231
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001232/// Builds an expression which might be an implicit member expression.
1233Sema::OwningExprResult
1234Sema::BuildPossibleImplicitMemberExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
1235 LookupResult &R,
1236 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs) {
1237 switch (ClassifyImplicitMemberAccess(*this, R)) {
1238 case IMA_Instance:
1239 return BuildImplicitMemberExpr(SS, R, TemplateArgs, true);
1240
1241 case IMA_AnonymousMember:
1242 assert(R.isSingleResult());
1243 return BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(R.getNameLoc(),
1244 R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>());
1245
1246 case IMA_Mixed:
1247 case IMA_Mixed_Unrelated:
1248 case IMA_Unresolved:
1249 return BuildImplicitMemberExpr(SS, R, TemplateArgs, false);
1250
1251 case IMA_Static:
1252 case IMA_Mixed_StaticContext:
1253 case IMA_Unresolved_StaticContext:
1254 if (TemplateArgs)
1255 return BuildTemplateIdExpr(SS, R, false, *TemplateArgs);
1256 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R, false);
1257
1258 case IMA_Error_StaticContext:
1259 case IMA_Error_Unrelated:
1260 DiagnoseInstanceReference(*this, SS, R);
1261 return ExprError();
1262 }
1263
1264 llvm_unreachable("unexpected instance member access kind");
1265 return ExprError();
1266}
1267
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001268/// BuildQualifiedDeclarationNameExpr - Build a C++ qualified
1269/// declaration name, generally during template instantiation.
1270/// There's a large number of things which don't need to be done along
1271/// this path.
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001272Sema::OwningExprResult
Jeffrey Yasskin9ab14542010-04-08 16:38:48 +00001273Sema::BuildQualifiedDeclarationNameExpr(CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001274 DeclarationName Name,
1275 SourceLocation NameLoc) {
1276 DeclContext *DC;
Douglas Gregore6ec5c42010-04-28 07:04:26 +00001277 if (!(DC = computeDeclContext(SS, false)) || DC->isDependentContext())
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001278 return BuildDependentDeclRefExpr(SS, Name, NameLoc, 0);
1279
John McCall77bb1aa2010-05-01 00:40:08 +00001280 if (RequireCompleteDeclContext(SS, DC))
Douglas Gregore6ec5c42010-04-28 07:04:26 +00001281 return ExprError();
1282
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001283 LookupResult R(*this, Name, NameLoc, LookupOrdinaryName);
1284 LookupQualifiedName(R, DC);
1285
1286 if (R.isAmbiguous())
1287 return ExprError();
1288
1289 if (R.empty()) {
1290 Diag(NameLoc, diag::err_no_member) << Name << DC << SS.getRange();
1291 return ExprError();
1292 }
1293
1294 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R, /*ADL*/ false);
1295}
1296
1297/// LookupInObjCMethod - The parser has read a name in, and Sema has
1298/// detected that we're currently inside an ObjC method. Perform some
1299/// additional lookup.
1300///
1301/// Ideally, most of this would be done by lookup, but there's
1302/// actually quite a lot of extra work involved.
1303///
1304/// Returns a null sentinel to indicate trivial success.
1305Sema::OwningExprResult
1306Sema::LookupInObjCMethod(LookupResult &Lookup, Scope *S,
Chris Lattnereb483eb2010-04-11 08:28:14 +00001307 IdentifierInfo *II, bool AllowBuiltinCreation) {
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001308 SourceLocation Loc = Lookup.getNameLoc();
Chris Lattneraec43db2010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001309 ObjCMethodDecl *CurMethod = getCurMethodDecl();
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00001310
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001311 // There are two cases to handle here. 1) scoped lookup could have failed,
1312 // in which case we should look for an ivar. 2) scoped lookup could have
1313 // found a decl, but that decl is outside the current instance method (i.e.
1314 // a global variable). In these two cases, we do a lookup for an ivar with
1315 // this name, if the lookup sucedes, we replace it our current decl.
1316
1317 // If we're in a class method, we don't normally want to look for
1318 // ivars. But if we don't find anything else, and there's an
1319 // ivar, that's an error.
Chris Lattneraec43db2010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001320 bool IsClassMethod = CurMethod->isClassMethod();
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001321
1322 bool LookForIvars;
1323 if (Lookup.empty())
1324 LookForIvars = true;
1325 else if (IsClassMethod)
1326 LookForIvars = false;
1327 else
1328 LookForIvars = (Lookup.isSingleResult() &&
1329 Lookup.getFoundDecl()->isDefinedOutsideFunctionOrMethod());
Fariborz Jahanian412e7982010-02-09 19:31:38 +00001330 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = 0;
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001331 if (LookForIvars) {
Chris Lattneraec43db2010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001332 IFace = CurMethod->getClassInterface();
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001333 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassDeclared;
1334 if (ObjCIvarDecl *IV = IFace->lookupInstanceVariable(II, ClassDeclared)) {
1335 // Diagnose using an ivar in a class method.
1336 if (IsClassMethod)
1337 return ExprError(Diag(Loc, diag::error_ivar_use_in_class_method)
1338 << IV->getDeclName());
1339
1340 // If we're referencing an invalid decl, just return this as a silent
1341 // error node. The error diagnostic was already emitted on the decl.
1342 if (IV->isInvalidDecl())
1343 return ExprError();
1344
1345 // Check if referencing a field with __attribute__((deprecated)).
1346 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(IV, Loc))
1347 return ExprError();
1348
1349 // Diagnose the use of an ivar outside of the declaring class.
1350 if (IV->getAccessControl() == ObjCIvarDecl::Private &&
1351 ClassDeclared != IFace)
1352 Diag(Loc, diag::error_private_ivar_access) << IV->getDeclName();
1353
1354 // FIXME: This should use a new expr for a direct reference, don't
1355 // turn this into Self->ivar, just return a BareIVarExpr or something.
1356 IdentifierInfo &II = Context.Idents.get("self");
1357 UnqualifiedId SelfName;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001358 SelfName.setIdentifier(&II, SourceLocation());
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001359 CXXScopeSpec SelfScopeSpec;
1360 OwningExprResult SelfExpr = ActOnIdExpression(S, SelfScopeSpec,
1361 SelfName, false, false);
1362 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, IV);
1363 return Owned(new (Context)
1364 ObjCIvarRefExpr(IV, IV->getType(), Loc,
1365 SelfExpr.takeAs<Expr>(), true, true));
1366 }
Chris Lattneraec43db2010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001367 } else if (CurMethod->isInstanceMethod()) {
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001368 // We should warn if a local variable hides an ivar.
Chris Lattneraec43db2010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001369 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = CurMethod->getClassInterface();
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001370 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassDeclared;
1371 if (ObjCIvarDecl *IV = IFace->lookupInstanceVariable(II, ClassDeclared)) {
1372 if (IV->getAccessControl() != ObjCIvarDecl::Private ||
1373 IFace == ClassDeclared)
1374 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_ivar_use_hidden) << IV->getDeclName();
1375 }
1376 }
1377
Fariborz Jahanian48c2d562010-01-12 23:58:59 +00001378 if (Lookup.empty() && II && AllowBuiltinCreation) {
1379 // FIXME. Consolidate this with similar code in LookupName.
1380 if (unsigned BuiltinID = II->getBuiltinID()) {
1381 if (!(getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
1382 Context.BuiltinInfo.isPredefinedLibFunction(BuiltinID))) {
1383 NamedDecl *D = LazilyCreateBuiltin((IdentifierInfo *)II, BuiltinID,
1384 S, Lookup.isForRedeclaration(),
1385 Lookup.getNameLoc());
1386 if (D) Lookup.addDecl(D);
1387 }
1388 }
1389 }
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001390 // Sentinel value saying that we didn't do anything special.
1391 return Owned((Expr*) 0);
Douglas Gregor751f9a42009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001392}
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001393
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001394/// \brief Cast a base object to a member's actual type.
1395///
1396/// Logically this happens in three phases:
1397///
1398/// * First we cast from the base type to the naming class.
1399/// The naming class is the class into which we were looking
1400/// when we found the member; it's the qualifier type if a
1401/// qualifier was provided, and otherwise it's the base type.
1402///
1403/// * Next we cast from the naming class to the declaring class.
1404/// If the member we found was brought into a class's scope by
1405/// a using declaration, this is that class; otherwise it's
1406/// the class declaring the member.
1407///
1408/// * Finally we cast from the declaring class to the "true"
1409/// declaring class of the member. This conversion does not
1410/// obey access control.
Fariborz Jahanianf3e53d32009-07-29 19:40:11 +00001411bool
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001412Sema::PerformObjectMemberConversion(Expr *&From,
1413 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier,
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001414 NamedDecl *FoundDecl,
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001415 NamedDecl *Member) {
1416 CXXRecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Member->getDeclContext());
1417 if (!RD)
1418 return false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001419
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001420 QualType DestRecordType;
1421 QualType DestType;
1422 QualType FromRecordType;
1423 QualType FromType = From->getType();
1424 bool PointerConversions = false;
1425 if (isa<FieldDecl>(Member)) {
1426 DestRecordType = Context.getCanonicalType(Context.getTypeDeclType(RD));
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001427
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001428 if (FromType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
1429 DestType = Context.getPointerType(DestRecordType);
1430 FromRecordType = FromType->getPointeeType();
1431 PointerConversions = true;
1432 } else {
1433 DestType = DestRecordType;
1434 FromRecordType = FromType;
Fariborz Jahanian98a541e2009-07-29 18:40:24 +00001435 }
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001436 } else if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Member)) {
1437 if (Method->isStatic())
1438 return false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001439
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001440 DestType = Method->getThisType(Context);
1441 DestRecordType = DestType->getPointeeType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001442
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001443 if (FromType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
1444 FromRecordType = FromType->getPointeeType();
1445 PointerConversions = true;
1446 } else {
1447 FromRecordType = FromType;
1448 DestType = DestRecordType;
1449 }
1450 } else {
1451 // No conversion necessary.
1452 return false;
1453 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001454
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001455 if (DestType->isDependentType() || FromType->isDependentType())
1456 return false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001457
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001458 // If the unqualified types are the same, no conversion is necessary.
1459 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromRecordType, DestRecordType))
1460 return false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001461
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001462 SourceRange FromRange = From->getSourceRange();
1463 SourceLocation FromLoc = FromRange.getBegin();
1464
Sebastian Redl906082e2010-07-20 04:20:21 +00001465 ImplicitCastExpr::ResultCategory Category = CastCategory(From);
1466
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001467 // C++ [class.member.lookup]p8:
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001468 // [...] Ambiguities can often be resolved by qualifying a name with its
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001469 // class name.
1470 //
1471 // If the member was a qualified name and the qualified referred to a
1472 // specific base subobject type, we'll cast to that intermediate type
1473 // first and then to the object in which the member is declared. That allows
1474 // one to resolve ambiguities in, e.g., a diamond-shaped hierarchy such as:
1475 //
1476 // class Base { public: int x; };
1477 // class Derived1 : public Base { };
1478 // class Derived2 : public Base { };
1479 // class VeryDerived : public Derived1, public Derived2 { void f(); };
1480 //
1481 // void VeryDerived::f() {
1482 // x = 17; // error: ambiguous base subobjects
1483 // Derived1::x = 17; // okay, pick the Base subobject of Derived1
1484 // }
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001485 if (Qualifier) {
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001486 QualType QType = QualType(Qualifier->getAsType(), 0);
1487 assert(!QType.isNull() && "lookup done with dependent qualifier?");
1488 assert(QType->isRecordType() && "lookup done with non-record type");
1489
1490 QualType QRecordType = QualType(QType->getAs<RecordType>(), 0);
1491
1492 // In C++98, the qualifier type doesn't actually have to be a base
1493 // type of the object type, in which case we just ignore it.
1494 // Otherwise build the appropriate casts.
1495 if (IsDerivedFrom(FromRecordType, QRecordType)) {
John McCallf871d0c2010-08-07 06:22:56 +00001496 CXXCastPath BasePath;
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001497 if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion(FromRecordType, QRecordType,
Anders Carlssoncee22422010-04-24 19:22:20 +00001498 FromLoc, FromRange, &BasePath))
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001499 return true;
1500
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001501 if (PointerConversions)
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001502 QType = Context.getPointerType(QType);
John McCall23cba802010-03-30 23:58:03 +00001503 ImpCastExprToType(From, QType, CastExpr::CK_UncheckedDerivedToBase,
John McCallf871d0c2010-08-07 06:22:56 +00001504 Category, &BasePath);
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001505
1506 FromType = QType;
1507 FromRecordType = QRecordType;
1508
1509 // If the qualifier type was the same as the destination type,
1510 // we're done.
1511 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromRecordType, DestRecordType))
1512 return false;
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001513 }
1514 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001515
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001516 bool IgnoreAccess = false;
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001517
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001518 // If we actually found the member through a using declaration, cast
1519 // down to the using declaration's type.
1520 //
1521 // Pointer equality is fine here because only one declaration of a
1522 // class ever has member declarations.
1523 if (FoundDecl->getDeclContext() != Member->getDeclContext()) {
1524 assert(isa<UsingShadowDecl>(FoundDecl));
1525 QualType URecordType = Context.getTypeDeclType(
1526 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(FoundDecl->getDeclContext()));
1527
1528 // We only need to do this if the naming-class to declaring-class
1529 // conversion is non-trivial.
1530 if (!Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromRecordType, URecordType)) {
1531 assert(IsDerivedFrom(FromRecordType, URecordType));
John McCallf871d0c2010-08-07 06:22:56 +00001532 CXXCastPath BasePath;
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001533 if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion(FromRecordType, URecordType,
Anders Carlssoncee22422010-04-24 19:22:20 +00001534 FromLoc, FromRange, &BasePath))
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001535 return true;
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00001536
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001537 QualType UType = URecordType;
1538 if (PointerConversions)
1539 UType = Context.getPointerType(UType);
John McCall23cba802010-03-30 23:58:03 +00001540 ImpCastExprToType(From, UType, CastExpr::CK_UncheckedDerivedToBase,
John McCallf871d0c2010-08-07 06:22:56 +00001541 Category, &BasePath);
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001542 FromType = UType;
1543 FromRecordType = URecordType;
1544 }
1545
1546 // We don't do access control for the conversion from the
1547 // declaring class to the true declaring class.
1548 IgnoreAccess = true;
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001549 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001550
John McCallf871d0c2010-08-07 06:22:56 +00001551 CXXCastPath BasePath;
Anders Carlssoncee22422010-04-24 19:22:20 +00001552 if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion(FromRecordType, DestRecordType,
1553 FromLoc, FromRange, &BasePath,
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001554 IgnoreAccess))
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001555 return true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001556
John McCall23cba802010-03-30 23:58:03 +00001557 ImpCastExprToType(From, DestType, CastExpr::CK_UncheckedDerivedToBase,
John McCallf871d0c2010-08-07 06:22:56 +00001558 Category, &BasePath);
Fariborz Jahanianf3e53d32009-07-29 19:40:11 +00001559 return false;
Fariborz Jahanian98a541e2009-07-29 18:40:24 +00001560}
Douglas Gregor751f9a42009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001561
Douglas Gregor83f6faf2009-08-31 23:41:50 +00001562/// \brief Build a MemberExpr AST node.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001563static MemberExpr *BuildMemberExpr(ASTContext &C, Expr *Base, bool isArrow,
Eli Friedmanf595cc42009-12-04 06:40:45 +00001564 const CXXScopeSpec &SS, ValueDecl *Member,
John McCall161755a2010-04-06 21:38:20 +00001565 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
1566 SourceLocation Loc, QualType Ty,
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001567 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs = 0) {
1568 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier = 0;
1569 SourceRange QualifierRange;
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001570 if (SS.isSet()) {
1571 Qualifier = (NestedNameSpecifier *) SS.getScopeRep();
1572 QualifierRange = SS.getRange();
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001573 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001574
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001575 return MemberExpr::Create(C, Base, isArrow, Qualifier, QualifierRange,
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001576 Member, FoundDecl, Loc, TemplateArgs, Ty);
Douglas Gregorbd4c4ae2009-08-26 22:36:53 +00001577}
1578
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001579/// Builds an implicit member access expression. The current context
1580/// is known to be an instance method, and the given unqualified lookup
1581/// set is known to contain only instance members, at least one of which
1582/// is from an appropriate type.
John McCall5b3f9132009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001583Sema::OwningExprResult
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001584Sema::BuildImplicitMemberExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
1585 LookupResult &R,
1586 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs,
1587 bool IsKnownInstance) {
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001588 assert(!R.empty() && !R.isAmbiguous());
1589
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001590 SourceLocation Loc = R.getNameLoc();
Sebastian Redlebc07d52009-02-03 20:19:35 +00001591
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +00001592 // We may have found a field within an anonymous union or struct
1593 // (C++ [class.union]).
Douglas Gregore961afb2009-10-22 07:08:30 +00001594 // FIXME: This needs to happen post-isImplicitMemberReference?
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001595 // FIXME: template-ids inside anonymous structs?
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001596 if (FieldDecl *FD = R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>())
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +00001597 if (cast<RecordDecl>(FD->getDeclContext())->isAnonymousStructOrUnion())
John McCall5b3f9132009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001598 return BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(Loc, FD);
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001599
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001600 // If this is known to be an instance access, go ahead and build a
1601 // 'this' expression now.
John McCallea1471e2010-05-20 01:18:31 +00001602 DeclContext *DC = getFunctionLevelDeclContext();
1603 QualType ThisType = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DC)->getThisType(Context);
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001604 Expr *This = 0; // null signifies implicit access
1605 if (IsKnownInstance) {
Douglas Gregor828a1972010-01-07 23:12:05 +00001606 SourceLocation Loc = R.getNameLoc();
1607 if (SS.getRange().isValid())
1608 Loc = SS.getRange().getBegin();
1609 This = new (Context) CXXThisExpr(Loc, ThisType, /*isImplicit=*/true);
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00001610 }
1611
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001612 return BuildMemberReferenceExpr(ExprArg(*this, This), ThisType,
1613 /*OpLoc*/ SourceLocation(),
1614 /*IsArrow*/ true,
John McCallc2233c52010-01-15 08:34:02 +00001615 SS,
1616 /*FirstQualifierInScope*/ 0,
1617 R, TemplateArgs);
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001618}
1619
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001620bool Sema::UseArgumentDependentLookup(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall5b3f9132009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001621 const LookupResult &R,
1622 bool HasTrailingLParen) {
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001623 // Only when used directly as the postfix-expression of a call.
1624 if (!HasTrailingLParen)
1625 return false;
1626
1627 // Never if a scope specifier was provided.
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001628 if (SS.isSet())
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001629 return false;
1630
1631 // Only in C++ or ObjC++.
John McCall5b3f9132009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001632 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001633 return false;
1634
1635 // Turn off ADL when we find certain kinds of declarations during
1636 // normal lookup:
1637 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I) {
1638 NamedDecl *D = *I;
1639
1640 // C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3:
1641 // -- a declaration of a class member
1642 // Since using decls preserve this property, we check this on the
1643 // original decl.
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001644 if (D->isCXXClassMember())
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001645 return false;
1646
1647 // C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3:
1648 // -- a block-scope function declaration that is not a
1649 // using-declaration
1650 // NOTE: we also trigger this for function templates (in fact, we
1651 // don't check the decl type at all, since all other decl types
1652 // turn off ADL anyway).
1653 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D))
1654 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl();
1655 else if (D->getDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod())
1656 return false;
1657
1658 // C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3:
1659 // -- a declaration that is neither a function or a function
1660 // template
1661 // And also for builtin functions.
1662 if (isa<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
1663 FunctionDecl *FDecl = cast<FunctionDecl>(D);
1664
1665 // But also builtin functions.
1666 if (FDecl->getBuiltinID() && FDecl->isImplicit())
1667 return false;
1668 } else if (!isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D))
1669 return false;
1670 }
1671
1672 return true;
1673}
1674
1675
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001676/// Diagnoses obvious problems with the use of the given declaration
1677/// as an expression. This is only actually called for lookups that
1678/// were not overloaded, and it doesn't promise that the declaration
1679/// will in fact be used.
1680static bool CheckDeclInExpr(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, NamedDecl *D) {
1681 if (isa<TypedefDecl>(D)) {
1682 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_unexpected_typedef) << D->getDeclName();
1683 return true;
1684 }
1685
1686 if (isa<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(D)) {
1687 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_unexpected_interface) << D->getDeclName();
1688 return true;
1689 }
1690
1691 if (isa<NamespaceDecl>(D)) {
1692 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_unexpected_namespace) << D->getDeclName();
1693 return true;
1694 }
1695
1696 return false;
1697}
1698
1699Sema::OwningExprResult
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001700Sema::BuildDeclarationNameExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall5b3f9132009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001701 LookupResult &R,
1702 bool NeedsADL) {
John McCallfead20c2009-12-08 22:45:53 +00001703 // If this is a single, fully-resolved result and we don't need ADL,
1704 // just build an ordinary singleton decl ref.
Douglas Gregor86b8e092010-01-29 17:15:43 +00001705 if (!NeedsADL && R.isSingleResult() && !R.getAsSingle<FunctionTemplateDecl>())
John McCall5b3f9132009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001706 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R.getNameLoc(), R.getFoundDecl());
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001707
1708 // We only need to check the declaration if there's exactly one
1709 // result, because in the overloaded case the results can only be
1710 // functions and function templates.
John McCall5b3f9132009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001711 if (R.isSingleResult() &&
1712 CheckDeclInExpr(*this, R.getNameLoc(), R.getFoundDecl()))
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001713 return ExprError();
1714
John McCallc373d482010-01-27 01:50:18 +00001715 // Otherwise, just build an unresolved lookup expression. Suppress
1716 // any lookup-related diagnostics; we'll hash these out later, when
1717 // we've picked a target.
1718 R.suppressDiagnostics();
1719
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001720 bool Dependent
1721 = UnresolvedLookupExpr::ComputeDependence(R.begin(), R.end(), 0);
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001722 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE
John McCallc373d482010-01-27 01:50:18 +00001723 = UnresolvedLookupExpr::Create(Context, Dependent, R.getNamingClass(),
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001724 (NestedNameSpecifier*) SS.getScopeRep(),
1725 SS.getRange(),
John McCall5b3f9132009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001726 R.getLookupName(), R.getNameLoc(),
Douglas Gregor5a84dec2010-05-23 18:57:34 +00001727 NeedsADL, R.isOverloadedResult(),
1728 R.begin(), R.end());
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001729
1730 return Owned(ULE);
1731}
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001732
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001733
1734/// \brief Complete semantic analysis for a reference to the given declaration.
1735Sema::OwningExprResult
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001736Sema::BuildDeclarationNameExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001737 SourceLocation Loc, NamedDecl *D) {
1738 assert(D && "Cannot refer to a NULL declaration");
John McCall7453ed42009-11-22 00:44:51 +00001739 assert(!isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D) &&
1740 "Cannot refer unambiguously to a function template");
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001741
1742 if (CheckDeclInExpr(*this, Loc, D))
1743 return ExprError();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001744
Douglas Gregor9af2f522009-12-01 16:58:18 +00001745 if (TemplateDecl *Template = dyn_cast<TemplateDecl>(D)) {
1746 // Specifically diagnose references to class templates that are missing
1747 // a template argument list.
1748 Diag(Loc, diag::err_template_decl_ref)
1749 << Template << SS.getRange();
1750 Diag(Template->getLocation(), diag::note_template_decl_here);
1751 return ExprError();
1752 }
1753
1754 // Make sure that we're referring to a value.
1755 ValueDecl *VD = dyn_cast<ValueDecl>(D);
1756 if (!VD) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001757 Diag(Loc, diag::err_ref_non_value)
Douglas Gregor9af2f522009-12-01 16:58:18 +00001758 << D << SS.getRange();
John McCall87cf6702009-12-18 18:35:10 +00001759 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_declared_at);
Douglas Gregor9af2f522009-12-01 16:58:18 +00001760 return ExprError();
1761 }
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001762
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +00001763 // Check whether this declaration can be used. Note that we suppress
1764 // this check when we're going to perform argument-dependent lookup
1765 // on this function name, because this might not be the function
1766 // that overload resolution actually selects.
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001767 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(VD, Loc))
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +00001768 return ExprError();
1769
Steve Naroffdd972f22008-09-05 22:11:13 +00001770 // Only create DeclRefExpr's for valid Decl's.
1771 if (VD->isInvalidDecl())
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001772 return ExprError();
1773
Chris Lattner639e2d32008-10-20 05:16:36 +00001774 // If the identifier reference is inside a block, and it refers to a value
1775 // that is outside the block, create a BlockDeclRefExpr instead of a
1776 // DeclRefExpr. This ensures the value is treated as a copy-in snapshot when
1777 // the block is formed.
Steve Naroffdd972f22008-09-05 22:11:13 +00001778 //
Chris Lattner639e2d32008-10-20 05:16:36 +00001779 // We do not do this for things like enum constants, global variables, etc,
1780 // as they do not get snapshotted.
1781 //
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001782 if (getCurBlock() &&
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +00001783 ShouldSnapshotBlockValueReference(*this, getCurBlock(), VD)) {
Mike Stump0d6fd572010-01-05 02:56:35 +00001784 if (VD->getType().getTypePtr()->isVariablyModifiedType()) {
1785 Diag(Loc, diag::err_ref_vm_type);
1786 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_declared_at);
1787 return ExprError();
1788 }
1789
Fariborz Jahanian8596bbe2010-03-16 23:39:51 +00001790 if (VD->getType()->isArrayType()) {
Mike Stump28497342010-01-05 03:10:36 +00001791 Diag(Loc, diag::err_ref_array_type);
1792 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_declared_at);
1793 return ExprError();
1794 }
1795
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00001796 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, VD);
Eli Friedman5fdeae12009-03-22 23:00:19 +00001797 QualType ExprTy = VD->getType().getNonReferenceType();
Steve Naroff090276f2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00001798 // The BlocksAttr indicates the variable is bound by-reference.
Argyrios Kyrtzidis40b598e2009-06-30 02:34:44 +00001799 if (VD->getAttr<BlocksAttr>())
Eli Friedman5fdeae12009-03-22 23:00:19 +00001800 return Owned(new (Context) BlockDeclRefExpr(VD, ExprTy, Loc, true));
Fariborz Jahanian7d5c74e2009-06-19 23:37:08 +00001801 // This is to record that a 'const' was actually synthesize and added.
1802 bool constAdded = !ExprTy.isConstQualified();
Steve Naroff090276f2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00001803 // Variable will be bound by-copy, make it const within the closure.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001804
Eli Friedman5fdeae12009-03-22 23:00:19 +00001805 ExprTy.addConst();
Fariborz Jahanian52bc56a2010-07-12 17:26:57 +00001806 QualType T = VD->getType();
Fariborz Jahanian59da45a2010-06-04 21:35:44 +00001807 BlockDeclRefExpr *BDRE = new (Context) BlockDeclRefExpr(VD,
1808 ExprTy, Loc, false,
Fariborz Jahanian84ca0082010-07-12 18:12:03 +00001809 constAdded);
Fariborz Jahanian833f42e2010-07-09 22:21:32 +00001810 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
1811 if (!T->isDependentType() && !T->isReferenceType()) {
1812 Expr *E = new (Context)
1813 DeclRefExpr(const_cast<ValueDecl*>(BDRE->getDecl()), T,
1814 SourceLocation());
Fariborz Jahanian59da45a2010-06-04 21:35:44 +00001815
Fariborz Jahanian833f42e2010-07-09 22:21:32 +00001816 OwningExprResult Res = PerformCopyInitialization(
1817 InitializedEntity::InitializeBlock(VD->getLocation(),
Fariborz Jahanian310b1c42010-06-07 16:14:00 +00001818 T, false),
Fariborz Jahanian833f42e2010-07-09 22:21:32 +00001819 SourceLocation(),
1820 Owned(E));
1821 if (!Res.isInvalid()) {
1822 Res = MaybeCreateCXXExprWithTemporaries(move(Res));
1823 Expr *Init = Res.takeAs<Expr>();
1824 BDRE->setCopyConstructorExpr(Init);
1825 }
Fariborz Jahanian59da45a2010-06-04 21:35:44 +00001826 }
1827 }
1828 return Owned(BDRE);
Steve Naroff090276f2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00001829 }
1830 // If this reference is not in a block or if the referenced variable is
1831 // within the block, create a normal DeclRefExpr.
Douglas Gregor898574e2008-12-05 23:32:09 +00001832
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001833 return BuildDeclRefExpr(VD, VD->getType().getNonReferenceType(), Loc, &SS);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001834}
1835
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001836Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnPredefinedExpr(SourceLocation Loc,
1837 tok::TokenKind Kind) {
Chris Lattnerd9f69102008-08-10 01:53:14 +00001838 PredefinedExpr::IdentType IT;
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001839
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001840 switch (Kind) {
Chris Lattner1423ea42008-01-12 18:39:25 +00001841 default: assert(0 && "Unknown simple primary expr!");
Chris Lattnerd9f69102008-08-10 01:53:14 +00001842 case tok::kw___func__: IT = PredefinedExpr::Func; break; // [C99 6.4.2.2]
1843 case tok::kw___FUNCTION__: IT = PredefinedExpr::Function; break;
1844 case tok::kw___PRETTY_FUNCTION__: IT = PredefinedExpr::PrettyFunction; break;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001845 }
Chris Lattner1423ea42008-01-12 18:39:25 +00001846
Chris Lattnerfa28b302008-01-12 08:14:25 +00001847 // Pre-defined identifiers are of type char[x], where x is the length of the
1848 // string.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001849
Anders Carlsson3a082d82009-09-08 18:24:21 +00001850 Decl *currentDecl = getCurFunctionOrMethodDecl();
Fariborz Jahanianeb024ac2010-07-23 21:53:24 +00001851 if (!currentDecl && getCurBlock())
1852 currentDecl = getCurBlock()->TheDecl;
Anders Carlsson3a082d82009-09-08 18:24:21 +00001853 if (!currentDecl) {
Chris Lattnerb0da9232008-12-12 05:05:20 +00001854 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_predef_outside_function);
Anders Carlsson3a082d82009-09-08 18:24:21 +00001855 currentDecl = Context.getTranslationUnitDecl();
Chris Lattnerb0da9232008-12-12 05:05:20 +00001856 }
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001857
Anders Carlsson773f3972009-09-11 01:22:35 +00001858 QualType ResTy;
1859 if (cast<DeclContext>(currentDecl)->isDependentContext()) {
1860 ResTy = Context.DependentTy;
1861 } else {
Anders Carlsson848fa642010-02-11 18:20:28 +00001862 unsigned Length = PredefinedExpr::ComputeName(IT, currentDecl).length();
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001863
Anders Carlsson773f3972009-09-11 01:22:35 +00001864 llvm::APInt LengthI(32, Length + 1);
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +00001865 ResTy = Context.CharTy.withConst();
Anders Carlsson773f3972009-09-11 01:22:35 +00001866 ResTy = Context.getConstantArrayType(ResTy, LengthI, ArrayType::Normal, 0);
1867 }
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00001868 return Owned(new (Context) PredefinedExpr(Loc, ResTy, IT));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001869}
1870
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001871Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnCharacterConstant(const Token &Tok) {
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001872 llvm::SmallString<16> CharBuffer;
Douglas Gregor453091c2010-03-16 22:30:13 +00001873 bool Invalid = false;
1874 llvm::StringRef ThisTok = PP.getSpelling(Tok, CharBuffer, &Invalid);
1875 if (Invalid)
1876 return ExprError();
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001877
Benjamin Kramerddeea562010-02-27 13:44:12 +00001878 CharLiteralParser Literal(ThisTok.begin(), ThisTok.end(), Tok.getLocation(),
1879 PP);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001880 if (Literal.hadError())
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001881 return ExprError();
Chris Lattnerfc62bfd2008-03-01 08:32:21 +00001882
Chris Lattnere8337df2009-12-30 21:19:39 +00001883 QualType Ty;
1884 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
1885 Ty = Context.IntTy; // 'x' and L'x' -> int in C.
1886 else if (Literal.isWide())
1887 Ty = Context.WCharTy; // L'x' -> wchar_t in C++.
Eli Friedman136b0cd2010-02-03 18:21:45 +00001888 else if (Literal.isMultiChar())
1889 Ty = Context.IntTy; // 'wxyz' -> int in C++.
Chris Lattnere8337df2009-12-30 21:19:39 +00001890 else
1891 Ty = Context.CharTy; // 'x' -> char in C++
Chris Lattnerfc62bfd2008-03-01 08:32:21 +00001892
Sebastian Redle91b3bc2009-01-20 22:23:13 +00001893 return Owned(new (Context) CharacterLiteral(Literal.getValue(),
1894 Literal.isWide(),
Chris Lattnere8337df2009-12-30 21:19:39 +00001895 Ty, Tok.getLocation()));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001896}
1897
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001898Action::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnNumericConstant(const Token &Tok) {
1899 // Fast path for a single digit (which is quite common). A single digit
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001900 // cannot have a trigraph, escaped newline, radix prefix, or type suffix.
1901 if (Tok.getLength() == 1) {
Chris Lattner7216dc92009-01-26 22:36:52 +00001902 const char Val = PP.getSpellingOfSingleCharacterNumericConstant(Tok);
Chris Lattner0c21e842009-01-16 07:10:29 +00001903 unsigned IntSize = Context.Target.getIntWidth();
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00001904 return Owned(new (Context) IntegerLiteral(llvm::APInt(IntSize, Val-'0'),
Steve Naroff0a473932009-01-20 19:53:53 +00001905 Context.IntTy, Tok.getLocation()));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001906 }
Ted Kremenek28396602009-01-13 23:19:12 +00001907
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001908 llvm::SmallString<512> IntegerBuffer;
Chris Lattner2a299042008-09-30 20:53:45 +00001909 // Add padding so that NumericLiteralParser can overread by one character.
1910 IntegerBuffer.resize(Tok.getLength()+1);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001911 const char *ThisTokBegin = &IntegerBuffer[0];
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001912
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001913 // Get the spelling of the token, which eliminates trigraphs, etc.
Douglas Gregor453091c2010-03-16 22:30:13 +00001914 bool Invalid = false;
1915 unsigned ActualLength = PP.getSpelling(Tok, ThisTokBegin, &Invalid);
1916 if (Invalid)
1917 return ExprError();
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001918
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001919 NumericLiteralParser Literal(ThisTokBegin, ThisTokBegin+ActualLength,
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001920 Tok.getLocation(), PP);
1921 if (Literal.hadError)
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001922 return ExprError();
1923
Chris Lattner5d661452007-08-26 03:42:43 +00001924 Expr *Res;
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001925
Chris Lattner5d661452007-08-26 03:42:43 +00001926 if (Literal.isFloatingLiteral()) {
Chris Lattner525a0502007-09-22 18:29:59 +00001927 QualType Ty;
Chris Lattnerb7cfe882008-06-30 18:32:54 +00001928 if (Literal.isFloat)
Chris Lattner525a0502007-09-22 18:29:59 +00001929 Ty = Context.FloatTy;
Chris Lattnerb7cfe882008-06-30 18:32:54 +00001930 else if (!Literal.isLong)
Chris Lattner525a0502007-09-22 18:29:59 +00001931 Ty = Context.DoubleTy;
Chris Lattnerb7cfe882008-06-30 18:32:54 +00001932 else
Chris Lattner9e9b6dc2008-03-08 08:52:55 +00001933 Ty = Context.LongDoubleTy;
Chris Lattnerb7cfe882008-06-30 18:32:54 +00001934
1935 const llvm::fltSemantics &Format = Context.getFloatTypeSemantics(Ty);
1936
John McCall94c939d2009-12-24 09:08:04 +00001937 using llvm::APFloat;
1938 APFloat Val(Format);
1939
1940 APFloat::opStatus result = Literal.GetFloatValue(Val);
John McCall9f2df882009-12-24 11:09:08 +00001941
1942 // Overflow is always an error, but underflow is only an error if
1943 // we underflowed to zero (APFloat reports denormals as underflow).
1944 if ((result & APFloat::opOverflow) ||
1945 ((result & APFloat::opUnderflow) && Val.isZero())) {
John McCall94c939d2009-12-24 09:08:04 +00001946 unsigned diagnostic;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001947 llvm::SmallString<20> buffer;
John McCall94c939d2009-12-24 09:08:04 +00001948 if (result & APFloat::opOverflow) {
John McCall2a0d7572010-02-26 23:35:57 +00001949 diagnostic = diag::warn_float_overflow;
John McCall94c939d2009-12-24 09:08:04 +00001950 APFloat::getLargest(Format).toString(buffer);
1951 } else {
John McCall2a0d7572010-02-26 23:35:57 +00001952 diagnostic = diag::warn_float_underflow;
John McCall94c939d2009-12-24 09:08:04 +00001953 APFloat::getSmallest(Format).toString(buffer);
1954 }
1955
1956 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diagnostic)
1957 << Ty
1958 << llvm::StringRef(buffer.data(), buffer.size());
1959 }
1960
1961 bool isExact = (result == APFloat::opOK);
Chris Lattner001d64d2009-06-29 17:34:55 +00001962 Res = new (Context) FloatingLiteral(Val, isExact, Ty, Tok.getLocation());
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001963
Chris Lattner5d661452007-08-26 03:42:43 +00001964 } else if (!Literal.isIntegerLiteral()) {
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001965 return ExprError();
Chris Lattner5d661452007-08-26 03:42:43 +00001966 } else {
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001967 QualType Ty;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001968
Neil Boothb9449512007-08-29 22:00:19 +00001969 // long long is a C99 feature.
1970 if (!getLangOptions().C99 && !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus0x &&
Neil Booth79859c32007-08-29 22:13:52 +00001971 Literal.isLongLong)
Neil Boothb9449512007-08-29 22:00:19 +00001972 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::ext_longlong);
1973
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001974 // Get the value in the widest-possible width.
Chris Lattner98be4942008-03-05 18:54:05 +00001975 llvm::APInt ResultVal(Context.Target.getIntMaxTWidth(), 0);
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001976
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001977 if (Literal.GetIntegerValue(ResultVal)) {
1978 // If this value didn't fit into uintmax_t, warn and force to ull.
1979 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::warn_integer_too_large);
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001980 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongLongTy;
1981 assert(Context.getTypeSize(Ty) == ResultVal.getBitWidth() &&
Chris Lattner98be4942008-03-05 18:54:05 +00001982 "long long is not intmax_t?");
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001983 } else {
1984 // If this value fits into a ULL, try to figure out what else it fits into
1985 // according to the rules of C99 6.4.4.1p5.
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001986
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001987 // Octal, Hexadecimal, and integers with a U suffix are allowed to
1988 // be an unsigned int.
1989 bool AllowUnsigned = Literal.isUnsigned || Literal.getRadix() != 10;
1990
1991 // Check from smallest to largest, picking the smallest type we can.
Chris Lattner8cbcb0e2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00001992 unsigned Width = 0;
Chris Lattner97c51562007-08-23 21:58:08 +00001993 if (!Literal.isLong && !Literal.isLongLong) {
1994 // Are int/unsigned possibilities?
Chris Lattner8cbcb0e2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00001995 unsigned IntSize = Context.Target.getIntWidth();
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001996
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001997 // Does it fit in a unsigned int?
1998 if (ResultVal.isIntN(IntSize)) {
1999 // Does it fit in a signed int?
2000 if (!Literal.isUnsigned && ResultVal[IntSize-1] == 0)
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002001 Ty = Context.IntTy;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002002 else if (AllowUnsigned)
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002003 Ty = Context.UnsignedIntTy;
Chris Lattner8cbcb0e2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002004 Width = IntSize;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002005 }
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002006 }
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002007
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002008 // Are long/unsigned long possibilities?
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002009 if (Ty.isNull() && !Literal.isLongLong) {
Chris Lattner8cbcb0e2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002010 unsigned LongSize = Context.Target.getLongWidth();
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002011
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002012 // Does it fit in a unsigned long?
2013 if (ResultVal.isIntN(LongSize)) {
2014 // Does it fit in a signed long?
2015 if (!Literal.isUnsigned && ResultVal[LongSize-1] == 0)
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002016 Ty = Context.LongTy;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002017 else if (AllowUnsigned)
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002018 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongTy;
Chris Lattner8cbcb0e2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002019 Width = LongSize;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002020 }
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002021 }
2022
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002023 // Finally, check long long if needed.
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002024 if (Ty.isNull()) {
Chris Lattner8cbcb0e2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002025 unsigned LongLongSize = Context.Target.getLongLongWidth();
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002026
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002027 // Does it fit in a unsigned long long?
2028 if (ResultVal.isIntN(LongLongSize)) {
2029 // Does it fit in a signed long long?
2030 if (!Literal.isUnsigned && ResultVal[LongLongSize-1] == 0)
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002031 Ty = Context.LongLongTy;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002032 else if (AllowUnsigned)
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002033 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongLongTy;
Chris Lattner8cbcb0e2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002034 Width = LongLongSize;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002035 }
2036 }
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002037
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002038 // If we still couldn't decide a type, we probably have something that
2039 // does not fit in a signed long long, but has no U suffix.
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002040 if (Ty.isNull()) {
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002041 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::warn_integer_too_large_for_signed);
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002042 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongLongTy;
Chris Lattner8cbcb0e2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002043 Width = Context.Target.getLongLongWidth();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002044 }
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002045
Chris Lattner8cbcb0e2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002046 if (ResultVal.getBitWidth() != Width)
2047 ResultVal.trunc(Width);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002048 }
Sebastian Redle91b3bc2009-01-20 22:23:13 +00002049 Res = new (Context) IntegerLiteral(ResultVal, Ty, Tok.getLocation());
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002050 }
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002051
Chris Lattner5d661452007-08-26 03:42:43 +00002052 // If this is an imaginary literal, create the ImaginaryLiteral wrapper.
2053 if (Literal.isImaginary)
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002054 Res = new (Context) ImaginaryLiteral(Res,
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00002055 Context.getComplexType(Res->getType()));
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002056
2057 return Owned(Res);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002058}
2059
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002060Action::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnParenExpr(SourceLocation L,
2061 SourceLocation R, ExprArg Val) {
Anders Carlssone9146f22009-05-01 19:49:17 +00002062 Expr *E = Val.takeAs<Expr>();
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002063 assert((E != 0) && "ActOnParenExpr() missing expr");
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00002064 return Owned(new (Context) ParenExpr(L, R, E));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002065}
2066
2067/// The UsualUnaryConversions() function is *not* called by this routine.
2068/// See C99 6.3.2.1p[2-4] for more details.
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002069bool Sema::CheckSizeOfAlignOfOperand(QualType exprType,
Sebastian Redl05189992008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002070 SourceLocation OpLoc,
2071 const SourceRange &ExprRange,
2072 bool isSizeof) {
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002073 if (exprType->isDependentType())
2074 return false;
2075
Sebastian Redl5d484e82009-11-23 17:18:46 +00002076 // C++ [expr.sizeof]p2: "When applied to a reference or a reference type,
2077 // the result is the size of the referenced type."
2078 // C++ [expr.alignof]p3: "When alignof is applied to a reference type, the
2079 // result shall be the alignment of the referenced type."
2080 if (const ReferenceType *Ref = exprType->getAs<ReferenceType>())
2081 exprType = Ref->getPointeeType();
2082
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002083 // C99 6.5.3.4p1:
John McCall5ab75172009-11-04 07:28:41 +00002084 if (exprType->isFunctionType()) {
Chris Lattner1efaa952009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002085 // alignof(function) is allowed as an extension.
Chris Lattner01072922009-01-24 19:46:37 +00002086 if (isSizeof)
2087 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_sizeof_function_type) << ExprRange;
2088 return false;
2089 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002090
Chris Lattner1efaa952009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002091 // Allow sizeof(void)/alignof(void) as an extension.
Chris Lattner01072922009-01-24 19:46:37 +00002092 if (exprType->isVoidType()) {
Chris Lattnerfa25bbb2008-11-19 05:08:23 +00002093 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_sizeof_void_type)
2094 << (isSizeof ? "sizeof" : "__alignof") << ExprRange;
Chris Lattner01072922009-01-24 19:46:37 +00002095 return false;
2096 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002097
Chris Lattner1efaa952009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002098 if (RequireCompleteType(OpLoc, exprType,
Douglas Gregor5cc07df2009-12-15 16:44:32 +00002099 PDiag(diag::err_sizeof_alignof_incomplete_type)
2100 << int(!isSizeof) << ExprRange))
Chris Lattner1efaa952009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002101 return true;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002102
Chris Lattner1efaa952009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002103 // Reject sizeof(interface) and sizeof(interface<proto>) in 64-bit mode.
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00002104 if (LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI && exprType->isObjCObjectType()) {
Chris Lattner1efaa952009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002105 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_sizeof_nonfragile_interface)
Chris Lattner5cb10d32009-04-24 22:30:50 +00002106 << exprType << isSizeof << ExprRange;
2107 return true;
Chris Lattnerca790922009-04-21 19:55:16 +00002108 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002109
Douglas Gregor9ba6af82010-05-23 19:43:23 +00002110 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(exprType, Context.OverloadTy)) {
2111 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_sizeof_alignof_overloaded_function_type)
2112 << !isSizeof << ExprRange;
2113 return true;
2114 }
2115
Chris Lattner1efaa952009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002116 return false;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002117}
2118
Chris Lattner31e21e02009-01-24 20:17:12 +00002119bool Sema::CheckAlignOfExpr(Expr *E, SourceLocation OpLoc,
2120 const SourceRange &ExprRange) {
2121 E = E->IgnoreParens();
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002122
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002123 // alignof decl is always ok.
Chris Lattner31e21e02009-01-24 20:17:12 +00002124 if (isa<DeclRefExpr>(E))
2125 return false;
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002126
2127 // Cannot know anything else if the expression is dependent.
2128 if (E->isTypeDependent())
2129 return false;
2130
Douglas Gregor33bbbc52009-05-02 02:18:30 +00002131 if (E->getBitField()) {
2132 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_sizeof_alignof_bitfield) << 1 << ExprRange;
2133 return true;
Chris Lattner31e21e02009-01-24 20:17:12 +00002134 }
Douglas Gregor33bbbc52009-05-02 02:18:30 +00002135
2136 // Alignment of a field access is always okay, so long as it isn't a
2137 // bit-field.
2138 if (MemberExpr *ME = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(E))
Mike Stump8e1fab22009-07-22 18:58:19 +00002139 if (isa<FieldDecl>(ME->getMemberDecl()))
Douglas Gregor33bbbc52009-05-02 02:18:30 +00002140 return false;
2141
Chris Lattner31e21e02009-01-24 20:17:12 +00002142 return CheckSizeOfAlignOfOperand(E->getType(), OpLoc, ExprRange, false);
2143}
2144
Douglas Gregorba498172009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002145/// \brief Build a sizeof or alignof expression given a type operand.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002146Action::OwningExprResult
John McCalla93c9342009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002147Sema::CreateSizeOfAlignOfExpr(TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
John McCall5ab75172009-11-04 07:28:41 +00002148 SourceLocation OpLoc,
Douglas Gregorba498172009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002149 bool isSizeOf, SourceRange R) {
John McCalla93c9342009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002150 if (!TInfo)
Douglas Gregorba498172009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002151 return ExprError();
2152
John McCalla93c9342009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002153 QualType T = TInfo->getType();
John McCall5ab75172009-11-04 07:28:41 +00002154
Douglas Gregorba498172009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002155 if (!T->isDependentType() &&
2156 CheckSizeOfAlignOfOperand(T, OpLoc, R, isSizeOf))
2157 return ExprError();
2158
2159 // C99 6.5.3.4p4: the type (an unsigned integer type) is size_t.
John McCalla93c9342009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002160 return Owned(new (Context) SizeOfAlignOfExpr(isSizeOf, TInfo,
Douglas Gregorba498172009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002161 Context.getSizeType(), OpLoc,
2162 R.getEnd()));
2163}
2164
2165/// \brief Build a sizeof or alignof expression given an expression
2166/// operand.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002167Action::OwningExprResult
2168Sema::CreateSizeOfAlignOfExpr(Expr *E, SourceLocation OpLoc,
Douglas Gregorba498172009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002169 bool isSizeOf, SourceRange R) {
2170 // Verify that the operand is valid.
2171 bool isInvalid = false;
2172 if (E->isTypeDependent()) {
2173 // Delay type-checking for type-dependent expressions.
2174 } else if (!isSizeOf) {
2175 isInvalid = CheckAlignOfExpr(E, OpLoc, R);
Douglas Gregor33bbbc52009-05-02 02:18:30 +00002176 } else if (E->getBitField()) { // C99 6.5.3.4p1.
Douglas Gregorba498172009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002177 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_sizeof_alignof_bitfield) << 0;
2178 isInvalid = true;
2179 } else {
2180 isInvalid = CheckSizeOfAlignOfOperand(E->getType(), OpLoc, R, true);
2181 }
2182
2183 if (isInvalid)
2184 return ExprError();
2185
2186 // C99 6.5.3.4p4: the type (an unsigned integer type) is size_t.
2187 return Owned(new (Context) SizeOfAlignOfExpr(isSizeOf, E,
2188 Context.getSizeType(), OpLoc,
2189 R.getEnd()));
2190}
2191
Sebastian Redl05189992008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002192/// ActOnSizeOfAlignOfExpr - Handle @c sizeof(type) and @c sizeof @c expr and
2193/// the same for @c alignof and @c __alignof
2194/// Note that the ArgRange is invalid if isType is false.
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002195Action::OwningExprResult
Sebastian Redl05189992008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002196Sema::ActOnSizeOfAlignOfExpr(SourceLocation OpLoc, bool isSizeof, bool isType,
2197 void *TyOrEx, const SourceRange &ArgRange) {
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002198 // If error parsing type, ignore.
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002199 if (TyOrEx == 0) return ExprError();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002200
Sebastian Redl05189992008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002201 if (isType) {
John McCalla93c9342009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002202 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo;
2203 (void) GetTypeFromParser(TyOrEx, &TInfo);
2204 return CreateSizeOfAlignOfExpr(TInfo, OpLoc, isSizeof, ArgRange);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002205 }
Sebastian Redl05189992008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002206
Douglas Gregorba498172009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002207 Expr *ArgEx = (Expr *)TyOrEx;
2208 Action::OwningExprResult Result
2209 = CreateSizeOfAlignOfExpr(ArgEx, OpLoc, isSizeof, ArgEx->getSourceRange());
2210
2211 if (Result.isInvalid())
2212 DeleteExpr(ArgEx);
2213
2214 return move(Result);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002215}
2216
Chris Lattnerba27e2a2009-02-17 08:12:06 +00002217QualType Sema::CheckRealImagOperand(Expr *&V, SourceLocation Loc, bool isReal) {
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002218 if (V->isTypeDependent())
2219 return Context.DependentTy;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002220
Chris Lattnercc26ed72007-08-26 05:39:26 +00002221 // These operators return the element type of a complex type.
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002222 if (const ComplexType *CT = V->getType()->getAs<ComplexType>())
Chris Lattnerdbb36972007-08-24 21:16:53 +00002223 return CT->getElementType();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002224
Chris Lattnercc26ed72007-08-26 05:39:26 +00002225 // Otherwise they pass through real integer and floating point types here.
2226 if (V->getType()->isArithmeticType())
2227 return V->getType();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002228
Chris Lattnercc26ed72007-08-26 05:39:26 +00002229 // Reject anything else.
Chris Lattnerba27e2a2009-02-17 08:12:06 +00002230 Diag(Loc, diag::err_realimag_invalid_type) << V->getType()
2231 << (isReal ? "__real" : "__imag");
Chris Lattnercc26ed72007-08-26 05:39:26 +00002232 return QualType();
Chris Lattnerdbb36972007-08-24 21:16:53 +00002233}
2234
2235
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002236
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002237Action::OwningExprResult
2238Sema::ActOnPostfixUnaryOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
2239 tok::TokenKind Kind, ExprArg Input) {
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002240 UnaryOperator::Opcode Opc;
2241 switch (Kind) {
2242 default: assert(0 && "Unknown unary op!");
2243 case tok::plusplus: Opc = UnaryOperator::PostInc; break;
2244 case tok::minusminus: Opc = UnaryOperator::PostDec; break;
2245 }
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002246
Eli Friedmane4216e92009-11-18 03:38:04 +00002247 return BuildUnaryOp(S, OpLoc, Opc, move(Input));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002248}
2249
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002250Action::OwningExprResult
2251Sema::ActOnArraySubscriptExpr(Scope *S, ExprArg Base, SourceLocation LLoc,
2252 ExprArg Idx, SourceLocation RLoc) {
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00002253 // Since this might be a postfix expression, get rid of ParenListExprs.
2254 Base = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, move(Base));
2255
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002256 Expr *LHSExp = static_cast<Expr*>(Base.get()),
2257 *RHSExp = static_cast<Expr*>(Idx.get());
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002258
Douglas Gregor337c6b92008-11-19 17:17:41 +00002259 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
Douglas Gregor3384c9c2009-05-19 00:01:19 +00002260 (LHSExp->isTypeDependent() || RHSExp->isTypeDependent())) {
2261 Base.release();
2262 Idx.release();
2263 return Owned(new (Context) ArraySubscriptExpr(LHSExp, RHSExp,
2264 Context.DependentTy, RLoc));
2265 }
2266
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002267 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002268 (LHSExp->getType()->isRecordType() ||
Eli Friedman03f332a2008-12-15 22:34:21 +00002269 LHSExp->getType()->isEnumeralType() ||
2270 RHSExp->getType()->isRecordType() ||
2271 RHSExp->getType()->isEnumeralType())) {
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +00002272 return CreateOverloadedArraySubscriptExpr(LLoc, RLoc, move(Base),move(Idx));
Douglas Gregor337c6b92008-11-19 17:17:41 +00002273 }
2274
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +00002275 return CreateBuiltinArraySubscriptExpr(move(Base), LLoc, move(Idx), RLoc);
2276}
2277
2278
2279Action::OwningExprResult
2280Sema::CreateBuiltinArraySubscriptExpr(ExprArg Base, SourceLocation LLoc,
2281 ExprArg Idx, SourceLocation RLoc) {
2282 Expr *LHSExp = static_cast<Expr*>(Base.get());
2283 Expr *RHSExp = static_cast<Expr*>(Idx.get());
2284
Chris Lattner12d9ff62007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002285 // Perform default conversions.
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +00002286 if (!LHSExp->getType()->getAs<VectorType>())
2287 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(LHSExp);
2288 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(RHSExp);
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002289
Chris Lattner12d9ff62007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002290 QualType LHSTy = LHSExp->getType(), RHSTy = RHSExp->getType();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002291
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002292 // C99 6.5.2.1p2: the expression e1[e2] is by definition precisely equivalent
Chris Lattner73d0d4f2007-08-30 17:45:32 +00002293 // to the expression *((e1)+(e2)). This means the array "Base" may actually be
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002294 // in the subscript position. As a result, we need to derive the array base
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002295 // and index from the expression types.
Chris Lattner12d9ff62007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002296 Expr *BaseExpr, *IndexExpr;
2297 QualType ResultType;
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002298 if (LHSTy->isDependentType() || RHSTy->isDependentType()) {
2299 BaseExpr = LHSExp;
2300 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
2301 ResultType = Context.DependentTy;
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002302 } else if (const PointerType *PTy = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Chris Lattner12d9ff62007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002303 BaseExpr = LHSExp;
2304 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
Chris Lattner12d9ff62007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002305 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002306 } else if (const PointerType *PTy = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Chris Lattner7a2e0472007-07-16 00:23:25 +00002307 // Handle the uncommon case of "123[Ptr]".
Chris Lattner12d9ff62007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002308 BaseExpr = RHSExp;
2309 IndexExpr = LHSExp;
Chris Lattner12d9ff62007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002310 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002311 } else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *PTy =
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002312 LHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002313 BaseExpr = LHSExp;
2314 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
2315 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002316 } else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *PTy =
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002317 RHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002318 // Handle the uncommon case of "123[Ptr]".
2319 BaseExpr = RHSExp;
2320 IndexExpr = LHSExp;
2321 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002322 } else if (const VectorType *VTy = LHSTy->getAs<VectorType>()) {
Chris Lattnerc8629632007-07-31 19:29:30 +00002323 BaseExpr = LHSExp; // vectors: V[123]
Chris Lattner12d9ff62007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002324 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
Nate Begeman334a8022009-01-18 00:45:31 +00002325
Chris Lattner12d9ff62007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002326 // FIXME: need to deal with const...
2327 ResultType = VTy->getElementType();
Eli Friedman7c32f8e2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002328 } else if (LHSTy->isArrayType()) {
2329 // If we see an array that wasn't promoted by
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +00002330 // DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion, it must be an array that
Eli Friedman7c32f8e2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002331 // wasn't promoted because of the C90 rule that doesn't
2332 // allow promoting non-lvalue arrays. Warn, then
2333 // force the promotion here.
2334 Diag(LHSExp->getLocStart(), diag::ext_subscript_non_lvalue) <<
2335 LHSExp->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00002336 ImpCastExprToType(LHSExp, Context.getArrayDecayedType(LHSTy),
2337 CastExpr::CK_ArrayToPointerDecay);
Eli Friedman7c32f8e2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002338 LHSTy = LHSExp->getType();
2339
2340 BaseExpr = LHSExp;
2341 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002342 ResultType = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Eli Friedman7c32f8e2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002343 } else if (RHSTy->isArrayType()) {
2344 // Same as previous, except for 123[f().a] case
2345 Diag(RHSExp->getLocStart(), diag::ext_subscript_non_lvalue) <<
2346 RHSExp->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00002347 ImpCastExprToType(RHSExp, Context.getArrayDecayedType(RHSTy),
2348 CastExpr::CK_ArrayToPointerDecay);
Eli Friedman7c32f8e2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002349 RHSTy = RHSExp->getType();
2350
2351 BaseExpr = RHSExp;
2352 IndexExpr = LHSExp;
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002353 ResultType = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002354 } else {
Chris Lattner338395d2009-04-25 22:50:55 +00002355 return ExprError(Diag(LLoc, diag::err_typecheck_subscript_value)
2356 << LHSExp->getSourceRange() << RHSExp->getSourceRange());
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002357 }
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002358 // C99 6.5.2.1p1
Douglas Gregorf6094622010-07-23 15:58:24 +00002359 if (!IndexExpr->getType()->isIntegerType() && !IndexExpr->isTypeDependent())
Chris Lattner338395d2009-04-25 22:50:55 +00002360 return ExprError(Diag(LLoc, diag::err_typecheck_subscript_not_integer)
2361 << IndexExpr->getSourceRange());
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002362
Daniel Dunbar7e88a602009-09-17 06:31:17 +00002363 if ((IndexExpr->getType()->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Char_S) ||
Sam Weinig0f9a5b52009-09-14 20:14:57 +00002364 IndexExpr->getType()->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Char_U))
2365 && !IndexExpr->isTypeDependent())
Sam Weinig76e2b712009-09-14 01:58:58 +00002366 Diag(LLoc, diag::warn_subscript_is_char) << IndexExpr->getSourceRange();
2367
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00002368 // C99 6.5.2.1p1: "shall have type "pointer to *object* type". Similarly,
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002369 // C++ [expr.sub]p1: The type "T" shall be a completely-defined object
2370 // type. Note that Functions are not objects, and that (in C99 parlance)
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00002371 // incomplete types are not object types.
2372 if (ResultType->isFunctionType()) {
2373 Diag(BaseExpr->getLocStart(), diag::err_subscript_function_type)
2374 << ResultType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
2375 return ExprError();
2376 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002377
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00002378 if (!ResultType->isDependentType() &&
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002379 RequireCompleteType(LLoc, ResultType,
Anders Carlssonb7906612009-08-26 23:45:07 +00002380 PDiag(diag::err_subscript_incomplete_type)
2381 << BaseExpr->getSourceRange()))
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00002382 return ExprError();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002383
Chris Lattner1efaa952009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002384 // Diagnose bad cases where we step over interface counts.
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00002385 if (ResultType->isObjCObjectType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
Chris Lattner1efaa952009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002386 Diag(LLoc, diag::err_subscript_nonfragile_interface)
2387 << ResultType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
2388 return ExprError();
2389 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002390
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002391 Base.release();
2392 Idx.release();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002393 return Owned(new (Context) ArraySubscriptExpr(LHSExp, RHSExp,
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00002394 ResultType, RLoc));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002395}
2396
Steve Naroffe1b31fe2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002397QualType Sema::
Nate Begeman213541a2008-04-18 23:10:10 +00002398CheckExtVectorComponent(QualType baseType, SourceLocation OpLoc,
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002399 const IdentifierInfo *CompName,
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002400 SourceLocation CompLoc) {
Daniel Dunbar2ad32892009-10-18 02:09:38 +00002401 // FIXME: Share logic with ExtVectorElementExpr::containsDuplicateElements,
2402 // see FIXME there.
2403 //
2404 // FIXME: This logic can be greatly simplified by splitting it along
2405 // halving/not halving and reworking the component checking.
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002406 const ExtVectorType *vecType = baseType->getAs<ExtVectorType>();
Nate Begeman8a997642008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002407
Steve Naroffe1b31fe2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002408 // The vector accessor can't exceed the number of elements.
Daniel Dunbare013d682009-10-18 20:26:12 +00002409 const char *compStr = CompName->getNameStart();
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002410
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002411 // This flag determines whether or not the component is one of the four
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002412 // special names that indicate a subset of exactly half the elements are
2413 // to be selected.
2414 bool HalvingSwizzle = false;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002415
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002416 // This flag determines whether or not CompName has an 's' char prefix,
2417 // indicating that it is a string of hex values to be used as vector indices.
Nate Begeman131f4652009-06-25 21:06:09 +00002418 bool HexSwizzle = *compStr == 's' || *compStr == 'S';
Nate Begeman8a997642008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002419
2420 // Check that we've found one of the special components, or that the component
2421 // names must come from the same set.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002422 if (!strcmp(compStr, "hi") || !strcmp(compStr, "lo") ||
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002423 !strcmp(compStr, "even") || !strcmp(compStr, "odd")) {
2424 HalvingSwizzle = true;
Nate Begeman8a997642008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002425 } else if (vecType->getPointAccessorIdx(*compStr) != -1) {
Chris Lattner88dca042007-08-02 22:33:49 +00002426 do
2427 compStr++;
2428 while (*compStr && vecType->getPointAccessorIdx(*compStr) != -1);
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002429 } else if (HexSwizzle || vecType->getNumericAccessorIdx(*compStr) != -1) {
Chris Lattner88dca042007-08-02 22:33:49 +00002430 do
2431 compStr++;
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002432 while (*compStr && vecType->getNumericAccessorIdx(*compStr) != -1);
Chris Lattner88dca042007-08-02 22:33:49 +00002433 }
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002434
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002435 if (!HalvingSwizzle && *compStr) {
Steve Naroffe1b31fe2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002436 // We didn't get to the end of the string. This means the component names
2437 // didn't come from the same set *or* we encountered an illegal name.
Chris Lattnerfa25bbb2008-11-19 05:08:23 +00002438 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ext_vector_component_name_illegal)
2439 << std::string(compStr,compStr+1) << SourceRange(CompLoc);
Steve Naroffe1b31fe2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002440 return QualType();
2441 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002442
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002443 // Ensure no component accessor exceeds the width of the vector type it
2444 // operates on.
2445 if (!HalvingSwizzle) {
Daniel Dunbare013d682009-10-18 20:26:12 +00002446 compStr = CompName->getNameStart();
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002447
2448 if (HexSwizzle)
Steve Naroffe1b31fe2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002449 compStr++;
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002450
2451 while (*compStr) {
2452 if (!vecType->isAccessorWithinNumElements(*compStr++)) {
2453 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ext_vector_component_exceeds_length)
2454 << baseType << SourceRange(CompLoc);
2455 return QualType();
2456 }
2457 }
Steve Naroffe1b31fe2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002458 }
Nate Begeman8a997642008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002459
Steve Naroffe1b31fe2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002460 // The component accessor looks fine - now we need to compute the actual type.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002461 // The vector type is implied by the component accessor. For example,
Steve Naroffe1b31fe2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002462 // vec4.b is a float, vec4.xy is a vec2, vec4.rgb is a vec3, etc.
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002463 // vec4.s0 is a float, vec4.s23 is a vec3, etc.
Nate Begeman8a997642008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002464 // vec4.hi, vec4.lo, vec4.e, and vec4.o all return vec2.
Nate Begeman0479a0b2009-12-15 18:13:04 +00002465 unsigned CompSize = HalvingSwizzle ? (vecType->getNumElements() + 1) / 2
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002466 : CompName->getLength();
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002467 if (HexSwizzle)
2468 CompSize--;
2469
Steve Naroffe1b31fe2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002470 if (CompSize == 1)
2471 return vecType->getElementType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002472
Nate Begeman213541a2008-04-18 23:10:10 +00002473 QualType VT = Context.getExtVectorType(vecType->getElementType(), CompSize);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002474 // Now look up the TypeDefDecl from the vector type. Without this,
Nate Begeman213541a2008-04-18 23:10:10 +00002475 // diagostics look bad. We want extended vector types to appear built-in.
2476 for (unsigned i = 0, E = ExtVectorDecls.size(); i != E; ++i) {
2477 if (ExtVectorDecls[i]->getUnderlyingType() == VT)
2478 return Context.getTypedefType(ExtVectorDecls[i]);
Steve Naroffbea0b342007-07-29 16:33:31 +00002479 }
2480 return VT; // should never get here (a typedef type should always be found).
Steve Naroffe1b31fe2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002481}
2482
Fariborz Jahanian2ce1be02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002483static Decl *FindGetterNameDeclFromProtocolList(const ObjCProtocolDecl*PDecl,
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002484 IdentifierInfo *Member,
Douglas Gregor6ab35242009-04-09 21:40:53 +00002485 const Selector &Sel,
2486 ASTContext &Context) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002487
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002488 if (ObjCPropertyDecl *PD = PDecl->FindPropertyDeclaration(Member))
Fariborz Jahanian2ce1be02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002489 return PD;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis17945a02009-06-30 02:36:12 +00002490 if (ObjCMethodDecl *OMD = PDecl->getInstanceMethod(Sel))
Fariborz Jahanian2ce1be02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002491 return OMD;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002492
Fariborz Jahanian2ce1be02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002493 for (ObjCProtocolDecl::protocol_iterator I = PDecl->protocol_begin(),
2494 E = PDecl->protocol_end(); I != E; ++I) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002495 if (Decl *D = FindGetterNameDeclFromProtocolList(*I, Member, Sel,
Douglas Gregor6ab35242009-04-09 21:40:53 +00002496 Context))
Fariborz Jahanian2ce1be02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002497 return D;
2498 }
2499 return 0;
2500}
2501
Steve Naroffd1b3c2d2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00002502static Decl *FindGetterNameDecl(const ObjCObjectPointerType *QIdTy,
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002503 IdentifierInfo *Member,
Douglas Gregor6ab35242009-04-09 21:40:53 +00002504 const Selector &Sel,
2505 ASTContext &Context) {
Fariborz Jahanian2ce1be02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002506 // Check protocols on qualified interfaces.
2507 Decl *GDecl = 0;
Steve Naroffd1b3c2d2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00002508 for (ObjCObjectPointerType::qual_iterator I = QIdTy->qual_begin(),
Fariborz Jahanian2ce1be02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002509 E = QIdTy->qual_end(); I != E; ++I) {
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002510 if (ObjCPropertyDecl *PD = (*I)->FindPropertyDeclaration(Member)) {
Fariborz Jahanian2ce1be02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002511 GDecl = PD;
2512 break;
2513 }
2514 // Also must look for a getter name which uses property syntax.
Argyrios Kyrtzidis17945a02009-06-30 02:36:12 +00002515 if (ObjCMethodDecl *OMD = (*I)->getInstanceMethod(Sel)) {
Fariborz Jahanian2ce1be02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002516 GDecl = OMD;
2517 break;
2518 }
2519 }
2520 if (!GDecl) {
Steve Naroffd1b3c2d2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00002521 for (ObjCObjectPointerType::qual_iterator I = QIdTy->qual_begin(),
Fariborz Jahanian2ce1be02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002522 E = QIdTy->qual_end(); I != E; ++I) {
2523 // Search in the protocol-qualifier list of current protocol.
Douglas Gregor6ab35242009-04-09 21:40:53 +00002524 GDecl = FindGetterNameDeclFromProtocolList(*I, Member, Sel, Context);
Fariborz Jahanian2ce1be02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002525 if (GDecl)
2526 return GDecl;
2527 }
2528 }
2529 return GDecl;
2530}
Chris Lattner76a642f2009-02-15 22:43:40 +00002531
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002532Sema::OwningExprResult
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002533Sema::ActOnDependentMemberExpr(ExprArg Base, QualType BaseType,
2534 bool IsArrow, SourceLocation OpLoc,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002535 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
2536 NamedDecl *FirstQualifierInScope,
2537 DeclarationName Name, SourceLocation NameLoc,
2538 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs) {
2539 Expr *BaseExpr = Base.takeAs<Expr>();
2540
2541 // Even in dependent contexts, try to diagnose base expressions with
2542 // obviously wrong types, e.g.:
2543 //
2544 // T* t;
2545 // t.f;
2546 //
2547 // In Obj-C++, however, the above expression is valid, since it could be
2548 // accessing the 'f' property if T is an Obj-C interface. The extra check
2549 // allows this, while still reporting an error if T is a struct pointer.
2550 if (!IsArrow) {
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002551 const PointerType *PT = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>();
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002552 if (PT && (!getLangOptions().ObjC1 ||
2553 PT->getPointeeType()->isRecordType())) {
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002554 assert(BaseExpr && "cannot happen with implicit member accesses");
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002555 Diag(NameLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_struct_union)
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002556 << BaseType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002557 return ExprError();
2558 }
2559 }
2560
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00002561 assert(BaseType->isDependentType() || Name.isDependentName() ||
Douglas Gregor01e56ae2010-04-12 20:54:26 +00002562 isDependentScopeSpecifier(SS));
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002563
2564 // Get the type being accessed in BaseType. If this is an arrow, the BaseExpr
2565 // must have pointer type, and the accessed type is the pointee.
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002566 return Owned(CXXDependentScopeMemberExpr::Create(Context, BaseExpr, BaseType,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002567 IsArrow, OpLoc,
2568 static_cast<NestedNameSpecifier*>(SS.getScopeRep()),
2569 SS.getRange(),
2570 FirstQualifierInScope,
2571 Name, NameLoc,
2572 TemplateArgs));
2573}
2574
2575/// We know that the given qualified member reference points only to
2576/// declarations which do not belong to the static type of the base
2577/// expression. Diagnose the problem.
2578static void DiagnoseQualifiedMemberReference(Sema &SemaRef,
2579 Expr *BaseExpr,
2580 QualType BaseType,
John McCall2f841ba2009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002581 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002582 const LookupResult &R) {
John McCall2f841ba2009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002583 // If this is an implicit member access, use a different set of
2584 // diagnostics.
2585 if (!BaseExpr)
2586 return DiagnoseInstanceReference(SemaRef, SS, R);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002587
John McCall110acc12010-04-27 01:43:38 +00002588 SemaRef.Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_qualified_member_of_unrelated)
2589 << SS.getRange() << R.getRepresentativeDecl() << BaseType;
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002590}
2591
2592// Check whether the declarations we found through a nested-name
2593// specifier in a member expression are actually members of the base
2594// type. The restriction here is:
2595//
2596// C++ [expr.ref]p2:
2597// ... In these cases, the id-expression shall name a
2598// member of the class or of one of its base classes.
2599//
2600// So it's perfectly legitimate for the nested-name specifier to name
2601// an unrelated class, and for us to find an overload set including
2602// decls from classes which are not superclasses, as long as the decl
2603// we actually pick through overload resolution is from a superclass.
2604bool Sema::CheckQualifiedMemberReference(Expr *BaseExpr,
2605 QualType BaseType,
John McCall2f841ba2009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002606 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002607 const LookupResult &R) {
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002608 const RecordType *BaseRT = BaseType->getAs<RecordType>();
2609 if (!BaseRT) {
2610 // We can't check this yet because the base type is still
2611 // dependent.
2612 assert(BaseType->isDependentType());
2613 return false;
2614 }
2615 CXXRecordDecl *BaseRecord = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(BaseRT->getDecl());
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002616
2617 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I) {
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002618 // If this is an implicit member reference and we find a
2619 // non-instance member, it's not an error.
John McCall161755a2010-04-06 21:38:20 +00002620 if (!BaseExpr && !(*I)->isCXXInstanceMember())
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002621 return false;
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002622
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002623 // Note that we use the DC of the decl, not the underlying decl.
Eli Friedman02463762010-07-27 20:51:02 +00002624 DeclContext *DC = (*I)->getDeclContext();
2625 while (DC->isTransparentContext())
2626 DC = DC->getParent();
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002627
Douglas Gregor9d4bb942010-07-28 22:27:52 +00002628 if (!DC->isRecord())
2629 continue;
2630
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002631 llvm::SmallPtrSet<CXXRecordDecl*,4> MemberRecord;
Eli Friedman02463762010-07-27 20:51:02 +00002632 MemberRecord.insert(cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DC)->getCanonicalDecl());
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002633
2634 if (!IsProvablyNotDerivedFrom(*this, BaseRecord, MemberRecord))
2635 return false;
2636 }
2637
John McCall2f841ba2009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002638 DiagnoseQualifiedMemberReference(*this, BaseExpr, BaseType, SS, R);
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002639 return true;
2640}
2641
2642static bool
2643LookupMemberExprInRecord(Sema &SemaRef, LookupResult &R,
2644 SourceRange BaseRange, const RecordType *RTy,
John McCallad00b772010-06-16 08:42:20 +00002645 SourceLocation OpLoc, CXXScopeSpec &SS,
2646 bool HasTemplateArgs) {
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002647 RecordDecl *RDecl = RTy->getDecl();
2648 if (SemaRef.RequireCompleteType(OpLoc, QualType(RTy, 0),
Douglas Gregorfe6b2d42010-03-29 23:34:08 +00002649 SemaRef.PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_incomplete_tag)
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002650 << BaseRange))
2651 return true;
2652
John McCallad00b772010-06-16 08:42:20 +00002653 if (HasTemplateArgs) {
2654 // LookupTemplateName doesn't expect these both to exist simultaneously.
2655 QualType ObjectType = SS.isSet() ? QualType() : QualType(RTy, 0);
2656
2657 bool MOUS;
2658 SemaRef.LookupTemplateName(R, 0, SS, ObjectType, false, MOUS);
2659 return false;
2660 }
2661
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002662 DeclContext *DC = RDecl;
2663 if (SS.isSet()) {
2664 // If the member name was a qualified-id, look into the
2665 // nested-name-specifier.
2666 DC = SemaRef.computeDeclContext(SS, false);
2667
John McCall77bb1aa2010-05-01 00:40:08 +00002668 if (SemaRef.RequireCompleteDeclContext(SS, DC)) {
John McCall2f841ba2009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002669 SemaRef.Diag(SS.getRange().getEnd(), diag::err_typecheck_incomplete_tag)
2670 << SS.getRange() << DC;
2671 return true;
2672 }
2673
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002674 assert(DC && "Cannot handle non-computable dependent contexts in lookup");
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002675
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002676 if (!isa<TypeDecl>(DC)) {
2677 SemaRef.Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_qualified_member_nonclass)
2678 << DC << SS.getRange();
2679 return true;
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002680 }
2681 }
2682
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002683 // The record definition is complete, now look up the member.
2684 SemaRef.LookupQualifiedName(R, DC);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002685
Douglas Gregor2dcc0112009-12-31 07:42:17 +00002686 if (!R.empty())
2687 return false;
2688
2689 // We didn't find anything with the given name, so try to correct
2690 // for typos.
2691 DeclarationName Name = R.getLookupName();
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00002692 if (SemaRef.CorrectTypo(R, 0, &SS, DC, false, Sema::CTC_MemberLookup) &&
Douglas Gregoraaf87162010-04-14 20:04:41 +00002693 !R.empty() &&
Douglas Gregor2dcc0112009-12-31 07:42:17 +00002694 (isa<ValueDecl>(*R.begin()) || isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(*R.begin()))) {
2695 SemaRef.Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member_suggest)
2696 << Name << DC << R.getLookupName() << SS.getRange()
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00002697 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(R.getNameLoc(),
2698 R.getLookupName().getAsString());
Douglas Gregor67dd1d42010-01-07 00:17:44 +00002699 if (NamedDecl *ND = R.getAsSingle<NamedDecl>())
2700 SemaRef.Diag(ND->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
2701 << ND->getDeclName();
Douglas Gregor2dcc0112009-12-31 07:42:17 +00002702 return false;
2703 } else {
2704 R.clear();
Douglas Gregor12eb5d62010-06-29 19:27:42 +00002705 R.setLookupName(Name);
Douglas Gregor2dcc0112009-12-31 07:42:17 +00002706 }
2707
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002708 return false;
2709}
2710
2711Sema::OwningExprResult
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002712Sema::BuildMemberReferenceExpr(ExprArg BaseArg, QualType BaseType,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002713 SourceLocation OpLoc, bool IsArrow,
Jeffrey Yasskin9ab14542010-04-08 16:38:48 +00002714 CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002715 NamedDecl *FirstQualifierInScope,
2716 DeclarationName Name, SourceLocation NameLoc,
2717 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs) {
2718 Expr *Base = BaseArg.takeAs<Expr>();
2719
John McCall2f841ba2009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002720 if (BaseType->isDependentType() ||
2721 (SS.isSet() && isDependentScopeSpecifier(SS)))
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002722 return ActOnDependentMemberExpr(ExprArg(*this, Base), BaseType,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002723 IsArrow, OpLoc,
2724 SS, FirstQualifierInScope,
2725 Name, NameLoc,
2726 TemplateArgs);
2727
2728 LookupResult R(*this, Name, NameLoc, LookupMemberName);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002729
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002730 // Implicit member accesses.
2731 if (!Base) {
2732 QualType RecordTy = BaseType;
2733 if (IsArrow) RecordTy = RecordTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
2734 if (LookupMemberExprInRecord(*this, R, SourceRange(),
2735 RecordTy->getAs<RecordType>(),
John McCallad00b772010-06-16 08:42:20 +00002736 OpLoc, SS, TemplateArgs != 0))
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002737 return ExprError();
2738
2739 // Explicit member accesses.
2740 } else {
2741 OwningExprResult Result =
2742 LookupMemberExpr(R, Base, IsArrow, OpLoc,
John McCallad00b772010-06-16 08:42:20 +00002743 SS, /*ObjCImpDecl*/ DeclPtrTy(), TemplateArgs != 0);
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002744
2745 if (Result.isInvalid()) {
2746 Owned(Base);
2747 return ExprError();
2748 }
2749
2750 if (Result.get())
2751 return move(Result);
Sebastian Redlf3e63372010-05-07 09:25:11 +00002752
2753 // LookupMemberExpr can modify Base, and thus change BaseType
2754 BaseType = Base->getType();
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002755 }
2756
Sebastian Redl0aa866f2010-05-07 09:09:23 +00002757 return BuildMemberReferenceExpr(ExprArg(*this, Base), BaseType,
John McCallc2233c52010-01-15 08:34:02 +00002758 OpLoc, IsArrow, SS, FirstQualifierInScope,
2759 R, TemplateArgs);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002760}
2761
2762Sema::OwningExprResult
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002763Sema::BuildMemberReferenceExpr(ExprArg Base, QualType BaseExprType,
2764 SourceLocation OpLoc, bool IsArrow,
2765 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCallc2233c52010-01-15 08:34:02 +00002766 NamedDecl *FirstQualifierInScope,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002767 LookupResult &R,
Douglas Gregor06a9f362010-05-01 20:49:11 +00002768 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs,
2769 bool SuppressQualifierCheck) {
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002770 Expr *BaseExpr = Base.takeAs<Expr>();
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002771 QualType BaseType = BaseExprType;
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002772 if (IsArrow) {
2773 assert(BaseType->isPointerType());
2774 BaseType = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
2775 }
John McCall161755a2010-04-06 21:38:20 +00002776 R.setBaseObjectType(BaseType);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002777
2778 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier =
2779 static_cast<NestedNameSpecifier*>(SS.getScopeRep());
2780 DeclarationName MemberName = R.getLookupName();
2781 SourceLocation MemberLoc = R.getNameLoc();
2782
2783 if (R.isAmbiguous())
Douglas Gregorfe85ced2009-08-06 03:17:00 +00002784 return ExprError();
2785
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002786 if (R.empty()) {
2787 // Rederive where we looked up.
2788 DeclContext *DC = (SS.isSet()
2789 ? computeDeclContext(SS, false)
2790 : BaseType->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl());
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00002791
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002792 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member)
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002793 << MemberName << DC
2794 << (BaseExpr ? BaseExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange());
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002795 return ExprError();
2796 }
2797
John McCallc2233c52010-01-15 08:34:02 +00002798 // Diagnose lookups that find only declarations from a non-base
2799 // type. This is possible for either qualified lookups (which may
2800 // have been qualified with an unrelated type) or implicit member
2801 // expressions (which were found with unqualified lookup and thus
2802 // may have come from an enclosing scope). Note that it's okay for
2803 // lookup to find declarations from a non-base type as long as those
2804 // aren't the ones picked by overload resolution.
2805 if ((SS.isSet() || !BaseExpr ||
2806 (isa<CXXThisExpr>(BaseExpr) &&
2807 cast<CXXThisExpr>(BaseExpr)->isImplicit())) &&
Douglas Gregor06a9f362010-05-01 20:49:11 +00002808 !SuppressQualifierCheck &&
John McCallc2233c52010-01-15 08:34:02 +00002809 CheckQualifiedMemberReference(BaseExpr, BaseType, SS, R))
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002810 return ExprError();
2811
2812 // Construct an unresolved result if we in fact got an unresolved
2813 // result.
2814 if (R.isOverloadedResult() || R.isUnresolvableResult()) {
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002815 bool Dependent =
John McCall410a3f32009-12-19 02:05:44 +00002816 BaseExprType->isDependentType() ||
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002817 R.isUnresolvableResult() ||
John McCall7bb12da2010-02-02 06:20:04 +00002818 OverloadExpr::ComputeDependence(R.begin(), R.end(), TemplateArgs);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002819
John McCallc373d482010-01-27 01:50:18 +00002820 // Suppress any lookup-related diagnostics; we'll do these when we
2821 // pick a member.
2822 R.suppressDiagnostics();
2823
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002824 UnresolvedMemberExpr *MemExpr
2825 = UnresolvedMemberExpr::Create(Context, Dependent,
2826 R.isUnresolvableResult(),
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002827 BaseExpr, BaseExprType,
2828 IsArrow, OpLoc,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002829 Qualifier, SS.getRange(),
2830 MemberName, MemberLoc,
Douglas Gregor5a84dec2010-05-23 18:57:34 +00002831 TemplateArgs, R.begin(), R.end());
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002832
2833 return Owned(MemExpr);
2834 }
2835
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002836 assert(R.isSingleResult());
John McCall161755a2010-04-06 21:38:20 +00002837 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = R.begin().getPair();
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002838 NamedDecl *MemberDecl = R.getFoundDecl();
2839
2840 // FIXME: diagnose the presence of template arguments now.
2841
2842 // If the decl being referenced had an error, return an error for this
2843 // sub-expr without emitting another error, in order to avoid cascading
2844 // error cases.
2845 if (MemberDecl->isInvalidDecl())
2846 return ExprError();
2847
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002848 // Handle the implicit-member-access case.
2849 if (!BaseExpr) {
2850 // If this is not an instance member, convert to a non-member access.
John McCall161755a2010-04-06 21:38:20 +00002851 if (!MemberDecl->isCXXInstanceMember())
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002852 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R.getNameLoc(), MemberDecl);
2853
Douglas Gregor828a1972010-01-07 23:12:05 +00002854 SourceLocation Loc = R.getNameLoc();
2855 if (SS.getRange().isValid())
2856 Loc = SS.getRange().getBegin();
2857 BaseExpr = new (Context) CXXThisExpr(Loc, BaseExprType,/*isImplicit=*/true);
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002858 }
2859
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002860 bool ShouldCheckUse = true;
2861 if (CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
2862 // Don't diagnose the use of a virtual member function unless it's
2863 // explicitly qualified.
2864 if (MD->isVirtual() && !SS.isSet())
2865 ShouldCheckUse = false;
2866 }
2867
2868 // Check the use of this member.
2869 if (ShouldCheckUse && DiagnoseUseOfDecl(MemberDecl, MemberLoc)) {
2870 Owned(BaseExpr);
2871 return ExprError();
2872 }
2873
2874 if (FieldDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
2875 // We may have found a field within an anonymous union or struct
2876 // (C++ [class.union]).
Eli Friedman16c53782009-12-04 07:18:51 +00002877 if (cast<RecordDecl>(FD->getDeclContext())->isAnonymousStructOrUnion() &&
2878 !BaseType->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl()->isAnonymousStructOrUnion())
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002879 return BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(MemberLoc, FD,
2880 BaseExpr, OpLoc);
2881
2882 // Figure out the type of the member; see C99 6.5.2.3p3, C++ [expr.ref]
2883 QualType MemberType = FD->getType();
2884 if (const ReferenceType *Ref = MemberType->getAs<ReferenceType>())
2885 MemberType = Ref->getPointeeType();
2886 else {
2887 Qualifiers BaseQuals = BaseType.getQualifiers();
2888 BaseQuals.removeObjCGCAttr();
2889 if (FD->isMutable()) BaseQuals.removeConst();
2890
2891 Qualifiers MemberQuals
2892 = Context.getCanonicalType(MemberType).getQualifiers();
2893
2894 Qualifiers Combined = BaseQuals + MemberQuals;
2895 if (Combined != MemberQuals)
2896 MemberType = Context.getQualifiedType(MemberType, Combined);
2897 }
2898
2899 MarkDeclarationReferenced(MemberLoc, FD);
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00002900 if (PerformObjectMemberConversion(BaseExpr, Qualifier, FoundDecl, FD))
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002901 return ExprError();
2902 return Owned(BuildMemberExpr(Context, BaseExpr, IsArrow, SS,
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00002903 FD, FoundDecl, MemberLoc, MemberType));
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002904 }
2905
2906 if (VarDecl *Var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
2907 MarkDeclarationReferenced(MemberLoc, Var);
2908 return Owned(BuildMemberExpr(Context, BaseExpr, IsArrow, SS,
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00002909 Var, FoundDecl, MemberLoc,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002910 Var->getType().getNonReferenceType()));
2911 }
2912
2913 if (FunctionDecl *MemberFn = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
2914 MarkDeclarationReferenced(MemberLoc, MemberDecl);
2915 return Owned(BuildMemberExpr(Context, BaseExpr, IsArrow, SS,
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00002916 MemberFn, FoundDecl, MemberLoc,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002917 MemberFn->getType()));
2918 }
2919
2920 if (EnumConstantDecl *Enum = dyn_cast<EnumConstantDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
2921 MarkDeclarationReferenced(MemberLoc, MemberDecl);
2922 return Owned(BuildMemberExpr(Context, BaseExpr, IsArrow, SS,
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00002923 Enum, FoundDecl, MemberLoc, Enum->getType()));
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002924 }
2925
2926 Owned(BaseExpr);
2927
Douglas Gregorb0fd4832010-04-25 20:55:08 +00002928 // We found something that we didn't expect. Complain.
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002929 if (isa<TypeDecl>(MemberDecl))
Douglas Gregorb0fd4832010-04-25 20:55:08 +00002930 Diag(MemberLoc,diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_type)
2931 << MemberName << BaseType << int(IsArrow);
2932 else
2933 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_unknown)
2934 << MemberName << BaseType << int(IsArrow);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002935
Douglas Gregorb0fd4832010-04-25 20:55:08 +00002936 Diag(MemberDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_member_declared_here)
2937 << MemberName;
Douglas Gregor2b147f02010-04-25 21:15:30 +00002938 R.suppressDiagnostics();
Douglas Gregorb0fd4832010-04-25 20:55:08 +00002939 return ExprError();
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002940}
2941
2942/// Look up the given member of the given non-type-dependent
2943/// expression. This can return in one of two ways:
2944/// * If it returns a sentinel null-but-valid result, the caller will
2945/// assume that lookup was performed and the results written into
2946/// the provided structure. It will take over from there.
2947/// * Otherwise, the returned expression will be produced in place of
2948/// an ordinary member expression.
2949///
2950/// The ObjCImpDecl bit is a gross hack that will need to be properly
2951/// fixed for ObjC++.
2952Sema::OwningExprResult
2953Sema::LookupMemberExpr(LookupResult &R, Expr *&BaseExpr,
John McCall812c1542009-12-07 22:46:59 +00002954 bool &IsArrow, SourceLocation OpLoc,
Jeffrey Yasskin9ab14542010-04-08 16:38:48 +00002955 CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCallad00b772010-06-16 08:42:20 +00002956 DeclPtrTy ObjCImpDecl, bool HasTemplateArgs) {
Douglas Gregora71d8192009-09-04 17:36:40 +00002957 assert(BaseExpr && "no base expression");
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002958
Steve Naroff3cc4af82007-12-16 21:42:28 +00002959 // Perform default conversions.
2960 DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(BaseExpr);
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002961
Steve Naroffdfa6aae2007-07-26 03:11:44 +00002962 QualType BaseType = BaseExpr->getType();
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002963 assert(!BaseType->isDependentType());
2964
2965 DeclarationName MemberName = R.getLookupName();
2966 SourceLocation MemberLoc = R.getNameLoc();
Douglas Gregor3f0b5fd2009-11-06 06:30:47 +00002967
2968 // If the user is trying to apply -> or . to a function pointer
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002969 // type, it's probably because they forgot parentheses to call that
Douglas Gregor3f0b5fd2009-11-06 06:30:47 +00002970 // function. Suggest the addition of those parentheses, build the
2971 // call, and continue on.
2972 if (const PointerType *Ptr = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
2973 if (const FunctionProtoType *Fun
2974 = Ptr->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) {
2975 QualType ResultTy = Fun->getResultType();
2976 if (Fun->getNumArgs() == 0 &&
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002977 ((!IsArrow && ResultTy->isRecordType()) ||
2978 (IsArrow && ResultTy->isPointerType() &&
Douglas Gregor3f0b5fd2009-11-06 06:30:47 +00002979 ResultTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()
2980 ->isRecordType()))) {
2981 SourceLocation Loc = PP.getLocForEndOfToken(BaseExpr->getLocEnd());
2982 Diag(Loc, diag::err_member_reference_needs_call)
2983 << QualType(Fun, 0)
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00002984 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Loc, "()");
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002985
Douglas Gregor3f0b5fd2009-11-06 06:30:47 +00002986 OwningExprResult NewBase
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002987 = ActOnCallExpr(0, ExprArg(*this, BaseExpr), Loc,
Douglas Gregor3f0b5fd2009-11-06 06:30:47 +00002988 MultiExprArg(*this, 0, 0), 0, Loc);
Douglas Gregorf918b832010-06-21 22:46:46 +00002989 BaseExpr = 0;
Douglas Gregor3f0b5fd2009-11-06 06:30:47 +00002990 if (NewBase.isInvalid())
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002991 return ExprError();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002992
Douglas Gregor3f0b5fd2009-11-06 06:30:47 +00002993 BaseExpr = NewBase.takeAs<Expr>();
2994 DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(BaseExpr);
2995 BaseType = BaseExpr->getType();
2996 }
2997 }
2998 }
2999
David Chisnall0f436562009-08-17 16:35:33 +00003000 // If this is an Objective-C pseudo-builtin and a definition is provided then
3001 // use that.
3002 if (BaseType->isObjCIdType()) {
Fariborz Jahanian6d910f02009-12-07 20:09:25 +00003003 if (IsArrow) {
3004 // Handle the following exceptional case PObj->isa.
3005 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT =
3006 BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003007 if (OPT->getObjectType()->isObjCId() &&
Fariborz Jahanian6d910f02009-12-07 20:09:25 +00003008 MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo()->isStr("isa"))
Fariborz Jahanian83dc3252009-12-09 19:05:56 +00003009 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCIsaExpr(BaseExpr, true, MemberLoc,
3010 Context.getObjCClassType()));
Fariborz Jahanian6d910f02009-12-07 20:09:25 +00003011 }
3012 }
David Chisnall0f436562009-08-17 16:35:33 +00003013 // We have an 'id' type. Rather than fall through, we check if this
3014 // is a reference to 'isa'.
3015 if (BaseType != Context.ObjCIdRedefinitionType) {
3016 BaseType = Context.ObjCIdRedefinitionType;
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00003017 ImpCastExprToType(BaseExpr, BaseType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
David Chisnall0f436562009-08-17 16:35:33 +00003018 }
David Chisnall0f436562009-08-17 16:35:33 +00003019 }
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003020
Fariborz Jahanian369a3bd2009-11-25 23:07:42 +00003021 // If this is an Objective-C pseudo-builtin and a definition is provided then
3022 // use that.
3023 if (Context.isObjCSelType(BaseType)) {
3024 // We have an 'SEL' type. Rather than fall through, we check if this
3025 // is a reference to 'sel_id'.
3026 if (BaseType != Context.ObjCSelRedefinitionType) {
3027 BaseType = Context.ObjCSelRedefinitionType;
3028 ImpCastExprToType(BaseExpr, BaseType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
3029 }
3030 }
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003031
Steve Naroffdfa6aae2007-07-26 03:11:44 +00003032 assert(!BaseType.isNull() && "no type for member expression");
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003033
Fariborz Jahanianb2ef1be2009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003034 // Handle properties on ObjC 'Class' types.
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003035 if (!IsArrow && BaseType->isObjCClassType()) {
Fariborz Jahanianb2ef1be2009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003036 // Also must look for a getter name which uses property syntax.
3037 IdentifierInfo *Member = MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo();
3038 Selector Sel = PP.getSelectorTable().getNullarySelector(Member);
3039 if (ObjCMethodDecl *MD = getCurMethodDecl()) {
3040 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = MD->getClassInterface();
3041 ObjCMethodDecl *Getter;
3042 // FIXME: need to also look locally in the implementation.
3043 if ((Getter = IFace->lookupClassMethod(Sel))) {
3044 // Check the use of this method.
3045 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Getter, MemberLoc))
3046 return ExprError();
3047 }
3048 // If we found a getter then this may be a valid dot-reference, we
3049 // will look for the matching setter, in case it is needed.
3050 Selector SetterSel =
3051 SelectorTable::constructSetterName(PP.getIdentifierTable(),
3052 PP.getSelectorTable(), Member);
3053 ObjCMethodDecl *Setter = IFace->lookupClassMethod(SetterSel);
3054 if (!Setter) {
3055 // If this reference is in an @implementation, also check for 'private'
3056 // methods.
Steve Naroffd789d3d2009-10-01 23:46:04 +00003057 Setter = IFace->lookupPrivateInstanceMethod(SetterSel);
Fariborz Jahanianb2ef1be2009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003058 }
3059 // Look through local category implementations associated with the class.
3060 if (!Setter)
3061 Setter = IFace->getCategoryClassMethod(SetterSel);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003062
Fariborz Jahanianb2ef1be2009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003063 if (Setter && DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Setter, MemberLoc))
3064 return ExprError();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003065
Fariborz Jahanianb2ef1be2009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003066 if (Getter || Setter) {
3067 QualType PType;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003068
Fariborz Jahanianb2ef1be2009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003069 if (Getter)
Douglas Gregor5291c3c2010-07-13 08:18:22 +00003070 PType = Getter->getSendResultType();
Fariborz Jahanianb2ef1be2009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003071 else
3072 // Get the expression type from Setter's incoming parameter.
3073 PType = (*(Setter->param_end() -1))->getType();
3074 // FIXME: we must check that the setter has property type.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003075 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCImplicitSetterGetterRefExpr(Getter,
Fariborz Jahanianb2ef1be2009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003076 PType,
3077 Setter, MemberLoc, BaseExpr));
3078 }
3079 return ExprError(Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_property_not_found)
3080 << MemberName << BaseType);
3081 }
3082 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003083
Fariborz Jahanianb2ef1be2009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003084 if (BaseType->isObjCClassType() &&
3085 BaseType != Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType) {
3086 BaseType = Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType;
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00003087 ImpCastExprToType(BaseExpr, BaseType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahanianb2ef1be2009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003088 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003089
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003090 if (IsArrow) {
3091 if (const PointerType *PT = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>())
Steve Naroffdfa6aae2007-07-26 03:11:44 +00003092 BaseType = PT->getPointeeType();
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003093 else if (BaseType->isObjCObjectPointerType())
3094 ;
John McCall812c1542009-12-07 22:46:59 +00003095 else if (BaseType->isRecordType()) {
3096 // Recover from arrow accesses to records, e.g.:
3097 // struct MyRecord foo;
3098 // foo->bar
3099 // This is actually well-formed in C++ if MyRecord has an
3100 // overloaded operator->, but that should have been dealt with
3101 // by now.
3102 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_suggestion)
3103 << BaseType << int(IsArrow) << BaseExpr->getSourceRange()
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00003104 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(OpLoc, ".");
John McCall812c1542009-12-07 22:46:59 +00003105 IsArrow = false;
3106 } else {
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003107 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_arrow)
3108 << BaseType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
3109 return ExprError();
Anders Carlsson4ef27702009-05-16 20:31:20 +00003110 }
John McCall812c1542009-12-07 22:46:59 +00003111 } else {
3112 // Recover from dot accesses to pointers, e.g.:
3113 // type *foo;
3114 // foo.bar
3115 // This is actually well-formed in two cases:
3116 // - 'type' is an Objective C type
3117 // - 'bar' is a pseudo-destructor name which happens to refer to
3118 // the appropriate pointer type
3119 if (MemberName.getNameKind() != DeclarationName::CXXDestructorName) {
3120 const PointerType *PT = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>();
3121 if (PT && PT->getPointeeType()->isRecordType()) {
3122 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_suggestion)
3123 << BaseType << int(IsArrow) << BaseExpr->getSourceRange()
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00003124 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(OpLoc, "->");
John McCall812c1542009-12-07 22:46:59 +00003125 BaseType = PT->getPointeeType();
3126 IsArrow = true;
3127 }
3128 }
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003129 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003130
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003131 // Handle field access to simple records.
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003132 if (const RecordType *RTy = BaseType->getAs<RecordType>()) {
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003133 if (LookupMemberExprInRecord(*this, R, BaseExpr->getSourceRange(),
John McCallad00b772010-06-16 08:42:20 +00003134 RTy, OpLoc, SS, HasTemplateArgs))
Douglas Gregor4ec339f2009-01-19 19:26:10 +00003135 return ExprError();
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003136 return Owned((Expr*) 0);
Chris Lattnerfb173ec2008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003137 }
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003138
Chris Lattnera38e6b12008-07-21 04:59:05 +00003139 // Handle access to Objective-C instance variables, such as "Obj->ivar" and
3140 // (*Obj).ivar.
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003141 if ((IsArrow && BaseType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) ||
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003142 (!IsArrow && BaseType->isObjCObjectType())) {
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003143 const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT = BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003144 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IDecl =
3145 OPT ? OPT->getInterfaceDecl()
3146 : BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectType>()->getInterface();
3147 if (IDecl) {
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003148 IdentifierInfo *Member = MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo();
3149
Steve Naroffc70e8d92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003150 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassDeclared;
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003151 ObjCIvarDecl *IV = IDecl->lookupInstanceVariable(Member, ClassDeclared);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003152
Douglas Gregorf06cdae2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00003153 if (!IV) {
3154 // Attempt to correct for typos in ivar names.
3155 LookupResult Res(*this, R.getLookupName(), R.getNameLoc(),
3156 LookupMemberName);
Douglas Gregoraaf87162010-04-14 20:04:41 +00003157 if (CorrectTypo(Res, 0, 0, IDecl, false, CTC_MemberLookup) &&
Douglas Gregorf06cdae2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00003158 (IV = Res.getAsSingle<ObjCIvarDecl>())) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003159 Diag(R.getNameLoc(),
Douglas Gregorf06cdae2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00003160 diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_ivar_suggest)
3161 << IDecl->getDeclName() << MemberName << IV->getDeclName()
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00003162 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(R.getNameLoc(),
3163 IV->getNameAsString());
Douglas Gregor67dd1d42010-01-07 00:17:44 +00003164 Diag(IV->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003165 << IV->getDeclName();
Douglas Gregor12eb5d62010-06-29 19:27:42 +00003166 } else {
3167 Res.clear();
3168 Res.setLookupName(Member);
Douglas Gregorf06cdae2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00003169 }
3170 }
3171
Steve Naroffc70e8d92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003172 if (IV) {
3173 // If the decl being referenced had an error, return an error for this
3174 // sub-expr without emitting another error, in order to avoid cascading
3175 // error cases.
3176 if (IV->isInvalidDecl())
3177 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +00003178
Steve Naroffc70e8d92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003179 // Check whether we can reference this field.
3180 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(IV, MemberLoc))
3181 return ExprError();
3182 if (IV->getAccessControl() != ObjCIvarDecl::Public &&
3183 IV->getAccessControl() != ObjCIvarDecl::Package) {
3184 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassOfMethodDecl = 0;
3185 if (ObjCMethodDecl *MD = getCurMethodDecl())
3186 ClassOfMethodDecl = MD->getClassInterface();
3187 else if (ObjCImpDecl && getCurFunctionDecl()) {
3188 // Case of a c-function declared inside an objc implementation.
3189 // FIXME: For a c-style function nested inside an objc implementation
3190 // class, there is no implementation context available, so we pass
3191 // down the context as argument to this routine. Ideally, this context
3192 // need be passed down in the AST node and somehow calculated from the
3193 // AST for a function decl.
3194 Decl *ImplDecl = ObjCImpDecl.getAs<Decl>();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003195 if (ObjCImplementationDecl *IMPD =
Steve Naroffc70e8d92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003196 dyn_cast<ObjCImplementationDecl>(ImplDecl))
3197 ClassOfMethodDecl = IMPD->getClassInterface();
3198 else if (ObjCCategoryImplDecl* CatImplClass =
3199 dyn_cast<ObjCCategoryImplDecl>(ImplDecl))
3200 ClassOfMethodDecl = CatImplClass->getClassInterface();
3201 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003202
3203 if (IV->getAccessControl() == ObjCIvarDecl::Private) {
3204 if (ClassDeclared != IDecl ||
Steve Naroffc70e8d92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003205 ClassOfMethodDecl != ClassDeclared)
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003206 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::error_private_ivar_access)
Steve Naroffc70e8d92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003207 << IV->getDeclName();
Mike Stumpac5fc7c2009-08-04 21:02:39 +00003208 } else if (!IDecl->isSuperClassOf(ClassOfMethodDecl))
3209 // @protected
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003210 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::error_protected_ivar_access)
Steve Naroffc70e8d92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003211 << IV->getDeclName();
Steve Naroffb06d8752009-03-04 18:34:24 +00003212 }
Steve Naroffc70e8d92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003213
3214 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCIvarRefExpr(IV, IV->getType(),
3215 MemberLoc, BaseExpr,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003216 IsArrow));
Fariborz Jahanian935fd762009-03-03 01:21:12 +00003217 }
Steve Naroffc70e8d92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003218 return ExprError(Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_ivar)
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003219 << IDecl->getDeclName() << MemberName
Steve Naroffc70e8d92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003220 << BaseExpr->getSourceRange());
Fariborz Jahanianaaa63a72008-12-13 22:20:28 +00003221 }
Chris Lattnerfb173ec2008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003222 }
Steve Naroffde2e22d2009-07-15 18:40:39 +00003223 // Handle properties on 'id' and qualified "id".
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003224 if (!IsArrow && (BaseType->isObjCIdType() ||
3225 BaseType->isObjCQualifiedIdType())) {
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003226 const ObjCObjectPointerType *QIdTy = BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003227 IdentifierInfo *Member = MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003228
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003229 // Check protocols on qualified interfaces.
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003230 Selector Sel = PP.getSelectorTable().getNullarySelector(Member);
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003231 if (Decl *PMDecl = FindGetterNameDecl(QIdTy, Member, Sel, Context)) {
3232 if (ObjCPropertyDecl *PD = dyn_cast<ObjCPropertyDecl>(PMDecl)) {
3233 // Check the use of this declaration
3234 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(PD, MemberLoc))
3235 return ExprError();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003236
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003237 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCPropertyRefExpr(PD, PD->getType(),
3238 MemberLoc, BaseExpr));
3239 }
3240 if (ObjCMethodDecl *OMD = dyn_cast<ObjCMethodDecl>(PMDecl)) {
3241 // Check the use of this method.
3242 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(OMD, MemberLoc))
3243 return ExprError();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003244
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00003245 return Owned(ObjCMessageExpr::Create(Context,
Douglas Gregor5291c3c2010-07-13 08:18:22 +00003246 OMD->getSendResultType(),
Douglas Gregor04badcf2010-04-21 00:45:42 +00003247 OpLoc, BaseExpr, Sel,
3248 OMD, NULL, 0, MemberLoc));
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003249 }
3250 }
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003251
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003252 return ExprError(Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_property_not_found)
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003253 << MemberName << BaseType);
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003254 }
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00003255
Chris Lattnera38e6b12008-07-21 04:59:05 +00003256 // Handle Objective-C property access, which is "Obj.property" where Obj is a
3257 // pointer to a (potentially qualified) interface type.
Chris Lattner7f816522010-04-11 07:45:24 +00003258 if (!IsArrow)
3259 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT =
3260 BaseType->getAsObjCInterfacePointerType())
Chris Lattnerb9d4fc12010-04-11 07:51:10 +00003261 return HandleExprPropertyRefExpr(OPT, BaseExpr, MemberName, MemberLoc);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003262
Steve Narofff242b1b2009-07-24 17:54:45 +00003263 // Handle the following exceptional case (*Obj).isa.
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003264 if (!IsArrow &&
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003265 BaseType->isObjCObjectType() &&
3266 BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectType>()->isObjCId() &&
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003267 MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo()->isStr("isa"))
Steve Narofff242b1b2009-07-24 17:54:45 +00003268 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCIsaExpr(BaseExpr, false, MemberLoc,
Fariborz Jahanian83dc3252009-12-09 19:05:56 +00003269 Context.getObjCClassType()));
Steve Narofff242b1b2009-07-24 17:54:45 +00003270
Chris Lattnerfb173ec2008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003271 // Handle 'field access' to vectors, such as 'V.xx'.
Chris Lattner73525de2009-02-16 21:11:58 +00003272 if (BaseType->isExtVectorType()) {
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003273 IdentifierInfo *Member = MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo();
Chris Lattnerfb173ec2008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003274 QualType ret = CheckExtVectorComponent(BaseType, OpLoc, Member, MemberLoc);
3275 if (ret.isNull())
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003276 return ExprError();
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003277 return Owned(new (Context) ExtVectorElementExpr(ret, BaseExpr, *Member,
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00003278 MemberLoc));
Chris Lattnerfb173ec2008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003279 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003280
Douglas Gregor214f31a2009-03-27 06:00:30 +00003281 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_struct_union)
3282 << BaseType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
3283
Douglas Gregor214f31a2009-03-27 06:00:30 +00003284 return ExprError();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00003285}
3286
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003287/// The main callback when the parser finds something like
3288/// expression . [nested-name-specifier] identifier
3289/// expression -> [nested-name-specifier] identifier
3290/// where 'identifier' encompasses a fairly broad spectrum of
3291/// possibilities, including destructor and operator references.
3292///
3293/// \param OpKind either tok::arrow or tok::period
3294/// \param HasTrailingLParen whether the next token is '(', which
3295/// is used to diagnose mis-uses of special members that can
3296/// only be called
3297/// \param ObjCImpDecl the current ObjC @implementation decl;
3298/// this is an ugly hack around the fact that ObjC @implementations
3299/// aren't properly put in the context chain
3300Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnMemberAccessExpr(Scope *S, ExprArg BaseArg,
3301 SourceLocation OpLoc,
3302 tok::TokenKind OpKind,
Jeffrey Yasskin9ab14542010-04-08 16:38:48 +00003303 CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003304 UnqualifiedId &Id,
3305 DeclPtrTy ObjCImpDecl,
3306 bool HasTrailingLParen) {
3307 if (SS.isSet() && SS.isInvalid())
3308 return ExprError();
3309
3310 TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer;
3311
3312 // Decompose the name into its component parts.
3313 DeclarationName Name;
3314 SourceLocation NameLoc;
3315 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs;
3316 DecomposeUnqualifiedId(*this, Id, TemplateArgsBuffer,
3317 Name, NameLoc, TemplateArgs);
3318
3319 bool IsArrow = (OpKind == tok::arrow);
3320
3321 NamedDecl *FirstQualifierInScope
3322 = (!SS.isSet() ? 0 : FindFirstQualifierInScope(S,
3323 static_cast<NestedNameSpecifier*>(SS.getScopeRep())));
3324
3325 // This is a postfix expression, so get rid of ParenListExprs.
3326 BaseArg = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, move(BaseArg));
3327
3328 Expr *Base = BaseArg.takeAs<Expr>();
3329 OwningExprResult Result(*this);
Douglas Gregor01e56ae2010-04-12 20:54:26 +00003330 if (Base->getType()->isDependentType() || Name.isDependentName() ||
3331 isDependentScopeSpecifier(SS)) {
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003332 Result = ActOnDependentMemberExpr(ExprArg(*this, Base), Base->getType(),
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003333 IsArrow, OpLoc,
3334 SS, FirstQualifierInScope,
3335 Name, NameLoc,
3336 TemplateArgs);
3337 } else {
3338 LookupResult R(*this, Name, NameLoc, LookupMemberName);
John McCallad00b772010-06-16 08:42:20 +00003339 Result = LookupMemberExpr(R, Base, IsArrow, OpLoc,
3340 SS, ObjCImpDecl, TemplateArgs != 0);
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00003341
John McCallad00b772010-06-16 08:42:20 +00003342 if (Result.isInvalid()) {
3343 Owned(Base);
3344 return ExprError();
3345 }
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003346
John McCallad00b772010-06-16 08:42:20 +00003347 if (Result.get()) {
3348 // The only way a reference to a destructor can be used is to
3349 // immediately call it, which falls into this case. If the
3350 // next token is not a '(', produce a diagnostic and build the
3351 // call now.
3352 if (!HasTrailingLParen &&
3353 Id.getKind() == UnqualifiedId::IK_DestructorName)
3354 return DiagnoseDtorReference(NameLoc, move(Result));
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003355
John McCallad00b772010-06-16 08:42:20 +00003356 return move(Result);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003357 }
3358
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003359 Result = BuildMemberReferenceExpr(ExprArg(*this, Base), Base->getType(),
John McCallc2233c52010-01-15 08:34:02 +00003360 OpLoc, IsArrow, SS, FirstQualifierInScope,
3361 R, TemplateArgs);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003362 }
3363
3364 return move(Result);
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003365}
3366
Anders Carlsson56c5e332009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003367Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::BuildCXXDefaultArgExpr(SourceLocation CallLoc,
3368 FunctionDecl *FD,
3369 ParmVarDecl *Param) {
3370 if (Param->hasUnparsedDefaultArg()) {
3371 Diag (CallLoc,
3372 diag::err_use_of_default_argument_to_function_declared_later) <<
3373 FD << cast<CXXRecordDecl>(FD->getDeclContext())->getDeclName();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003374 Diag(UnparsedDefaultArgLocs[Param],
Anders Carlsson56c5e332009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003375 diag::note_default_argument_declared_here);
3376 } else {
3377 if (Param->hasUninstantiatedDefaultArg()) {
3378 Expr *UninstExpr = Param->getUninstantiatedDefaultArg();
3379
3380 // Instantiate the expression.
Douglas Gregor525f96c2010-02-05 07:33:43 +00003381 MultiLevelTemplateArgumentList ArgList
3382 = getTemplateInstantiationArgs(FD, 0, /*RelativeToPrimary=*/true);
Anders Carlsson25cae7f2009-09-05 05:14:19 +00003383
Douglas Gregor24bae922010-07-08 18:37:38 +00003384 std::pair<const TemplateArgument *, unsigned> Innermost
3385 = ArgList.getInnermost();
3386 InstantiatingTemplate Inst(*this, CallLoc, Param, Innermost.first,
3387 Innermost.second);
Anders Carlsson56c5e332009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003388
John McCallce3ff2b2009-08-25 22:02:44 +00003389 OwningExprResult Result = SubstExpr(UninstExpr, ArgList);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003390 if (Result.isInvalid())
Anders Carlsson56c5e332009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003391 return ExprError();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003392
Douglas Gregor65222e82009-12-23 18:19:08 +00003393 // Check the expression as an initializer for the parameter.
3394 InitializedEntity Entity
3395 = InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Param);
3396 InitializationKind Kind
3397 = InitializationKind::CreateCopy(Param->getLocation(),
3398 /*FIXME:EqualLoc*/UninstExpr->getSourceRange().getBegin());
3399 Expr *ResultE = Result.takeAs<Expr>();
3400
3401 InitializationSequence InitSeq(*this, Entity, Kind, &ResultE, 1);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003402 Result = InitSeq.Perform(*this, Entity, Kind,
Douglas Gregor65222e82009-12-23 18:19:08 +00003403 MultiExprArg(*this, (void**)&ResultE, 1));
3404 if (Result.isInvalid())
Anders Carlsson56c5e332009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003405 return ExprError();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003406
Douglas Gregor65222e82009-12-23 18:19:08 +00003407 // Build the default argument expression.
Douglas Gregor036aed12009-12-23 23:03:06 +00003408 return Owned(CXXDefaultArgExpr::Create(Context, CallLoc, Param,
Douglas Gregor65222e82009-12-23 18:19:08 +00003409 Result.takeAs<Expr>()));
Anders Carlsson56c5e332009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003410 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003411
Anders Carlsson56c5e332009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003412 // If the default expression creates temporaries, we need to
3413 // push them to the current stack of expression temporaries so they'll
3414 // be properly destroyed.
Douglas Gregor65222e82009-12-23 18:19:08 +00003415 // FIXME: We should really be rebuilding the default argument with new
3416 // bound temporaries; see the comment in PR5810.
Anders Carlsson337cba42009-12-15 19:16:31 +00003417 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Param->getNumDefaultArgTemporaries(); i != e; ++i)
3418 ExprTemporaries.push_back(Param->getDefaultArgTemporary(i));
Anders Carlsson56c5e332009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003419 }
3420
3421 // We already type-checked the argument, so we know it works.
Douglas Gregor036aed12009-12-23 23:03:06 +00003422 return Owned(CXXDefaultArgExpr::Create(Context, CallLoc, Param));
Anders Carlsson56c5e332009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003423}
3424
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003425/// ConvertArgumentsForCall - Converts the arguments specified in
3426/// Args/NumArgs to the parameter types of the function FDecl with
3427/// function prototype Proto. Call is the call expression itself, and
3428/// Fn is the function expression. For a C++ member function, this
3429/// routine does not attempt to convert the object argument. Returns
3430/// true if the call is ill-formed.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003431bool
3432Sema::ConvertArgumentsForCall(CallExpr *Call, Expr *Fn,
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003433 FunctionDecl *FDecl,
Douglas Gregor72564e72009-02-26 23:50:07 +00003434 const FunctionProtoType *Proto,
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003435 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
3436 SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003437 // C99 6.5.2.2p7 - the arguments are implicitly converted, as if by
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003438 // assignment, to the types of the corresponding parameter, ...
3439 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
Douglas Gregor3fd56d72009-01-23 21:30:56 +00003440 bool Invalid = false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003441
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003442 // If too few arguments are available (and we don't have default
3443 // arguments for the remaining parameters), don't make the call.
3444 if (NumArgs < NumArgsInProto) {
3445 if (!FDecl || NumArgs < FDecl->getMinRequiredArguments())
3446 return Diag(RParenLoc, diag::err_typecheck_call_too_few_args)
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00003447 << Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType()
Eric Christopherd77b9a22010-04-16 04:48:22 +00003448 << NumArgsInProto << NumArgs << Fn->getSourceRange();
Ted Kremenek8189cde2009-02-07 01:47:29 +00003449 Call->setNumArgs(Context, NumArgsInProto);
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003450 }
3451
3452 // If too many are passed and not variadic, error on the extras and drop
3453 // them.
3454 if (NumArgs > NumArgsInProto) {
3455 if (!Proto->isVariadic()) {
3456 Diag(Args[NumArgsInProto]->getLocStart(),
3457 diag::err_typecheck_call_too_many_args)
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00003458 << Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType()
Eric Christopherccfa9632010-04-16 04:56:46 +00003459 << NumArgsInProto << NumArgs << Fn->getSourceRange()
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003460 << SourceRange(Args[NumArgsInProto]->getLocStart(),
3461 Args[NumArgs-1]->getLocEnd());
3462 // This deletes the extra arguments.
Ted Kremenek8189cde2009-02-07 01:47:29 +00003463 Call->setNumArgs(Context, NumArgsInProto);
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003464 return true;
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003465 }
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003466 }
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003467 llvm::SmallVector<Expr *, 8> AllArgs;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003468 VariadicCallType CallType =
Fariborz Jahanian4cd1c702009-11-24 19:27:49 +00003469 Proto->isVariadic() ? VariadicFunction : VariadicDoesNotApply;
3470 if (Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType())
3471 CallType = VariadicBlock; // Block
3472 else if (isa<MemberExpr>(Fn))
3473 CallType = VariadicMethod;
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003474 Invalid = GatherArgumentsForCall(Call->getSourceRange().getBegin(), FDecl,
Fariborz Jahanian2fe168f2009-11-24 21:37:28 +00003475 Proto, 0, Args, NumArgs, AllArgs, CallType);
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003476 if (Invalid)
3477 return true;
3478 unsigned TotalNumArgs = AllArgs.size();
3479 for (unsigned i = 0; i < TotalNumArgs; ++i)
3480 Call->setArg(i, AllArgs[i]);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003481
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003482 return false;
3483}
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003484
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003485bool Sema::GatherArgumentsForCall(SourceLocation CallLoc,
3486 FunctionDecl *FDecl,
3487 const FunctionProtoType *Proto,
3488 unsigned FirstProtoArg,
3489 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
3490 llvm::SmallVector<Expr *, 8> &AllArgs,
Fariborz Jahanian4cd1c702009-11-24 19:27:49 +00003491 VariadicCallType CallType) {
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003492 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
3493 unsigned NumArgsToCheck = NumArgs;
3494 bool Invalid = false;
3495 if (NumArgs != NumArgsInProto)
3496 // Use default arguments for missing arguments
3497 NumArgsToCheck = NumArgsInProto;
3498 unsigned ArgIx = 0;
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003499 // Continue to check argument types (even if we have too few/many args).
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003500 for (unsigned i = FirstProtoArg; i != NumArgsToCheck; i++) {
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003501 QualType ProtoArgType = Proto->getArgType(i);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003502
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003503 Expr *Arg;
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003504 if (ArgIx < NumArgs) {
3505 Arg = Args[ArgIx++];
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003506
Eli Friedmane7c6f7a2009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003507 if (RequireCompleteType(Arg->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
3508 ProtoArgType,
Anders Carlssonb7906612009-08-26 23:45:07 +00003509 PDiag(diag::err_call_incomplete_argument)
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003510 << Arg->getSourceRange()))
Eli Friedmane7c6f7a2009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003511 return true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003512
Douglas Gregora188ff22009-12-22 16:09:06 +00003513 // Pass the argument
3514 ParmVarDecl *Param = 0;
3515 if (FDecl && i < FDecl->getNumParams())
3516 Param = FDecl->getParamDecl(i);
Douglas Gregoraa037312009-12-22 07:24:36 +00003517
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003518
Douglas Gregora188ff22009-12-22 16:09:06 +00003519 InitializedEntity Entity =
3520 Param? InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Param)
3521 : InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(ProtoArgType);
3522 OwningExprResult ArgE = PerformCopyInitialization(Entity,
3523 SourceLocation(),
3524 Owned(Arg));
3525 if (ArgE.isInvalid())
3526 return true;
3527
3528 Arg = ArgE.takeAs<Expr>();
Anders Carlsson5e300d12009-06-12 16:51:40 +00003529 } else {
Anders Carlssoned961f92009-08-25 02:29:20 +00003530 ParmVarDecl *Param = FDecl->getParamDecl(i);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003531
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003532 OwningExprResult ArgExpr =
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003533 BuildCXXDefaultArgExpr(CallLoc, FDecl, Param);
Anders Carlsson56c5e332009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003534 if (ArgExpr.isInvalid())
3535 return true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003536
Anders Carlsson56c5e332009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003537 Arg = ArgExpr.takeAs<Expr>();
Anders Carlsson5e300d12009-06-12 16:51:40 +00003538 }
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003539 AllArgs.push_back(Arg);
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003540 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003541
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003542 // If this is a variadic call, handle args passed through "...".
Fariborz Jahanian4cd1c702009-11-24 19:27:49 +00003543 if (CallType != VariadicDoesNotApply) {
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003544 // Promote the arguments (C99 6.5.2.2p7).
Chris Lattner40378332010-05-16 04:01:30 +00003545 for (unsigned i = ArgIx; i != NumArgs; ++i) {
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003546 Expr *Arg = Args[i];
Chris Lattner40378332010-05-16 04:01:30 +00003547 Invalid |= DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion(Arg, CallType, FDecl);
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003548 AllArgs.push_back(Arg);
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003549 }
3550 }
Douglas Gregor3fd56d72009-01-23 21:30:56 +00003551 return Invalid;
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003552}
3553
Steve Narofff69936d2007-09-16 03:34:24 +00003554/// ActOnCallExpr - Handle a call to Fn with the specified array of arguments.
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00003555/// This provides the location of the left/right parens and a list of comma
3556/// locations.
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003557Action::OwningExprResult
3558Sema::ActOnCallExpr(Scope *S, ExprArg fn, SourceLocation LParenLoc,
3559 MultiExprArg args,
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003560 SourceLocation *CommaLocs, SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003561 unsigned NumArgs = args.size();
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00003562
3563 // Since this might be a postfix expression, get rid of ParenListExprs.
3564 fn = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, move(fn));
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003565
Anders Carlssonf1b1d592009-05-01 19:30:39 +00003566 Expr *Fn = fn.takeAs<Expr>();
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003567 Expr **Args = reinterpret_cast<Expr**>(args.release());
Chris Lattner74c469f2007-07-21 03:03:59 +00003568 assert(Fn && "no function call expression");
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003569
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003570 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
Douglas Gregora71d8192009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003571 // If this is a pseudo-destructor expression, build the call immediately.
3572 if (isa<CXXPseudoDestructorExpr>(Fn)) {
3573 if (NumArgs > 0) {
3574 // Pseudo-destructor calls should not have any arguments.
3575 Diag(Fn->getLocStart(), diag::err_pseudo_dtor_call_with_args)
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00003576 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(
Douglas Gregora71d8192009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003577 SourceRange(Args[0]->getLocStart(),
3578 Args[NumArgs-1]->getLocEnd()));
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003579
Douglas Gregora71d8192009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003580 NumArgs = 0;
3581 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003582
Douglas Gregora71d8192009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003583 return Owned(new (Context) CallExpr(Context, Fn, 0, 0, Context.VoidTy,
3584 RParenLoc));
3585 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003586
Douglas Gregor17330012009-02-04 15:01:18 +00003587 // Determine whether this is a dependent call inside a C++ template,
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003588 // in which case we won't do any semantic analysis now.
Mike Stump390b4cc2009-05-16 07:39:55 +00003589 // FIXME: Will need to cache the results of name lookup (including ADL) in
3590 // Fn.
Douglas Gregor17330012009-02-04 15:01:18 +00003591 bool Dependent = false;
3592 if (Fn->isTypeDependent())
3593 Dependent = true;
3594 else if (Expr::hasAnyTypeDependentArguments(Args, NumArgs))
3595 Dependent = true;
3596
3597 if (Dependent)
Ted Kremenek668bf912009-02-09 20:51:47 +00003598 return Owned(new (Context) CallExpr(Context, Fn, Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregor17330012009-02-04 15:01:18 +00003599 Context.DependentTy, RParenLoc));
3600
3601 // Determine whether this is a call to an object (C++ [over.call.object]).
3602 if (Fn->getType()->isRecordType())
3603 return Owned(BuildCallToObjectOfClassType(S, Fn, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
3604 CommaLocs, RParenLoc));
3605
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003606 Expr *NakedFn = Fn->IgnoreParens();
3607
3608 // Determine whether this is a call to an unresolved member function.
3609 if (UnresolvedMemberExpr *MemE = dyn_cast<UnresolvedMemberExpr>(NakedFn)) {
3610 // If lookup was unresolved but not dependent (i.e. didn't find
3611 // an unresolved using declaration), it has to be an overloaded
3612 // function set, which means it must contain either multiple
3613 // declarations (all methods or method templates) or a single
3614 // method template.
3615 assert((MemE->getNumDecls() > 1) ||
Douglas Gregor2b147f02010-04-25 21:15:30 +00003616 isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(
3617 (*MemE->decls_begin())->getUnderlyingDecl()));
Douglas Gregor958aeb02009-12-01 03:34:29 +00003618 (void)MemE;
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003619
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003620 return BuildCallToMemberFunction(S, Fn, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
3621 CommaLocs, RParenLoc);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003622 }
3623
Douglas Gregorfa047642009-02-04 00:32:51 +00003624 // Determine whether this is a call to a member function.
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003625 if (MemberExpr *MemExpr = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(NakedFn)) {
Douglas Gregore53060f2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00003626 NamedDecl *MemDecl = MemExpr->getMemberDecl();
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003627 if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(MemDecl))
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003628 return BuildCallToMemberFunction(S, Fn, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
3629 CommaLocs, RParenLoc);
Douglas Gregore53060f2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00003630 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003631
Anders Carlsson83ccfc32009-10-03 17:40:22 +00003632 // Determine whether this is a call to a pointer-to-member function.
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003633 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(NakedFn)) {
Anders Carlsson83ccfc32009-10-03 17:40:22 +00003634 if (BO->getOpcode() == BinaryOperator::PtrMemD ||
3635 BO->getOpcode() == BinaryOperator::PtrMemI) {
Douglas Gregor5f970ee2010-05-04 18:18:31 +00003636 if (const FunctionProtoType *FPT
3637 = BO->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) {
Douglas Gregor5291c3c2010-07-13 08:18:22 +00003638 QualType ResultTy = FPT->getCallResultType(Context);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003639
3640 ExprOwningPtr<CXXMemberCallExpr>
3641 TheCall(this, new (Context) CXXMemberCallExpr(Context, BO, Args,
Fariborz Jahanian5de24502009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003642 NumArgs, ResultTy,
3643 RParenLoc));
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003644
3645 if (CheckCallReturnType(FPT->getResultType(),
3646 BO->getRHS()->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
Fariborz Jahanian5de24502009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003647 TheCall.get(), 0))
3648 return ExprError();
Anders Carlsson8d6d90d2009-10-15 00:41:48 +00003649
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003650 if (ConvertArgumentsForCall(&*TheCall, BO, 0, FPT, Args, NumArgs,
Fariborz Jahanian5de24502009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003651 RParenLoc))
3652 return ExprError();
Anders Carlsson83ccfc32009-10-03 17:40:22 +00003653
Fariborz Jahanian5de24502009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003654 return Owned(MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall.release()).release());
3655 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003656 return ExprError(Diag(Fn->getLocStart(),
Fariborz Jahanian5de24502009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003657 diag::err_typecheck_call_not_function)
3658 << Fn->getType() << Fn->getSourceRange());
Anders Carlsson83ccfc32009-10-03 17:40:22 +00003659 }
3660 }
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003661 }
3662
Douglas Gregorfa047642009-02-04 00:32:51 +00003663 // If we're directly calling a function, get the appropriate declaration.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003664 // Also, in C++, keep track of whether we should perform argument-dependent
Douglas Gregor6db8ed42009-06-30 23:57:56 +00003665 // lookup and whether there were any explicitly-specified template arguments.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003666
Eli Friedmanefa42f72009-12-26 03:35:45 +00003667 Expr *NakedFn = Fn->IgnoreParens();
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00003668 if (isa<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(NakedFn)) {
3669 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE = cast<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(NakedFn);
Douglas Gregor1aae80b2010-04-14 20:27:54 +00003670 return BuildOverloadedCallExpr(S, Fn, ULE, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00003671 CommaLocs, RParenLoc);
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003672 }
Chris Lattner04421082008-04-08 04:40:51 +00003673
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00003674 NamedDecl *NDecl = 0;
3675 if (isa<DeclRefExpr>(NakedFn))
3676 NDecl = cast<DeclRefExpr>(NakedFn)->getDecl();
3677
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003678 return BuildResolvedCallExpr(Fn, NDecl, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs, RParenLoc);
3679}
3680
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00003681/// BuildResolvedCallExpr - Build a call to a resolved expression,
3682/// i.e. an expression not of \p OverloadTy. The expression should
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003683/// unary-convert to an expression of function-pointer or
3684/// block-pointer type.
3685///
3686/// \param NDecl the declaration being called, if available
3687Sema::OwningExprResult
3688Sema::BuildResolvedCallExpr(Expr *Fn, NamedDecl *NDecl,
3689 SourceLocation LParenLoc,
3690 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
3691 SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
3692 FunctionDecl *FDecl = dyn_cast_or_null<FunctionDecl>(NDecl);
3693
Chris Lattner04421082008-04-08 04:40:51 +00003694 // Promote the function operand.
3695 UsualUnaryConversions(Fn);
3696
Chris Lattner925e60d2007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003697 // Make the call expr early, before semantic checks. This guarantees cleanup
3698 // of arguments and function on error.
Ted Kremenek668bf912009-02-09 20:51:47 +00003699 ExprOwningPtr<CallExpr> TheCall(this, new (Context) CallExpr(Context, Fn,
3700 Args, NumArgs,
3701 Context.BoolTy,
3702 RParenLoc));
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003703
Steve Naroffdd972f22008-09-05 22:11:13 +00003704 const FunctionType *FuncT;
3705 if (!Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType()) {
3706 // C99 6.5.2.2p1 - "The expression that denotes the called function shall
3707 // have type pointer to function".
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003708 const PointerType *PT = Fn->getType()->getAs<PointerType>();
Steve Naroffdd972f22008-09-05 22:11:13 +00003709 if (PT == 0)
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003710 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_typecheck_call_not_function)
3711 << Fn->getType() << Fn->getSourceRange());
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003712 FuncT = PT->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionType>();
Steve Naroffdd972f22008-09-05 22:11:13 +00003713 } else { // This is a block call.
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003714 FuncT = Fn->getType()->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType()->
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003715 getAs<FunctionType>();
Steve Naroffdd972f22008-09-05 22:11:13 +00003716 }
Chris Lattner925e60d2007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003717 if (FuncT == 0)
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003718 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_typecheck_call_not_function)
3719 << Fn->getType() << Fn->getSourceRange());
3720
Eli Friedmane7c6f7a2009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003721 // Check for a valid return type
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003722 if (CheckCallReturnType(FuncT->getResultType(),
Anders Carlsson8c8d9192009-10-09 23:51:55 +00003723 Fn->getSourceRange().getBegin(), TheCall.get(),
3724 FDecl))
Eli Friedmane7c6f7a2009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003725 return ExprError();
3726
Chris Lattner925e60d2007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003727 // We know the result type of the call, set it.
Douglas Gregor5291c3c2010-07-13 08:18:22 +00003728 TheCall->setType(FuncT->getCallResultType(Context));
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003729
Douglas Gregor72564e72009-02-26 23:50:07 +00003730 if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(FuncT)) {
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003731 if (ConvertArgumentsForCall(&*TheCall, Fn, FDecl, Proto, Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003732 RParenLoc))
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003733 return ExprError();
Chris Lattner925e60d2007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003734 } else {
Douglas Gregor72564e72009-02-26 23:50:07 +00003735 assert(isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(FuncT) && "Unknown FunctionType!");
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003736
Douglas Gregor74734d52009-04-02 15:37:10 +00003737 if (FDecl) {
3738 // Check if we have too few/too many template arguments, based
3739 // on our knowledge of the function definition.
3740 const FunctionDecl *Def = 0;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis06a54a32010-07-07 11:31:19 +00003741 if (FDecl->hasBody(Def) && NumArgs != Def->param_size()) {
Eli Friedmanbc4e29f2009-06-01 09:24:59 +00003742 const FunctionProtoType *Proto =
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003743 Def->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
Eli Friedmanbc4e29f2009-06-01 09:24:59 +00003744 if (!Proto || !(Proto->isVariadic() && NumArgs >= Def->param_size())) {
3745 Diag(RParenLoc, diag::warn_call_wrong_number_of_arguments)
3746 << (NumArgs > Def->param_size()) << FDecl << Fn->getSourceRange();
3747 }
3748 }
Douglas Gregor74734d52009-04-02 15:37:10 +00003749 }
3750
Steve Naroffb291ab62007-08-28 23:30:39 +00003751 // Promote the arguments (C99 6.5.2.2p6).
Chris Lattner925e60d2007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003752 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumArgs; i++) {
3753 Expr *Arg = Args[i];
3754 DefaultArgumentPromotion(Arg);
Eli Friedmane7c6f7a2009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003755 if (RequireCompleteType(Arg->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
3756 Arg->getType(),
Anders Carlssonb7906612009-08-26 23:45:07 +00003757 PDiag(diag::err_call_incomplete_argument)
3758 << Arg->getSourceRange()))
Eli Friedmane7c6f7a2009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003759 return ExprError();
Chris Lattner925e60d2007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003760 TheCall->setArg(i, Arg);
Steve Naroffb291ab62007-08-28 23:30:39 +00003761 }
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00003762 }
Chris Lattner925e60d2007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003763
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003764 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast_or_null<CXXMethodDecl>(FDecl))
3765 if (!Method->isStatic())
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003766 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_member_call_without_object)
3767 << Fn->getSourceRange());
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003768
Fariborz Jahaniandaf04152009-05-15 20:33:25 +00003769 // Check for sentinels
3770 if (NDecl)
3771 DiagnoseSentinelCalls(NDecl, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003772
Chris Lattner59907c42007-08-10 20:18:51 +00003773 // Do special checking on direct calls to functions.
Anders Carlssond406bf02009-08-16 01:56:34 +00003774 if (FDecl) {
3775 if (CheckFunctionCall(FDecl, TheCall.get()))
3776 return ExprError();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003777
Douglas Gregor7814e6d2009-09-12 00:22:50 +00003778 if (unsigned BuiltinID = FDecl->getBuiltinID())
Anders Carlssond406bf02009-08-16 01:56:34 +00003779 return CheckBuiltinFunctionCall(BuiltinID, TheCall.take());
3780 } else if (NDecl) {
3781 if (CheckBlockCall(NDecl, TheCall.get()))
3782 return ExprError();
3783 }
Chris Lattner59907c42007-08-10 20:18:51 +00003784
Anders Carlssonec74c592009-08-16 03:06:32 +00003785 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall.take());
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00003786}
3787
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003788Action::OwningExprResult
3789Sema::ActOnCompoundLiteral(SourceLocation LParenLoc, TypeTy *Ty,
3790 SourceLocation RParenLoc, ExprArg InitExpr) {
Steve Narofff69936d2007-09-16 03:34:24 +00003791 assert((Ty != 0) && "ActOnCompoundLiteral(): missing type");
Steve Naroffaff1edd2007-07-19 21:32:11 +00003792 // FIXME: put back this assert when initializers are worked out.
Steve Narofff69936d2007-09-16 03:34:24 +00003793 //assert((InitExpr != 0) && "ActOnCompoundLiteral(): missing expression");
John McCall42f56b52010-01-18 19:35:47 +00003794
3795 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo;
3796 QualType literalType = GetTypeFromParser(Ty, &TInfo);
3797 if (!TInfo)
3798 TInfo = Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(literalType);
3799
3800 return BuildCompoundLiteralExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, RParenLoc, move(InitExpr));
3801}
3802
3803Action::OwningExprResult
3804Sema::BuildCompoundLiteralExpr(SourceLocation LParenLoc, TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
3805 SourceLocation RParenLoc, ExprArg InitExpr) {
3806 QualType literalType = TInfo->getType();
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003807 Expr *literalExpr = static_cast<Expr*>(InitExpr.get());
Anders Carlssond35c8322007-12-05 07:24:19 +00003808
Eli Friedman6223c222008-05-20 05:22:08 +00003809 if (literalType->isArrayType()) {
Chris Lattnerc63a1f22008-08-04 07:31:14 +00003810 if (literalType->isVariableArrayType())
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003811 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_variable_object_no_init)
3812 << SourceRange(LParenLoc, literalExpr->getSourceRange().getEnd()));
Douglas Gregor690dc7f2009-05-21 23:48:18 +00003813 } else if (!literalType->isDependentType() &&
3814 RequireCompleteType(LParenLoc, literalType,
Anders Carlssonb7906612009-08-26 23:45:07 +00003815 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_decl_incomplete_type)
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003816 << SourceRange(LParenLoc,
Anders Carlssonb7906612009-08-26 23:45:07 +00003817 literalExpr->getSourceRange().getEnd())))
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003818 return ExprError();
Eli Friedman6223c222008-05-20 05:22:08 +00003819
Douglas Gregor99a2e602009-12-16 01:38:02 +00003820 InitializedEntity Entity
Douglas Gregord6542d82009-12-22 15:35:07 +00003821 = InitializedEntity::InitializeTemporary(literalType);
Douglas Gregor99a2e602009-12-16 01:38:02 +00003822 InitializationKind Kind
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003823 = InitializationKind::CreateCast(SourceRange(LParenLoc, RParenLoc),
Douglas Gregor99a2e602009-12-16 01:38:02 +00003824 /*IsCStyleCast=*/true);
Eli Friedman08544622009-12-22 02:35:53 +00003825 InitializationSequence InitSeq(*this, Entity, Kind, &literalExpr, 1);
3826 OwningExprResult Result = InitSeq.Perform(*this, Entity, Kind,
3827 MultiExprArg(*this, (void**)&literalExpr, 1),
3828 &literalType);
3829 if (Result.isInvalid())
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003830 return ExprError();
Eli Friedman08544622009-12-22 02:35:53 +00003831 InitExpr.release();
3832 literalExpr = static_cast<Expr*>(Result.get());
Steve Naroffe9b12192008-01-14 18:19:28 +00003833
Chris Lattner371f2582008-12-04 23:50:19 +00003834 bool isFileScope = getCurFunctionOrMethodDecl() == 0;
Steve Naroffe9b12192008-01-14 18:19:28 +00003835 if (isFileScope) { // 6.5.2.5p3
Steve Naroffd0091aa2008-01-10 22:15:12 +00003836 if (CheckForConstantInitializer(literalExpr, literalType))
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003837 return ExprError();
Steve Naroffd0091aa2008-01-10 22:15:12 +00003838 }
Eli Friedman08544622009-12-22 02:35:53 +00003839
3840 Result.release();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003841
John McCall1d7d8d62010-01-19 22:33:45 +00003842 return Owned(new (Context) CompoundLiteralExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, literalType,
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00003843 literalExpr, isFileScope));
Steve Naroff4aa88f82007-07-19 01:06:55 +00003844}
3845
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003846Action::OwningExprResult
3847Sema::ActOnInitList(SourceLocation LBraceLoc, MultiExprArg initlist,
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003848 SourceLocation RBraceLoc) {
3849 unsigned NumInit = initlist.size();
3850 Expr **InitList = reinterpret_cast<Expr**>(initlist.release());
Anders Carlsson66b5a8a2007-08-31 04:56:16 +00003851
Steve Naroff08d92e42007-09-15 18:49:24 +00003852 // Semantic analysis for initializers is done by ActOnDeclarator() and
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003853 // CheckInitializer() - it requires knowledge of the object being intialized.
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003854
Ted Kremenek709210f2010-04-13 23:39:13 +00003855 InitListExpr *E = new (Context) InitListExpr(Context, LBraceLoc, InitList,
3856 NumInit, RBraceLoc);
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00003857 E->setType(Context.VoidTy); // FIXME: just a place holder for now.
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003858 return Owned(E);
Steve Naroff4aa88f82007-07-19 01:06:55 +00003859}
3860
Anders Carlsson82debc72009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003861static CastExpr::CastKind getScalarCastKind(ASTContext &Context,
3862 QualType SrcTy, QualType DestTy) {
Douglas Gregora4923eb2009-11-16 21:35:15 +00003863 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(SrcTy, DestTy))
Anders Carlsson82debc72009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003864 return CastExpr::CK_NoOp;
3865
3866 if (SrcTy->hasPointerRepresentation()) {
3867 if (DestTy->hasPointerRepresentation())
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003868 return DestTy->isObjCObjectPointerType() ?
3869 CastExpr::CK_AnyPointerToObjCPointerCast :
Fariborz Jahaniana7fa7cd2009-12-15 21:34:52 +00003870 CastExpr::CK_BitCast;
Anders Carlsson82debc72009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003871 if (DestTy->isIntegerType())
3872 return CastExpr::CK_PointerToIntegral;
3873 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003874
Anders Carlsson82debc72009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003875 if (SrcTy->isIntegerType()) {
3876 if (DestTy->isIntegerType())
3877 return CastExpr::CK_IntegralCast;
3878 if (DestTy->hasPointerRepresentation())
3879 return CastExpr::CK_IntegralToPointer;
3880 if (DestTy->isRealFloatingType())
3881 return CastExpr::CK_IntegralToFloating;
3882 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003883
Anders Carlsson82debc72009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003884 if (SrcTy->isRealFloatingType()) {
3885 if (DestTy->isRealFloatingType())
3886 return CastExpr::CK_FloatingCast;
3887 if (DestTy->isIntegerType())
3888 return CastExpr::CK_FloatingToIntegral;
3889 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003890
Anders Carlsson82debc72009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003891 // FIXME: Assert here.
3892 // assert(false && "Unhandled cast combination!");
3893 return CastExpr::CK_Unknown;
3894}
3895
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6c2dc4d2008-08-16 20:27:34 +00003896/// CheckCastTypes - Check type constraints for casting between types.
Sebastian Redlef0cb8e2009-07-29 13:50:23 +00003897bool Sema::CheckCastTypes(SourceRange TyR, QualType castType, Expr *&castExpr,
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003898 CastExpr::CastKind& Kind,
John McCallf871d0c2010-08-07 06:22:56 +00003899 CXXCastPath &BasePath,
Fariborz Jahaniane9f42082009-08-26 18:55:36 +00003900 bool FunctionalStyle) {
Sebastian Redl9cc11e72009-07-25 15:41:38 +00003901 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
Anders Carlsson5cf86ba2010-04-24 19:06:50 +00003902 return CXXCheckCStyleCast(TyR, castType, castExpr, Kind, BasePath,
3903 FunctionalStyle);
Sebastian Redl9cc11e72009-07-25 15:41:38 +00003904
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +00003905 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(castExpr);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6c2dc4d2008-08-16 20:27:34 +00003906
3907 // C99 6.5.4p2: the cast type needs to be void or scalar and the expression
3908 // type needs to be scalar.
3909 if (castType->isVoidType()) {
3910 // Cast to void allows any expr type.
Anders Carlssonebeaf202009-10-16 02:35:04 +00003911 Kind = CastExpr::CK_ToVoid;
3912 return false;
3913 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003914
Eli Friedman8d438082010-07-17 20:43:49 +00003915 if (RequireCompleteType(TyR.getBegin(), castType,
3916 diag::err_typecheck_cast_to_incomplete))
3917 return true;
3918
Anders Carlssonebeaf202009-10-16 02:35:04 +00003919 if (!castType->isScalarType() && !castType->isVectorType()) {
Douglas Gregora4923eb2009-11-16 21:35:15 +00003920 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(castType, castExpr->getType()) &&
Seo Sanghyeoneff2cd52009-01-15 04:51:39 +00003921 (castType->isStructureType() || castType->isUnionType())) {
3922 // GCC struct/union extension: allow cast to self.
Eli Friedmanb1d796d2009-03-23 00:24:07 +00003923 // FIXME: Check that the cast destination type is complete.
Seo Sanghyeoneff2cd52009-01-15 04:51:39 +00003924 Diag(TyR.getBegin(), diag::ext_typecheck_cast_nonscalar)
3925 << castType << castExpr->getSourceRange();
Anders Carlsson4d8673b2009-08-07 23:22:37 +00003926 Kind = CastExpr::CK_NoOp;
Anders Carlssonc3516322009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003927 return false;
3928 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003929
Anders Carlssonc3516322009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003930 if (castType->isUnionType()) {
Seo Sanghyeoneff2cd52009-01-15 04:51:39 +00003931 // GCC cast to union extension
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003932 RecordDecl *RD = castType->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl();
Seo Sanghyeoneff2cd52009-01-15 04:51:39 +00003933 RecordDecl::field_iterator Field, FieldEnd;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis17945a02009-06-30 02:36:12 +00003934 for (Field = RD->field_begin(), FieldEnd = RD->field_end();
Seo Sanghyeoneff2cd52009-01-15 04:51:39 +00003935 Field != FieldEnd; ++Field) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003936 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(Field->getType(),
Douglas Gregora4923eb2009-11-16 21:35:15 +00003937 castExpr->getType())) {
Seo Sanghyeoneff2cd52009-01-15 04:51:39 +00003938 Diag(TyR.getBegin(), diag::ext_typecheck_cast_to_union)
3939 << castExpr->getSourceRange();
3940 break;
3941 }
3942 }
3943 if (Field == FieldEnd)
3944 return Diag(TyR.getBegin(), diag::err_typecheck_cast_to_union_no_type)
3945 << castExpr->getType() << castExpr->getSourceRange();
Anders Carlsson4d8673b2009-08-07 23:22:37 +00003946 Kind = CastExpr::CK_ToUnion;
Anders Carlssonc3516322009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003947 return false;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6c2dc4d2008-08-16 20:27:34 +00003948 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003949
Anders Carlssonc3516322009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003950 // Reject any other conversions to non-scalar types.
3951 return Diag(TyR.getBegin(), diag::err_typecheck_cond_expect_scalar)
3952 << castType << castExpr->getSourceRange();
3953 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003954
3955 if (!castExpr->getType()->isScalarType() &&
Anders Carlssonc3516322009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003956 !castExpr->getType()->isVectorType()) {
Chris Lattnerfa25bbb2008-11-19 05:08:23 +00003957 return Diag(castExpr->getLocStart(),
3958 diag::err_typecheck_expect_scalar_operand)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00003959 << castExpr->getType() << castExpr->getSourceRange();
Anders Carlssonc3516322009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003960 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003961
3962 if (castType->isExtVectorType())
Anders Carlsson16a89042009-10-16 05:23:41 +00003963 return CheckExtVectorCast(TyR, castType, castExpr, Kind);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003964
Anders Carlssonc3516322009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003965 if (castType->isVectorType())
3966 return CheckVectorCast(TyR, castType, castExpr->getType(), Kind);
3967 if (castExpr->getType()->isVectorType())
3968 return CheckVectorCast(TyR, castExpr->getType(), castType, Kind);
3969
Anders Carlsson16a89042009-10-16 05:23:41 +00003970 if (isa<ObjCSelectorExpr>(castExpr))
3971 return Diag(castExpr->getLocStart(), diag::err_cast_selector_expr);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003972
Anders Carlssonc3516322009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003973 if (!castType->isArithmeticType()) {
Eli Friedman41826bb2009-05-01 02:23:58 +00003974 QualType castExprType = castExpr->getType();
Douglas Gregor9d3347a2010-06-16 00:35:25 +00003975 if (!castExprType->isIntegralType(Context) &&
Douglas Gregor2ade35e2010-06-16 00:17:44 +00003976 castExprType->isArithmeticType())
Eli Friedman41826bb2009-05-01 02:23:58 +00003977 return Diag(castExpr->getLocStart(),
3978 diag::err_cast_pointer_from_non_pointer_int)
3979 << castExprType << castExpr->getSourceRange();
3980 } else if (!castExpr->getType()->isArithmeticType()) {
Douglas Gregor9d3347a2010-06-16 00:35:25 +00003981 if (!castType->isIntegralType(Context) && castType->isArithmeticType())
Eli Friedman41826bb2009-05-01 02:23:58 +00003982 return Diag(castExpr->getLocStart(),
3983 diag::err_cast_pointer_to_non_pointer_int)
3984 << castType << castExpr->getSourceRange();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6c2dc4d2008-08-16 20:27:34 +00003985 }
Anders Carlsson82debc72009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003986
3987 Kind = getScalarCastKind(Context, castExpr->getType(), castType);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6c2dc4d2008-08-16 20:27:34 +00003988 return false;
3989}
3990
Anders Carlssonc3516322009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003991bool Sema::CheckVectorCast(SourceRange R, QualType VectorTy, QualType Ty,
3992 CastExpr::CastKind &Kind) {
Anders Carlssona64db8f2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00003993 assert(VectorTy->isVectorType() && "Not a vector type!");
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003994
Anders Carlssona64db8f2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00003995 if (Ty->isVectorType() || Ty->isIntegerType()) {
Chris Lattner98be4942008-03-05 18:54:05 +00003996 if (Context.getTypeSize(VectorTy) != Context.getTypeSize(Ty))
Anders Carlssona64db8f2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00003997 return Diag(R.getBegin(),
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003998 Ty->isVectorType() ?
Anders Carlssona64db8f2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00003999 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vectors :
Chris Lattnerfa25bbb2008-11-19 05:08:23 +00004000 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vector_and_integer)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00004001 << VectorTy << Ty << R;
Anders Carlssona64db8f2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00004002 } else
4003 return Diag(R.getBegin(),
Chris Lattnerfa25bbb2008-11-19 05:08:23 +00004004 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vector_and_scalar)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00004005 << VectorTy << Ty << R;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004006
Anders Carlssonc3516322009-10-16 02:48:28 +00004007 Kind = CastExpr::CK_BitCast;
Anders Carlssona64db8f2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00004008 return false;
4009}
4010
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004011bool Sema::CheckExtVectorCast(SourceRange R, QualType DestTy, Expr *&CastExpr,
Anders Carlsson16a89042009-10-16 05:23:41 +00004012 CastExpr::CastKind &Kind) {
Nate Begeman58d29a42009-06-26 00:50:28 +00004013 assert(DestTy->isExtVectorType() && "Not an extended vector type!");
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004014
Anders Carlsson16a89042009-10-16 05:23:41 +00004015 QualType SrcTy = CastExpr->getType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004016
Nate Begeman9b10da62009-06-27 22:05:55 +00004017 // If SrcTy is a VectorType, the total size must match to explicitly cast to
4018 // an ExtVectorType.
Nate Begeman58d29a42009-06-26 00:50:28 +00004019 if (SrcTy->isVectorType()) {
4020 if (Context.getTypeSize(DestTy) != Context.getTypeSize(SrcTy))
4021 return Diag(R.getBegin(),diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_ext_vectors)
4022 << DestTy << SrcTy << R;
Anders Carlsson16a89042009-10-16 05:23:41 +00004023 Kind = CastExpr::CK_BitCast;
Nate Begeman58d29a42009-06-26 00:50:28 +00004024 return false;
4025 }
4026
Nate Begeman1bd1f6e2009-06-28 02:36:38 +00004027 // All non-pointer scalars can be cast to ExtVector type. The appropriate
Nate Begeman58d29a42009-06-26 00:50:28 +00004028 // conversion will take place first from scalar to elt type, and then
4029 // splat from elt type to vector.
Nate Begeman1bd1f6e2009-06-28 02:36:38 +00004030 if (SrcTy->isPointerType())
4031 return Diag(R.getBegin(),
4032 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vector_and_scalar)
4033 << DestTy << SrcTy << R;
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004034
4035 QualType DestElemTy = DestTy->getAs<ExtVectorType>()->getElementType();
4036 ImpCastExprToType(CastExpr, DestElemTy,
4037 getScalarCastKind(Context, SrcTy, DestElemTy));
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004038
Anders Carlsson16a89042009-10-16 05:23:41 +00004039 Kind = CastExpr::CK_VectorSplat;
Nate Begeman58d29a42009-06-26 00:50:28 +00004040 return false;
4041}
4042
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004043Action::OwningExprResult
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004044Sema::ActOnCastExpr(Scope *S, SourceLocation LParenLoc, TypeTy *Ty,
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004045 SourceLocation RParenLoc, ExprArg Op) {
4046 assert((Ty != 0) && (Op.get() != 0) &&
4047 "ActOnCastExpr(): missing type or expr");
Steve Naroff16beff82007-07-16 23:25:18 +00004048
John McCall9d125032010-01-15 18:39:57 +00004049 TypeSourceInfo *castTInfo;
4050 QualType castType = GetTypeFromParser(Ty, &castTInfo);
4051 if (!castTInfo)
John McCall42f56b52010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004052 castTInfo = Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(castType);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004053
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004054 // If the Expr being casted is a ParenListExpr, handle it specially.
John McCallb042fdf2010-01-15 18:56:44 +00004055 Expr *castExpr = (Expr *)Op.get();
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004056 if (isa<ParenListExpr>(castExpr))
John McCall42f56b52010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004057 return ActOnCastOfParenListExpr(S, LParenLoc, RParenLoc, move(Op),
4058 castTInfo);
John McCallb042fdf2010-01-15 18:56:44 +00004059
4060 return BuildCStyleCastExpr(LParenLoc, castTInfo, RParenLoc, move(Op));
4061}
4062
4063Action::OwningExprResult
4064Sema::BuildCStyleCastExpr(SourceLocation LParenLoc, TypeSourceInfo *Ty,
4065 SourceLocation RParenLoc, ExprArg Op) {
4066 Expr *castExpr = static_cast<Expr*>(Op.get());
4067
John McCallb042fdf2010-01-15 18:56:44 +00004068 CastExpr::CastKind Kind = CastExpr::CK_Unknown;
John McCallf871d0c2010-08-07 06:22:56 +00004069 CXXCastPath BasePath;
John McCallb042fdf2010-01-15 18:56:44 +00004070 if (CheckCastTypes(SourceRange(LParenLoc, RParenLoc), Ty->getType(), castExpr,
Anders Carlsson5cf86ba2010-04-24 19:06:50 +00004071 Kind, BasePath))
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004072 return ExprError();
Anders Carlsson0aebc812009-09-09 21:33:21 +00004073
Douglas Gregord6e44a32010-04-16 22:09:46 +00004074 Op.release();
John McCallf871d0c2010-08-07 06:22:56 +00004075 return Owned(CStyleCastExpr::Create(Context,
Douglas Gregor63982352010-07-13 18:40:04 +00004076 Ty->getType().getNonLValueExprType(Context),
John McCallf871d0c2010-08-07 06:22:56 +00004077 Kind, castExpr, &BasePath, Ty,
4078 LParenLoc, RParenLoc));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004079}
4080
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004081/// This is not an AltiVec-style cast, so turn the ParenListExpr into a sequence
4082/// of comma binary operators.
4083Action::OwningExprResult
4084Sema::MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(Scope *S, ExprArg EA) {
4085 Expr *expr = EA.takeAs<Expr>();
4086 ParenListExpr *E = dyn_cast<ParenListExpr>(expr);
4087 if (!E)
4088 return Owned(expr);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004089
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004090 OwningExprResult Result(*this, E->getExpr(0));
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004091
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004092 for (unsigned i = 1, e = E->getNumExprs(); i != e && !Result.isInvalid(); ++i)
4093 Result = ActOnBinOp(S, E->getExprLoc(), tok::comma, move(Result),
4094 Owned(E->getExpr(i)));
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004095
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004096 return ActOnParenExpr(E->getLParenLoc(), E->getRParenLoc(), move(Result));
4097}
4098
4099Action::OwningExprResult
4100Sema::ActOnCastOfParenListExpr(Scope *S, SourceLocation LParenLoc,
4101 SourceLocation RParenLoc, ExprArg Op,
John McCall42f56b52010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004102 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo) {
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004103 ParenListExpr *PE = (ParenListExpr *)Op.get();
John McCall42f56b52010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004104 QualType Ty = TInfo->getType();
John Thompson8bb59a82010-06-30 22:55:51 +00004105 bool isAltiVecLiteral = false;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004106
John Thompson8bb59a82010-06-30 22:55:51 +00004107 // Check for an altivec literal,
4108 // i.e. all the elements are integer constants.
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004109 if (getLangOptions().AltiVec && Ty->isVectorType()) {
4110 if (PE->getNumExprs() == 0) {
4111 Diag(PE->getExprLoc(), diag::err_altivec_empty_initializer);
4112 return ExprError();
4113 }
John Thompson8bb59a82010-06-30 22:55:51 +00004114 if (PE->getNumExprs() == 1) {
4115 if (!PE->getExpr(0)->getType()->isVectorType())
4116 isAltiVecLiteral = true;
4117 }
4118 else
4119 isAltiVecLiteral = true;
4120 }
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004121
John Thompson8bb59a82010-06-30 22:55:51 +00004122 // If this is an altivec initializer, '(' type ')' '(' init, ..., init ')'
4123 // then handle it as such.
4124 if (isAltiVecLiteral) {
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004125 llvm::SmallVector<Expr *, 8> initExprs;
4126 for (unsigned i = 0, e = PE->getNumExprs(); i != e; ++i)
4127 initExprs.push_back(PE->getExpr(i));
4128
4129 // FIXME: This means that pretty-printing the final AST will produce curly
4130 // braces instead of the original commas.
4131 Op.release();
Ted Kremenek709210f2010-04-13 23:39:13 +00004132 InitListExpr *E = new (Context) InitListExpr(Context, LParenLoc,
4133 &initExprs[0],
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004134 initExprs.size(), RParenLoc);
4135 E->setType(Ty);
John McCall42f56b52010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004136 return BuildCompoundLiteralExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, RParenLoc, Owned(E));
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004137 } else {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004138 // This is not an AltiVec-style cast, so turn the ParenListExpr into a
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004139 // sequence of BinOp comma operators.
4140 Op = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, move(Op));
John McCall42f56b52010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004141 return BuildCStyleCastExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, RParenLoc, move(Op));
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004142 }
4143}
4144
Fariborz Jahanianf88f7ab2009-11-25 01:26:41 +00004145Action::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnParenOrParenListExpr(SourceLocation L,
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004146 SourceLocation R,
Fariborz Jahanianf88f7ab2009-11-25 01:26:41 +00004147 MultiExprArg Val,
4148 TypeTy *TypeOfCast) {
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004149 unsigned nexprs = Val.size();
4150 Expr **exprs = reinterpret_cast<Expr**>(Val.release());
Fariborz Jahanianf88f7ab2009-11-25 01:26:41 +00004151 assert((exprs != 0) && "ActOnParenOrParenListExpr() missing expr list");
4152 Expr *expr;
4153 if (nexprs == 1 && TypeOfCast && !TypeIsVectorType(TypeOfCast))
4154 expr = new (Context) ParenExpr(L, R, exprs[0]);
4155 else
4156 expr = new (Context) ParenListExpr(Context, L, exprs, nexprs, R);
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004157 return Owned(expr);
4158}
4159
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00004160/// Note that lhs is not null here, even if this is the gnu "x ?: y" extension.
4161/// In that case, lhs = cond.
Chris Lattnera119a3b2009-02-18 04:38:20 +00004162/// C99 6.5.15
4163QualType Sema::CheckConditionalOperands(Expr *&Cond, Expr *&LHS, Expr *&RHS,
4164 SourceLocation QuestionLoc) {
Sebastian Redl3201f6b2009-04-16 17:51:27 +00004165 // C++ is sufficiently different to merit its own checker.
4166 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
4167 return CXXCheckConditionalOperands(Cond, LHS, RHS, QuestionLoc);
4168
Chris Lattnerefdc39d2009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004169 UsualUnaryConversions(Cond);
4170 UsualUnaryConversions(LHS);
4171 UsualUnaryConversions(RHS);
4172 QualType CondTy = Cond->getType();
4173 QualType LHSTy = LHS->getType();
4174 QualType RHSTy = RHS->getType();
Steve Naroffc80b4ee2007-07-16 21:54:35 +00004175
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004176 // first, check the condition.
Sebastian Redl3201f6b2009-04-16 17:51:27 +00004177 if (!CondTy->isScalarType()) { // C99 6.5.15p2
4178 Diag(Cond->getLocStart(), diag::err_typecheck_cond_expect_scalar)
4179 << CondTy;
4180 return QualType();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004181 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004182
Chris Lattner70d67a92008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004183 // Now check the two expressions.
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004184 if (LHSTy->isVectorType() || RHSTy->isVectorType())
4185 return CheckVectorOperands(QuestionLoc, LHS, RHS);
Douglas Gregor898574e2008-12-05 23:32:09 +00004186
Chris Lattner70d67a92008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004187 // If both operands have arithmetic type, do the usual arithmetic conversions
4188 // to find a common type: C99 6.5.15p3,5.
Chris Lattnerefdc39d2009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004189 if (LHSTy->isArithmeticType() && RHSTy->isArithmeticType()) {
4190 UsualArithmeticConversions(LHS, RHS);
4191 return LHS->getType();
Steve Naroffa4332e22007-07-17 00:58:39 +00004192 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004193
Chris Lattner70d67a92008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004194 // If both operands are the same structure or union type, the result is that
4195 // type.
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004196 if (const RecordType *LHSRT = LHSTy->getAs<RecordType>()) { // C99 6.5.15p3
4197 if (const RecordType *RHSRT = RHSTy->getAs<RecordType>())
Chris Lattnera21ddb32007-11-26 01:40:58 +00004198 if (LHSRT->getDecl() == RHSRT->getDecl())
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004199 // "If both the operands have structure or union type, the result has
Chris Lattner70d67a92008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004200 // that type." This implies that CV qualifiers are dropped.
Chris Lattnerefdc39d2009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004201 return LHSTy.getUnqualifiedType();
Eli Friedmanb1d796d2009-03-23 00:24:07 +00004202 // FIXME: Type of conditional expression must be complete in C mode.
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004203 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004204
Chris Lattner70d67a92008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004205 // C99 6.5.15p5: "If both operands have void type, the result has void type."
Steve Naroffe701c0a2008-05-12 21:44:38 +00004206 // The following || allows only one side to be void (a GCC-ism).
Chris Lattnerefdc39d2009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004207 if (LHSTy->isVoidType() || RHSTy->isVoidType()) {
4208 if (!LHSTy->isVoidType())
4209 Diag(RHS->getLocStart(), diag::ext_typecheck_cond_one_void)
4210 << RHS->getSourceRange();
4211 if (!RHSTy->isVoidType())
4212 Diag(LHS->getLocStart(), diag::ext_typecheck_cond_one_void)
4213 << LHS->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004214 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, Context.VoidTy, CastExpr::CK_ToVoid);
4215 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, Context.VoidTy, CastExpr::CK_ToVoid);
Eli Friedman0e724012008-06-04 19:47:51 +00004216 return Context.VoidTy;
Steve Naroffe701c0a2008-05-12 21:44:38 +00004217 }
Steve Naroffb6d54e52008-01-08 01:11:38 +00004218 // C99 6.5.15p6 - "if one operand is a null pointer constant, the result has
4219 // the type of the other operand."
Steve Naroff58f9f2c2009-07-14 18:25:06 +00004220 if ((LHSTy->isAnyPointerType() || LHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) &&
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00004221 RHS->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004222 // promote the null to a pointer.
4223 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_Unknown);
Chris Lattnerefdc39d2009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004224 return LHSTy;
Steve Naroffb6d54e52008-01-08 01:11:38 +00004225 }
Steve Naroff58f9f2c2009-07-14 18:25:06 +00004226 if ((RHSTy->isAnyPointerType() || RHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) &&
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00004227 LHS->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004228 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CastExpr::CK_Unknown);
Chris Lattnerefdc39d2009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004229 return RHSTy;
Steve Naroffb6d54e52008-01-08 01:11:38 +00004230 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004231
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004232 // All objective-c pointer type analysis is done here.
4233 QualType compositeType = FindCompositeObjCPointerType(LHS, RHS,
4234 QuestionLoc);
4235 if (!compositeType.isNull())
4236 return compositeType;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004237
4238
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004239 // Handle block pointer types.
4240 if (LHSTy->isBlockPointerType() || RHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) {
4241 if (!LHSTy->isBlockPointerType() || !RHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) {
4242 if (LHSTy->isVoidPointerType() || RHSTy->isVoidPointerType()) {
4243 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(Context.VoidTy);
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004244 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4245 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004246 return destType;
4247 }
4248 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_typecheck_cond_incompatible_operands)
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004249 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004250 return QualType();
Mike Stumpdd3e1662009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004251 }
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004252 // We have 2 block pointer types.
4253 if (Context.getCanonicalType(LHSTy) == Context.getCanonicalType(RHSTy)) {
4254 // Two identical block pointer types are always compatible.
Mike Stumpdd3e1662009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004255 return LHSTy;
4256 }
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004257 // The block pointer types aren't identical, continue checking.
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004258 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4259 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004260
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004261 if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(lhptee.getUnqualifiedType(),
4262 rhptee.getUnqualifiedType())) {
Mike Stumpdd3e1662009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004263 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::warn_typecheck_cond_incompatible_pointers)
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004264 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
Mike Stumpdd3e1662009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004265 // In this situation, we assume void* type. No especially good
4266 // reason, but this is what gcc does, and we do have to pick
4267 // to get a consistent AST.
4268 QualType incompatTy = Context.getPointerType(Context.VoidTy);
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004269 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, incompatTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4270 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, incompatTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Mike Stumpdd3e1662009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004271 return incompatTy;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004272 }
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004273 // The block pointer types are compatible.
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004274 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4275 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff91588042009-04-08 17:05:15 +00004276 return LHSTy;
4277 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004278
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004279 // Check constraints for C object pointers types (C99 6.5.15p3,6).
4280 if (LHSTy->isPointerType() && RHSTy->isPointerType()) {
4281 // get the "pointed to" types
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004282 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4283 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004284
4285 // ignore qualifiers on void (C99 6.5.15p3, clause 6)
4286 if (lhptee->isVoidType() && rhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType()) {
4287 // Figure out necessary qualifiers (C99 6.5.15p6)
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004288 QualType destPointee
4289 = Context.getQualifiedType(lhptee, rhptee.getQualifiers());
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004290 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(destPointee);
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004291 // Add qualifiers if necessary.
4292 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_NoOp);
4293 // Promote to void*.
4294 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004295 return destType;
4296 }
4297 if (rhptee->isVoidType() && lhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType()) {
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004298 QualType destPointee
4299 = Context.getQualifiedType(rhptee, lhptee.getQualifiers());
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004300 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(destPointee);
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004301 // Add qualifiers if necessary.
Eli Friedman16fea9b2009-11-17 01:22:05 +00004302 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_NoOp);
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004303 // Promote to void*.
Eli Friedman16fea9b2009-11-17 01:22:05 +00004304 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004305 return destType;
4306 }
4307
4308 if (Context.getCanonicalType(LHSTy) == Context.getCanonicalType(RHSTy)) {
4309 // Two identical pointer types are always compatible.
4310 return LHSTy;
4311 }
4312 if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(lhptee.getUnqualifiedType(),
4313 rhptee.getUnqualifiedType())) {
4314 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::warn_typecheck_cond_incompatible_pointers)
4315 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
4316 // In this situation, we assume void* type. No especially good
4317 // reason, but this is what gcc does, and we do have to pick
4318 // to get a consistent AST.
4319 QualType incompatTy = Context.getPointerType(Context.VoidTy);
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004320 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, incompatTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4321 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, incompatTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004322 return incompatTy;
4323 }
4324 // The pointer types are compatible.
4325 // C99 6.5.15p6: If both operands are pointers to compatible types *or* to
4326 // differently qualified versions of compatible types, the result type is
4327 // a pointer to an appropriately qualified version of the *composite*
4328 // type.
4329 // FIXME: Need to calculate the composite type.
4330 // FIXME: Need to add qualifiers
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004331 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4332 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004333 return LHSTy;
4334 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004335
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004336 // GCC compatibility: soften pointer/integer mismatch.
4337 if (RHSTy->isPointerType() && LHSTy->isIntegerType()) {
4338 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::warn_typecheck_cond_pointer_integer_mismatch)
4339 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004340 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CastExpr::CK_IntegralToPointer);
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004341 return RHSTy;
4342 }
4343 if (LHSTy->isPointerType() && RHSTy->isIntegerType()) {
4344 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::warn_typecheck_cond_pointer_integer_mismatch)
4345 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004346 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_IntegralToPointer);
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004347 return LHSTy;
4348 }
Daniel Dunbar5e155f02008-09-11 23:12:46 +00004349
Chris Lattner70d67a92008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004350 // Otherwise, the operands are not compatible.
Chris Lattnerefdc39d2009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004351 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_typecheck_cond_incompatible_operands)
4352 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004353 return QualType();
4354}
4355
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004356/// FindCompositeObjCPointerType - Helper method to find composite type of
4357/// two objective-c pointer types of the two input expressions.
4358QualType Sema::FindCompositeObjCPointerType(Expr *&LHS, Expr *&RHS,
4359 SourceLocation QuestionLoc) {
4360 QualType LHSTy = LHS->getType();
4361 QualType RHSTy = RHS->getType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004362
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004363 // Handle things like Class and struct objc_class*. Here we case the result
4364 // to the pseudo-builtin, because that will be implicitly cast back to the
4365 // redefinition type if an attempt is made to access its fields.
4366 if (LHSTy->isObjCClassType() &&
4367 (RHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType)) {
4368 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4369 return LHSTy;
4370 }
4371 if (RHSTy->isObjCClassType() &&
4372 (LHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType)) {
4373 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4374 return RHSTy;
4375 }
4376 // And the same for struct objc_object* / id
4377 if (LHSTy->isObjCIdType() &&
4378 (RHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCIdRedefinitionType)) {
4379 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4380 return LHSTy;
4381 }
4382 if (RHSTy->isObjCIdType() &&
4383 (LHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCIdRedefinitionType)) {
4384 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4385 return RHSTy;
4386 }
4387 // And the same for struct objc_selector* / SEL
4388 if (Context.isObjCSelType(LHSTy) &&
4389 (RHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCSelRedefinitionType)) {
4390 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4391 return LHSTy;
4392 }
4393 if (Context.isObjCSelType(RHSTy) &&
4394 (LHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCSelRedefinitionType)) {
4395 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4396 return RHSTy;
4397 }
4398 // Check constraints for Objective-C object pointers types.
4399 if (LHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType() && RHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004400
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004401 if (Context.getCanonicalType(LHSTy) == Context.getCanonicalType(RHSTy)) {
4402 // Two identical object pointer types are always compatible.
4403 return LHSTy;
4404 }
4405 const ObjCObjectPointerType *LHSOPT = LHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
4406 const ObjCObjectPointerType *RHSOPT = RHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
4407 QualType compositeType = LHSTy;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004408
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004409 // If both operands are interfaces and either operand can be
4410 // assigned to the other, use that type as the composite
4411 // type. This allows
4412 // xxx ? (A*) a : (B*) b
4413 // where B is a subclass of A.
4414 //
4415 // Additionally, as for assignment, if either type is 'id'
4416 // allow silent coercion. Finally, if the types are
4417 // incompatible then make sure to use 'id' as the composite
4418 // type so the result is acceptable for sending messages to.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004419
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004420 // FIXME: Consider unifying with 'areComparableObjCPointerTypes'.
4421 // It could return the composite type.
4422 if (Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(LHSOPT, RHSOPT)) {
4423 compositeType = RHSOPT->isObjCBuiltinType() ? RHSTy : LHSTy;
4424 } else if (Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(RHSOPT, LHSOPT)) {
4425 compositeType = LHSOPT->isObjCBuiltinType() ? LHSTy : RHSTy;
4426 } else if ((LHSTy->isObjCQualifiedIdType() ||
4427 RHSTy->isObjCQualifiedIdType()) &&
4428 Context.ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible(LHSTy, RHSTy, true)) {
4429 // Need to handle "id<xx>" explicitly.
4430 // GCC allows qualified id and any Objective-C type to devolve to
4431 // id. Currently localizing to here until clear this should be
4432 // part of ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible.
4433 compositeType = Context.getObjCIdType();
4434 } else if (LHSTy->isObjCIdType() || RHSTy->isObjCIdType()) {
4435 compositeType = Context.getObjCIdType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004436 } else if (!(compositeType =
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004437 Context.areCommonBaseCompatible(LHSOPT, RHSOPT)).isNull())
4438 ;
4439 else {
4440 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::ext_typecheck_cond_incompatible_operands)
4441 << LHSTy << RHSTy
4442 << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
4443 QualType incompatTy = Context.getObjCIdType();
4444 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, incompatTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4445 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, incompatTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4446 return incompatTy;
4447 }
4448 // The object pointer types are compatible.
4449 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, compositeType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4450 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, compositeType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4451 return compositeType;
4452 }
4453 // Check Objective-C object pointer types and 'void *'
4454 if (LHSTy->isVoidPointerType() && RHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
4455 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4456 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4457 QualType destPointee
4458 = Context.getQualifiedType(lhptee, rhptee.getQualifiers());
4459 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(destPointee);
4460 // Add qualifiers if necessary.
4461 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_NoOp);
4462 // Promote to void*.
4463 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4464 return destType;
4465 }
4466 if (LHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType() && RHSTy->isVoidPointerType()) {
4467 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4468 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4469 QualType destPointee
4470 = Context.getQualifiedType(rhptee, lhptee.getQualifiers());
4471 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(destPointee);
4472 // Add qualifiers if necessary.
4473 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_NoOp);
4474 // Promote to void*.
4475 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4476 return destType;
4477 }
4478 return QualType();
4479}
4480
Steve Narofff69936d2007-09-16 03:34:24 +00004481/// ActOnConditionalOp - Parse a ?: operation. Note that 'LHS' may be null
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004482/// in the case of a the GNU conditional expr extension.
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004483Action::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnConditionalOp(SourceLocation QuestionLoc,
4484 SourceLocation ColonLoc,
4485 ExprArg Cond, ExprArg LHS,
4486 ExprArg RHS) {
4487 Expr *CondExpr = (Expr *) Cond.get();
4488 Expr *LHSExpr = (Expr *) LHS.get(), *RHSExpr = (Expr *) RHS.get();
Chris Lattnera21ddb32007-11-26 01:40:58 +00004489
4490 // If this is the gnu "x ?: y" extension, analyze the types as though the LHS
4491 // was the condition.
4492 bool isLHSNull = LHSExpr == 0;
4493 if (isLHSNull)
4494 LHSExpr = CondExpr;
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004495
4496 QualType result = CheckConditionalOperands(CondExpr, LHSExpr,
Chris Lattner26824902007-07-16 21:39:03 +00004497 RHSExpr, QuestionLoc);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004498 if (result.isNull())
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004499 return ExprError();
4500
4501 Cond.release();
4502 LHS.release();
4503 RHS.release();
Douglas Gregor47e1f7c2009-08-26 14:37:04 +00004504 return Owned(new (Context) ConditionalOperator(CondExpr, QuestionLoc,
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00004505 isLHSNull ? 0 : LHSExpr,
Douglas Gregor47e1f7c2009-08-26 14:37:04 +00004506 ColonLoc, RHSExpr, result));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004507}
4508
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004509// CheckPointerTypesForAssignment - This is a very tricky routine (despite
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004510// being closely modeled after the C99 spec:-). The odd characteristic of this
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004511// routine is it effectively iqnores the qualifiers on the top level pointee.
4512// This circumvents the usual type rules specified in 6.2.7p1 & 6.7.5.[1-3].
4513// FIXME: add a couple examples in this comment.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004514Sema::AssignConvertType
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004515Sema::CheckPointerTypesForAssignment(QualType lhsType, QualType rhsType) {
4516 QualType lhptee, rhptee;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004517
David Chisnall0f436562009-08-17 16:35:33 +00004518 if ((lhsType->isObjCClassType() &&
4519 (rhsType.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType)) ||
4520 (rhsType->isObjCClassType() &&
4521 (lhsType.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType))) {
4522 return Compatible;
4523 }
4524
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004525 // get the "pointed to" type (ignoring qualifiers at the top level)
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004526 lhptee = lhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4527 rhptee = rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004528
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004529 // make sure we operate on the canonical type
Chris Lattnerb77792e2008-07-26 22:17:49 +00004530 lhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(lhptee);
4531 rhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(rhptee);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004532
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004533 AssignConvertType ConvTy = Compatible;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004534
4535 // C99 6.5.16.1p1: This following citation is common to constraints
4536 // 3 & 4 (below). ...and the type *pointed to* by the left has all the
4537 // qualifiers of the type *pointed to* by the right;
Fariborz Jahanianf11284a2009-02-17 18:27:45 +00004538 // FIXME: Handle ExtQualType
Douglas Gregor98cd5992008-10-21 23:43:52 +00004539 if (!lhptee.isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(rhptee))
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004540 ConvTy = CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004541
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004542 // C99 6.5.16.1p1 (constraint 4): If one operand is a pointer to an object or
4543 // incomplete type and the other is a pointer to a qualified or unqualified
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004544 // version of void...
Chris Lattnerbfe639e2008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004545 if (lhptee->isVoidType()) {
Chris Lattnerd805bec2008-04-02 06:59:01 +00004546 if (rhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType())
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004547 return ConvTy;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004548
Chris Lattnerbfe639e2008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004549 // As an extension, we allow cast to/from void* to function pointer.
Chris Lattnerd805bec2008-04-02 06:59:01 +00004550 assert(rhptee->isFunctionType());
4551 return FunctionVoidPointer;
Chris Lattnerbfe639e2008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004552 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004553
Chris Lattnerbfe639e2008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004554 if (rhptee->isVoidType()) {
Chris Lattnerd805bec2008-04-02 06:59:01 +00004555 if (lhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType())
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004556 return ConvTy;
Chris Lattnerbfe639e2008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004557
4558 // As an extension, we allow cast to/from void* to function pointer.
Chris Lattnerd805bec2008-04-02 06:59:01 +00004559 assert(lhptee->isFunctionType());
4560 return FunctionVoidPointer;
Chris Lattnerbfe639e2008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004561 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004562 // C99 6.5.16.1p1 (constraint 3): both operands are pointers to qualified or
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004563 // unqualified versions of compatible types, ...
Eli Friedmanf05c05d2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004564 lhptee = lhptee.getUnqualifiedType();
4565 rhptee = rhptee.getUnqualifiedType();
4566 if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(lhptee, rhptee)) {
4567 // Check if the pointee types are compatible ignoring the sign.
4568 // We explicitly check for char so that we catch "char" vs
4569 // "unsigned char" on systems where "char" is unsigned.
Chris Lattner6a2b9262009-10-17 20:33:28 +00004570 if (lhptee->isCharType())
Eli Friedmanf05c05d2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004571 lhptee = Context.UnsignedCharTy;
Douglas Gregorf6094622010-07-23 15:58:24 +00004572 else if (lhptee->hasSignedIntegerRepresentation())
Eli Friedmanf05c05d2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004573 lhptee = Context.getCorrespondingUnsignedType(lhptee);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004574
Chris Lattner6a2b9262009-10-17 20:33:28 +00004575 if (rhptee->isCharType())
Eli Friedmanf05c05d2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004576 rhptee = Context.UnsignedCharTy;
Douglas Gregorf6094622010-07-23 15:58:24 +00004577 else if (rhptee->hasSignedIntegerRepresentation())
Eli Friedmanf05c05d2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004578 rhptee = Context.getCorrespondingUnsignedType(rhptee);
Chris Lattner6a2b9262009-10-17 20:33:28 +00004579
Eli Friedmanf05c05d2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004580 if (lhptee == rhptee) {
4581 // Types are compatible ignoring the sign. Qualifier incompatibility
4582 // takes priority over sign incompatibility because the sign
4583 // warning can be disabled.
4584 if (ConvTy != Compatible)
4585 return ConvTy;
4586 return IncompatiblePointerSign;
4587 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004588
Fariborz Jahanian36a862f2009-11-07 20:20:40 +00004589 // If we are a multi-level pointer, it's possible that our issue is simply
4590 // one of qualification - e.g. char ** -> const char ** is not allowed. If
4591 // the eventual target type is the same and the pointers have the same
4592 // level of indirection, this must be the issue.
4593 if (lhptee->isPointerType() && rhptee->isPointerType()) {
4594 do {
4595 lhptee = lhptee->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4596 rhptee = rhptee->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004597
Fariborz Jahanian36a862f2009-11-07 20:20:40 +00004598 lhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(lhptee);
4599 rhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(rhptee);
4600 } while (lhptee->isPointerType() && rhptee->isPointerType());
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004601
Douglas Gregora4923eb2009-11-16 21:35:15 +00004602 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(lhptee, rhptee))
Sean Huntc9132b62009-11-08 07:46:34 +00004603 return IncompatibleNestedPointerQualifiers;
Fariborz Jahanian36a862f2009-11-07 20:20:40 +00004604 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004605
Eli Friedmanf05c05d2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004606 // General pointer incompatibility takes priority over qualifiers.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004607 return IncompatiblePointer;
Eli Friedmanf05c05d2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004608 }
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004609 return ConvTy;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004610}
4611
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004612/// CheckBlockPointerTypesForAssignment - This routine determines whether two
4613/// block pointer types are compatible or whether a block and normal pointer
4614/// are compatible. It is more restrict than comparing two function pointer
4615// types.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004616Sema::AssignConvertType
4617Sema::CheckBlockPointerTypesForAssignment(QualType lhsType,
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004618 QualType rhsType) {
4619 QualType lhptee, rhptee;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004620
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004621 // get the "pointed to" type (ignoring qualifiers at the top level)
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004622 lhptee = lhsType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4623 rhptee = rhsType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004624
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004625 // make sure we operate on the canonical type
4626 lhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(lhptee);
4627 rhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(rhptee);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004628
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004629 AssignConvertType ConvTy = Compatible;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004630
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004631 // For blocks we enforce that qualifiers are identical.
Douglas Gregora4923eb2009-11-16 21:35:15 +00004632 if (lhptee.getLocalCVRQualifiers() != rhptee.getLocalCVRQualifiers())
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004633 ConvTy = CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004634
Fariborz Jahanian132f2a22010-03-17 00:20:01 +00004635 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
4636 if (!Context.typesAreBlockPointerCompatible(lhsType, rhsType))
4637 return IncompatibleBlockPointer;
4638 }
4639 else if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(lhptee, rhptee))
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004640 return IncompatibleBlockPointer;
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004641 return ConvTy;
4642}
4643
Fariborz Jahanian52efc3f2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004644/// CheckObjCPointerTypesForAssignment - Compares two objective-c pointer types
4645/// for assignment compatibility.
4646Sema::AssignConvertType
4647Sema::CheckObjCPointerTypesForAssignment(QualType lhsType, QualType rhsType) {
Fariborz Jahaniand4c60902010-03-19 18:06:10 +00004648 if (lhsType->isObjCBuiltinType()) {
4649 // Class is not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Fariborz Jahanian528adb12010-03-24 21:00:27 +00004650 if (lhsType->isObjCClassType() && !rhsType->isObjCBuiltinType() &&
4651 !rhsType->isObjCQualifiedClassType())
Fariborz Jahaniand4c60902010-03-19 18:06:10 +00004652 return IncompatiblePointer;
Fariborz Jahanian52efc3f2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004653 return Compatible;
Fariborz Jahaniand4c60902010-03-19 18:06:10 +00004654 }
4655 if (rhsType->isObjCBuiltinType()) {
4656 // Class is not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Fariborz Jahanian528adb12010-03-24 21:00:27 +00004657 if (rhsType->isObjCClassType() && !lhsType->isObjCBuiltinType() &&
4658 !lhsType->isObjCQualifiedClassType())
Fariborz Jahaniand4c60902010-03-19 18:06:10 +00004659 return IncompatiblePointer;
4660 return Compatible;
4661 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004662 QualType lhptee =
Fariborz Jahanian52efc3f2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004663 lhsType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004664 QualType rhptee =
Fariborz Jahanian52efc3f2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004665 rhsType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4666 // make sure we operate on the canonical type
4667 lhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(lhptee);
4668 rhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(rhptee);
4669 if (!lhptee.isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(rhptee))
4670 return CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004671
Fariborz Jahanian52efc3f2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004672 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(lhsType, rhsType))
4673 return Compatible;
4674 if (lhsType->isObjCQualifiedIdType() || rhsType->isObjCQualifiedIdType())
4675 return IncompatibleObjCQualifiedId;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004676 return IncompatiblePointer;
Fariborz Jahanian52efc3f2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004677}
4678
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004679/// CheckAssignmentConstraints (C99 6.5.16) - This routine currently
4680/// has code to accommodate several GCC extensions when type checking
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004681/// pointers. Here are some objectionable examples that GCC considers warnings:
4682///
4683/// int a, *pint;
4684/// short *pshort;
4685/// struct foo *pfoo;
4686///
4687/// pint = pshort; // warning: assignment from incompatible pointer type
4688/// a = pint; // warning: assignment makes integer from pointer without a cast
4689/// pint = a; // warning: assignment makes pointer from integer without a cast
4690/// pint = pfoo; // warning: assignment from incompatible pointer type
4691///
4692/// As a result, the code for dealing with pointers is more complex than the
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004693/// C99 spec dictates.
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004694///
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004695Sema::AssignConvertType
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004696Sema::CheckAssignmentConstraints(QualType lhsType, QualType rhsType) {
Chris Lattnerfc144e22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004697 // Get canonical types. We're not formatting these types, just comparing
4698 // them.
Chris Lattnerb77792e2008-07-26 22:17:49 +00004699 lhsType = Context.getCanonicalType(lhsType).getUnqualifiedType();
4700 rhsType = Context.getCanonicalType(rhsType).getUnqualifiedType();
Eli Friedmanf8f873d2008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004701
4702 if (lhsType == rhsType)
Chris Lattnerd2656dd2008-01-07 17:51:46 +00004703 return Compatible; // Common case: fast path an exact match.
Steve Naroff700204c2007-07-24 21:46:40 +00004704
David Chisnall0f436562009-08-17 16:35:33 +00004705 if ((lhsType->isObjCClassType() &&
4706 (rhsType.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType)) ||
4707 (rhsType->isObjCClassType() &&
4708 (lhsType.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType))) {
4709 return Compatible;
4710 }
4711
Douglas Gregor9d293df2008-10-28 00:22:11 +00004712 // If the left-hand side is a reference type, then we are in a
4713 // (rare!) case where we've allowed the use of references in C,
4714 // e.g., as a parameter type in a built-in function. In this case,
4715 // just make sure that the type referenced is compatible with the
4716 // right-hand side type. The caller is responsible for adjusting
4717 // lhsType so that the resulting expression does not have reference
4718 // type.
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004719 if (const ReferenceType *lhsTypeRef = lhsType->getAs<ReferenceType>()) {
Douglas Gregor9d293df2008-10-28 00:22:11 +00004720 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(lhsTypeRef->getPointeeType(), rhsType))
Anders Carlsson793680e2007-10-12 23:56:29 +00004721 return Compatible;
Chris Lattnerfc144e22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004722 return Incompatible;
Fariborz Jahanian411f3732007-12-19 17:45:58 +00004723 }
Nate Begeman1bd1f6e2009-06-28 02:36:38 +00004724 // Allow scalar to ExtVector assignments, and assignments of an ExtVector type
4725 // to the same ExtVector type.
4726 if (lhsType->isExtVectorType()) {
4727 if (rhsType->isExtVectorType())
4728 return lhsType == rhsType ? Compatible : Incompatible;
Douglas Gregor00619622010-06-22 23:41:02 +00004729 if (rhsType->isArithmeticType())
Nate Begeman1bd1f6e2009-06-28 02:36:38 +00004730 return Compatible;
4731 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004732
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00004733 if (lhsType->isVectorType() || rhsType->isVectorType()) {
Douglas Gregor255210e2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00004734 if (lhsType->isVectorType() && rhsType->isVectorType()) {
4735 // If we are allowing lax vector conversions, and LHS and RHS are both
4736 // vectors, the total size only needs to be the same. This is a bitcast;
4737 // no bits are changed but the result type is different.
4738 if (getLangOptions().LaxVectorConversions &&
4739 (Context.getTypeSize(lhsType) == Context.getTypeSize(rhsType)))
Anders Carlssonb0f90cc2009-01-30 23:17:46 +00004740 return IncompatibleVectors;
Douglas Gregor255210e2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00004741
4742 // Allow assignments of an AltiVec vector type to an equivalent GCC
4743 // vector type and vice versa
4744 if (Context.areCompatibleVectorTypes(lhsType, rhsType))
4745 return Compatible;
Chris Lattnere8b3e962008-01-04 23:32:24 +00004746 }
4747 return Incompatible;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004748 }
Eli Friedmanf8f873d2008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004749
Douglas Gregor88623ad2010-05-23 21:53:47 +00004750 if (lhsType->isArithmeticType() && rhsType->isArithmeticType() &&
4751 !(getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && lhsType->isEnumeralType()))
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004752 return Compatible;
Eli Friedmanf8f873d2008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004753
Chris Lattner78eca282008-04-07 06:49:41 +00004754 if (isa<PointerType>(lhsType)) {
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004755 if (rhsType->isIntegerType())
Chris Lattnerb7b61152008-01-04 18:22:42 +00004756 return IntToPointer;
Eli Friedmanf8f873d2008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004757
Chris Lattner78eca282008-04-07 06:49:41 +00004758 if (isa<PointerType>(rhsType))
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004759 return CheckPointerTypesForAssignment(lhsType, rhsType);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004760
Steve Naroff67ef8ea2009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004761 // In general, C pointers are not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004762 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(rhsType)) {
Steve Naroff67ef8ea2009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004763 if (lhsType->isVoidPointerType()) // an exception to the rule.
4764 return Compatible;
4765 return IncompatiblePointer;
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004766 }
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004767 if (rhsType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()) {
4768 if (lhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Douglas Gregor63a94902008-11-27 00:44:28 +00004769 return Compatible;
Steve Naroffb4406862008-09-29 18:10:17 +00004770
4771 // Treat block pointers as objects.
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004772 if (getLangOptions().ObjC1 && lhsType->isObjCIdType())
Steve Naroffb4406862008-09-29 18:10:17 +00004773 return Compatible;
4774 }
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004775 return Incompatible;
4776 }
4777
4778 if (isa<BlockPointerType>(lhsType)) {
4779 if (rhsType->isIntegerType())
Eli Friedmand8f4f432009-02-25 04:20:42 +00004780 return IntToBlockPointer;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004781
Steve Naroffb4406862008-09-29 18:10:17 +00004782 // Treat block pointers as objects.
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004783 if (getLangOptions().ObjC1 && rhsType->isObjCIdType())
Steve Naroffb4406862008-09-29 18:10:17 +00004784 return Compatible;
4785
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004786 if (rhsType->isBlockPointerType())
4787 return CheckBlockPointerTypesForAssignment(lhsType, rhsType);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004788
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004789 if (const PointerType *RHSPT = rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004790 if (RHSPT->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Douglas Gregor63a94902008-11-27 00:44:28 +00004791 return Compatible;
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004792 }
Chris Lattnerfc144e22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004793 return Incompatible;
4794 }
4795
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004796 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(lhsType)) {
4797 if (rhsType->isIntegerType())
4798 return IntToPointer;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004799
Steve Naroff67ef8ea2009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004800 // In general, C pointers are not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004801 if (isa<PointerType>(rhsType)) {
Steve Naroff67ef8ea2009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004802 if (rhsType->isVoidPointerType()) // an exception to the rule.
4803 return Compatible;
4804 return IncompatiblePointer;
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004805 }
4806 if (rhsType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
Fariborz Jahanian52efc3f2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004807 return CheckObjCPointerTypesForAssignment(lhsType, rhsType);
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004808 }
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004809 if (const PointerType *RHSPT = rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004810 if (RHSPT->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
4811 return Compatible;
4812 }
4813 // Treat block pointers as objects.
4814 if (rhsType->isBlockPointerType())
4815 return Compatible;
4816 return Incompatible;
4817 }
Chris Lattner78eca282008-04-07 06:49:41 +00004818 if (isa<PointerType>(rhsType)) {
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004819 // C99 6.5.16.1p1: the left operand is _Bool and the right is a pointer.
Eli Friedmanf8f873d2008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004820 if (lhsType == Context.BoolTy)
4821 return Compatible;
4822
4823 if (lhsType->isIntegerType())
Chris Lattnerb7b61152008-01-04 18:22:42 +00004824 return PointerToInt;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004825
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004826 if (isa<PointerType>(lhsType))
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004827 return CheckPointerTypesForAssignment(lhsType, rhsType);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004828
4829 if (isa<BlockPointerType>(lhsType) &&
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004830 rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Douglas Gregor63a94902008-11-27 00:44:28 +00004831 return Compatible;
Chris Lattnerfc144e22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004832 return Incompatible;
Chris Lattnerfc144e22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004833 }
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004834 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(rhsType)) {
4835 // C99 6.5.16.1p1: the left operand is _Bool and the right is a pointer.
4836 if (lhsType == Context.BoolTy)
4837 return Compatible;
4838
4839 if (lhsType->isIntegerType())
4840 return PointerToInt;
4841
Steve Naroff67ef8ea2009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004842 // In general, C pointers are not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004843 if (isa<PointerType>(lhsType)) {
Steve Naroff67ef8ea2009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004844 if (lhsType->isVoidPointerType()) // an exception to the rule.
4845 return Compatible;
4846 return IncompatiblePointer;
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004847 }
4848 if (isa<BlockPointerType>(lhsType) &&
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004849 rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004850 return Compatible;
4851 return Incompatible;
4852 }
Eli Friedmanf8f873d2008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004853
Chris Lattnerfc144e22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004854 if (isa<TagType>(lhsType) && isa<TagType>(rhsType)) {
Chris Lattner78eca282008-04-07 06:49:41 +00004855 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(lhsType, rhsType))
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004856 return Compatible;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004857 }
4858 return Incompatible;
4859}
4860
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004861/// \brief Constructs a transparent union from an expression that is
4862/// used to initialize the transparent union.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004863static void ConstructTransparentUnion(ASTContext &C, Expr *&E,
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004864 QualType UnionType, FieldDecl *Field) {
4865 // Build an initializer list that designates the appropriate member
4866 // of the transparent union.
Ted Kremenek709210f2010-04-13 23:39:13 +00004867 InitListExpr *Initializer = new (C) InitListExpr(C, SourceLocation(),
Ted Kremenekba7bc552010-02-19 01:50:18 +00004868 &E, 1,
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004869 SourceLocation());
4870 Initializer->setType(UnionType);
4871 Initializer->setInitializedFieldInUnion(Field);
4872
4873 // Build a compound literal constructing a value of the transparent
4874 // union type from this initializer list.
John McCall42f56b52010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004875 TypeSourceInfo *unionTInfo = C.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(UnionType);
John McCall1d7d8d62010-01-19 22:33:45 +00004876 E = new (C) CompoundLiteralExpr(SourceLocation(), unionTInfo, UnionType,
John McCall42f56b52010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004877 Initializer, false);
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004878}
4879
4880Sema::AssignConvertType
4881Sema::CheckTransparentUnionArgumentConstraints(QualType ArgType, Expr *&rExpr) {
4882 QualType FromType = rExpr->getType();
4883
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004884 // If the ArgType is a Union type, we want to handle a potential
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004885 // transparent_union GCC extension.
4886 const RecordType *UT = ArgType->getAsUnionType();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis40b598e2009-06-30 02:34:44 +00004887 if (!UT || !UT->getDecl()->hasAttr<TransparentUnionAttr>())
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004888 return Incompatible;
4889
4890 // The field to initialize within the transparent union.
4891 RecordDecl *UD = UT->getDecl();
4892 FieldDecl *InitField = 0;
4893 // It's compatible if the expression matches any of the fields.
Argyrios Kyrtzidis17945a02009-06-30 02:36:12 +00004894 for (RecordDecl::field_iterator it = UD->field_begin(),
4895 itend = UD->field_end();
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004896 it != itend; ++it) {
4897 if (it->getType()->isPointerType()) {
4898 // If the transparent union contains a pointer type, we allow:
4899 // 1) void pointer
4900 // 2) null pointer constant
4901 if (FromType->isPointerType())
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004902 if (FromType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType()) {
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004903 ImpCastExprToType(rExpr, it->getType(), CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004904 InitField = *it;
4905 break;
4906 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004907
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004908 if (rExpr->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00004909 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004910 ImpCastExprToType(rExpr, it->getType(), CastExpr::CK_IntegralToPointer);
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004911 InitField = *it;
4912 break;
4913 }
4914 }
4915
4916 if (CheckAssignmentConstraints(it->getType(), rExpr->getType())
4917 == Compatible) {
4918 InitField = *it;
4919 break;
4920 }
4921 }
4922
4923 if (!InitField)
4924 return Incompatible;
4925
4926 ConstructTransparentUnion(Context, rExpr, ArgType, InitField);
4927 return Compatible;
4928}
4929
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004930Sema::AssignConvertType
Steve Naroff90045e82007-07-13 23:32:42 +00004931Sema::CheckSingleAssignmentConstraints(QualType lhsType, Expr *&rExpr) {
Douglas Gregor98cd5992008-10-21 23:43:52 +00004932 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
4933 if (!lhsType->isRecordType()) {
4934 // C++ 5.17p3: If the left operand is not of class type, the
4935 // expression is implicitly converted (C++ 4) to the
4936 // cv-unqualified type of the left operand.
Douglas Gregor45920e82008-12-19 17:40:08 +00004937 if (PerformImplicitConversion(rExpr, lhsType.getUnqualifiedType(),
Douglas Gregor68647482009-12-16 03:45:30 +00004938 AA_Assigning))
Douglas Gregor98cd5992008-10-21 23:43:52 +00004939 return Incompatible;
Chris Lattner2c4463f2009-04-12 09:02:39 +00004940 return Compatible;
Douglas Gregor98cd5992008-10-21 23:43:52 +00004941 }
4942
4943 // FIXME: Currently, we fall through and treat C++ classes like C
4944 // structures.
4945 }
4946
Steve Naroff529a4ad2007-11-27 17:58:44 +00004947 // C99 6.5.16.1p1: the left operand is a pointer and the right is
4948 // a null pointer constant.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004949 if ((lhsType->isPointerType() ||
4950 lhsType->isObjCObjectPointerType() ||
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004951 lhsType->isBlockPointerType())
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004952 && rExpr->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00004953 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004954 ImpCastExprToType(rExpr, lhsType, CastExpr::CK_Unknown);
Steve Naroff529a4ad2007-11-27 17:58:44 +00004955 return Compatible;
4956 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004957
Chris Lattner943140e2007-10-16 02:55:40 +00004958 // This check seems unnatural, however it is necessary to ensure the proper
Steve Naroff90045e82007-07-13 23:32:42 +00004959 // conversion of functions/arrays. If the conversion were done for all
Douglas Gregor02a24ee2009-11-03 16:56:39 +00004960 // DeclExpr's (created by ActOnIdExpression), it would mess up the unary
Nick Lewyckyc133e9e2010-08-05 06:27:49 +00004961 // expressions that suppress this implicit conversion (&, sizeof).
Chris Lattner943140e2007-10-16 02:55:40 +00004962 //
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004963 // Suppress this for references: C++ 8.5.3p5.
Chris Lattner943140e2007-10-16 02:55:40 +00004964 if (!lhsType->isReferenceType())
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +00004965 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(rExpr);
Steve Narofff1120de2007-08-24 22:33:52 +00004966
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004967 Sema::AssignConvertType result =
4968 CheckAssignmentConstraints(lhsType, rExpr->getType());
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004969
Steve Narofff1120de2007-08-24 22:33:52 +00004970 // C99 6.5.16.1p2: The value of the right operand is converted to the
4971 // type of the assignment expression.
Douglas Gregor9d293df2008-10-28 00:22:11 +00004972 // CheckAssignmentConstraints allows the left-hand side to be a reference,
4973 // so that we can use references in built-in functions even in C.
4974 // The getNonReferenceType() call makes sure that the resulting expression
4975 // does not have reference type.
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004976 if (result != Incompatible && rExpr->getType() != lhsType)
Douglas Gregor63982352010-07-13 18:40:04 +00004977 ImpCastExprToType(rExpr, lhsType.getNonLValueExprType(Context),
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004978 CastExpr::CK_Unknown);
Steve Narofff1120de2007-08-24 22:33:52 +00004979 return result;
Steve Naroff90045e82007-07-13 23:32:42 +00004980}
4981
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00004982QualType Sema::InvalidOperands(SourceLocation Loc, Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex) {
Chris Lattnerc9c7c4e2008-11-18 22:52:51 +00004983 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_invalid_operands)
Chris Lattner22caddc2008-11-23 09:13:29 +00004984 << lex->getType() << rex->getType()
Chris Lattnerc9c7c4e2008-11-18 22:52:51 +00004985 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattnerca5eede2007-12-12 05:47:28 +00004986 return QualType();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004987}
4988
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00004989QualType Sema::CheckVectorOperands(SourceLocation Loc, Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex) {
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004990 // For conversion purposes, we ignore any qualifiers.
Nate Begeman1330b0e2008-04-04 01:30:25 +00004991 // For example, "const float" and "float" are equivalent.
Chris Lattnerb77792e2008-07-26 22:17:49 +00004992 QualType lhsType =
4993 Context.getCanonicalType(lex->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
4994 QualType rhsType =
4995 Context.getCanonicalType(rex->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004996
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00004997 // If the vector types are identical, return.
Nate Begeman1330b0e2008-04-04 01:30:25 +00004998 if (lhsType == rhsType)
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004999 return lhsType;
Nate Begeman4119d1a2007-12-30 02:59:45 +00005000
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005001 // Handle the case of a vector & extvector type of the same size and element
5002 // type. It would be nice if we only had one vector type someday.
Anders Carlssonb0f90cc2009-01-30 23:17:46 +00005003 if (getLangOptions().LaxVectorConversions) {
5004 // FIXME: Should we warn here?
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00005005 if (const VectorType *LV = lhsType->getAs<VectorType>()) {
5006 if (const VectorType *RV = rhsType->getAs<VectorType>())
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005007 if (LV->getElementType() == RV->getElementType() &&
Anders Carlssonb0f90cc2009-01-30 23:17:46 +00005008 LV->getNumElements() == RV->getNumElements()) {
Douglas Gregor26bcf672010-05-19 03:21:00 +00005009 if (lhsType->isExtVectorType()) {
5010 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lhsType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
5011 return lhsType;
5012 }
5013
5014 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rhsType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
5015 return rhsType;
Anders Carlssonb0f90cc2009-01-30 23:17:46 +00005016 }
5017 }
5018 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005019
Douglas Gregor255210e2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00005020 // Handle the case of equivalent AltiVec and GCC vector types
5021 if (lhsType->isVectorType() && rhsType->isVectorType() &&
5022 Context.areCompatibleVectorTypes(lhsType, rhsType)) {
5023 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rhsType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
5024 return rhsType;
5025 }
5026
Nate Begeman1bd1f6e2009-06-28 02:36:38 +00005027 // Canonicalize the ExtVector to the LHS, remember if we swapped so we can
5028 // swap back (so that we don't reverse the inputs to a subtract, for instance.
5029 bool swapped = false;
5030 if (rhsType->isExtVectorType()) {
5031 swapped = true;
5032 std::swap(rex, lex);
5033 std::swap(rhsType, lhsType);
5034 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005035
Nate Begemandde25982009-06-28 19:12:57 +00005036 // Handle the case of an ext vector and scalar.
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00005037 if (const ExtVectorType *LV = lhsType->getAs<ExtVectorType>()) {
Nate Begeman1bd1f6e2009-06-28 02:36:38 +00005038 QualType EltTy = LV->getElementType();
Douglas Gregor9d3347a2010-06-16 00:35:25 +00005039 if (EltTy->isIntegralType(Context) && rhsType->isIntegralType(Context)) {
Nate Begeman1bd1f6e2009-06-28 02:36:38 +00005040 if (Context.getIntegerTypeOrder(EltTy, rhsType) >= 0) {
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005041 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lhsType, CastExpr::CK_IntegralCast);
Nate Begeman1bd1f6e2009-06-28 02:36:38 +00005042 if (swapped) std::swap(rex, lex);
5043 return lhsType;
5044 }
5045 }
5046 if (EltTy->isRealFloatingType() && rhsType->isScalarType() &&
5047 rhsType->isRealFloatingType()) {
5048 if (Context.getFloatingTypeOrder(EltTy, rhsType) >= 0) {
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005049 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lhsType, CastExpr::CK_FloatingCast);
Nate Begeman1bd1f6e2009-06-28 02:36:38 +00005050 if (swapped) std::swap(rex, lex);
5051 return lhsType;
5052 }
Nate Begeman4119d1a2007-12-30 02:59:45 +00005053 }
5054 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005055
Nate Begemandde25982009-06-28 19:12:57 +00005056 // Vectors of different size or scalar and non-ext-vector are errors.
Chris Lattnerc9c7c4e2008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005057 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_vector_not_convertable)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005058 << lex->getType() << rex->getType()
Chris Lattnerc9c7c4e2008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005059 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005060 return QualType();
Sebastian Redl22460502009-02-07 00:15:38 +00005061}
5062
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005063QualType Sema::CheckMultiplyDivideOperands(
5064 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, bool isCompAssign, bool isDiv) {
Daniel Dunbar69d1d002009-01-05 22:42:10 +00005065 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType())
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005066 return CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005067
Steve Naroff9f5fa9b2007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005068 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, isCompAssign);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005069
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005070 if (!lex->getType()->isArithmeticType() ||
5071 !rex->getType()->isArithmeticType())
5072 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005073
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005074 // Check for division by zero.
5075 if (isDiv &&
5076 rex->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull))
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005077 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, PDiag(diag::warn_division_by_zero)
Chris Lattnercb329c52010-01-12 21:30:55 +00005078 << rex->getSourceRange());
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005079
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005080 return compType;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005081}
5082
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005083QualType Sema::CheckRemainderOperands(
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005084 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, bool isCompAssign) {
Daniel Dunbar523aa602009-01-05 22:55:36 +00005085 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType()) {
Douglas Gregorf6094622010-07-23 15:58:24 +00005086 if (lex->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation() &&
5087 rex->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation())
Daniel Dunbar523aa602009-01-05 22:55:36 +00005088 return CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5089 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5090 }
Steve Naroff90045e82007-07-13 23:32:42 +00005091
Steve Naroff9f5fa9b2007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005092 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, isCompAssign);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005093
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005094 if (!lex->getType()->isIntegerType() || !rex->getType()->isIntegerType())
5095 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005096
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005097 // Check for remainder by zero.
5098 if (rex->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull))
Chris Lattnercb329c52010-01-12 21:30:55 +00005099 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, PDiag(diag::warn_remainder_by_zero)
5100 << rex->getSourceRange());
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005101
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005102 return compType;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005103}
5104
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005105QualType Sema::CheckAdditionOperands( // C99 6.5.6
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005106 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, QualType* CompLHSTy) {
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005107 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType()) {
5108 QualType compType = CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5109 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
5110 return compType;
5111 }
Steve Naroff49b45262007-07-13 16:58:59 +00005112
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005113 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, CompLHSTy);
Eli Friedmand72d16e2008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005114
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005115 // handle the common case first (both operands are arithmetic).
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005116 if (lex->getType()->isArithmeticType() &&
5117 rex->getType()->isArithmeticType()) {
5118 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
Steve Naroff9f5fa9b2007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005119 return compType;
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005120 }
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005121
Eli Friedmand72d16e2008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005122 // Put any potential pointer into PExp
5123 Expr* PExp = lex, *IExp = rex;
Steve Naroff58f9f2c2009-07-14 18:25:06 +00005124 if (IExp->getType()->isAnyPointerType())
Eli Friedmand72d16e2008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005125 std::swap(PExp, IExp);
5126
Steve Naroff58f9f2c2009-07-14 18:25:06 +00005127 if (PExp->getType()->isAnyPointerType()) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005128
Eli Friedmand72d16e2008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005129 if (IExp->getType()->isIntegerType()) {
Steve Naroff760e3c42009-07-13 21:20:41 +00005130 QualType PointeeTy = PExp->getType()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005131
Chris Lattnerb5f15622009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005132 // Check for arithmetic on pointers to incomplete types.
5133 if (PointeeTy->isVoidType()) {
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005134 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5135 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type)
Chris Lattnerfa25bbb2008-11-19 05:08:23 +00005136 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor4ec339f2009-01-19 19:26:10 +00005137 return QualType();
Eli Friedmand72d16e2008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005138 }
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005139
5140 // GNU extension: arithmetic on pointer to void
5141 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr)
5142 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattnerb5f15622009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005143 } else if (PointeeTy->isFunctionType()) {
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005144 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5145 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type)
5146 << lex->getType() << lex->getSourceRange();
5147 return QualType();
5148 }
5149
5150 // GNU extension: arithmetic on pointer to function
5151 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith)
5152 << lex->getType() << lex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff9deaeca2009-07-13 21:32:29 +00005153 } else {
Steve Naroff760e3c42009-07-13 21:20:41 +00005154 // Check if we require a complete type.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005155 if (((PExp->getType()->isPointerType() &&
Steve Naroff9deaeca2009-07-13 21:32:29 +00005156 !PExp->getType()->isDependentType()) ||
Steve Naroff760e3c42009-07-13 21:20:41 +00005157 PExp->getType()->isObjCObjectPointerType()) &&
5158 RequireCompleteType(Loc, PointeeTy,
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005159 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_arithmetic_incomplete_type)
5160 << PExp->getSourceRange()
Anders Carlssond497ba72009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005161 << PExp->getType()))
Steve Naroff760e3c42009-07-13 21:20:41 +00005162 return QualType();
5163 }
Chris Lattnerb5f15622009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005164 // Diagnose bad cases where we step over interface counts.
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00005165 if (PointeeTy->isObjCObjectType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
Chris Lattnerb5f15622009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005166 Diag(Loc, diag::err_arithmetic_nonfragile_interface)
5167 << PointeeTy << PExp->getSourceRange();
5168 return QualType();
5169 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005170
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005171 if (CompLHSTy) {
Eli Friedman04e83572009-08-20 04:21:42 +00005172 QualType LHSTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(lex);
5173 if (LHSTy.isNull()) {
5174 LHSTy = lex->getType();
5175 if (LHSTy->isPromotableIntegerType())
5176 LHSTy = Context.getPromotedIntegerType(LHSTy);
Douglas Gregor2d833e32009-05-02 00:36:19 +00005177 }
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005178 *CompLHSTy = LHSTy;
5179 }
Eli Friedmand72d16e2008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005180 return PExp->getType();
5181 }
5182 }
5183
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005184 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005185}
5186
Chris Lattnereca7be62008-04-07 05:30:13 +00005187// C99 6.5.6
5188QualType Sema::CheckSubtractionOperands(Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex,
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005189 SourceLocation Loc, QualType* CompLHSTy) {
5190 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType()) {
5191 QualType compType = CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5192 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
5193 return compType;
5194 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005195
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005196 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, CompLHSTy);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005197
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005198 // Enforce type constraints: C99 6.5.6p3.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005199
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005200 // Handle the common case first (both operands are arithmetic).
Mike Stumpaf199f32009-05-07 18:43:07 +00005201 if (lex->getType()->isArithmeticType()
5202 && rex->getType()->isArithmeticType()) {
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005203 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
Steve Naroff9f5fa9b2007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005204 return compType;
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005205 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005206
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005207 // Either ptr - int or ptr - ptr.
Steve Naroff58f9f2c2009-07-14 18:25:06 +00005208 if (lex->getType()->isAnyPointerType()) {
Steve Naroff430ee5a2009-07-13 17:19:15 +00005209 QualType lpointee = lex->getType()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005210
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005211 // The LHS must be an completely-defined object type.
Douglas Gregorc983b862009-01-23 00:36:41 +00005212
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005213 bool ComplainAboutVoid = false;
5214 Expr *ComplainAboutFunc = 0;
5215 if (lpointee->isVoidType()) {
5216 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5217 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type)
5218 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5219 return QualType();
5220 }
5221
5222 // GNU C extension: arithmetic on pointer to void
5223 ComplainAboutVoid = true;
5224 } else if (lpointee->isFunctionType()) {
5225 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5226 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005227 << lex->getType() << lex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005228 return QualType();
5229 }
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005230
5231 // GNU C extension: arithmetic on pointer to function
5232 ComplainAboutFunc = lex;
5233 } else if (!lpointee->isDependentType() &&
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005234 RequireCompleteType(Loc, lpointee,
Anders Carlssond497ba72009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005235 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_sub_ptr_object)
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005236 << lex->getSourceRange()
Anders Carlssond497ba72009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005237 << lex->getType()))
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005238 return QualType();
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005239
Chris Lattnerb5f15622009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005240 // Diagnose bad cases where we step over interface counts.
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00005241 if (lpointee->isObjCObjectType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
Chris Lattnerb5f15622009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005242 Diag(Loc, diag::err_arithmetic_nonfragile_interface)
5243 << lpointee << lex->getSourceRange();
5244 return QualType();
5245 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005246
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005247 // The result type of a pointer-int computation is the pointer type.
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005248 if (rex->getType()->isIntegerType()) {
5249 if (ComplainAboutVoid)
5250 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr)
5251 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5252 if (ComplainAboutFunc)
5253 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith)
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005254 << ComplainAboutFunc->getType()
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005255 << ComplainAboutFunc->getSourceRange();
5256
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005257 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = lex->getType();
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005258 return lex->getType();
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005259 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005260
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005261 // Handle pointer-pointer subtractions.
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005262 if (const PointerType *RHSPTy = rex->getType()->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Eli Friedman8e54ad02008-02-08 01:19:44 +00005263 QualType rpointee = RHSPTy->getPointeeType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005264
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005265 // RHS must be a completely-type object type.
5266 // Handle the GNU void* extension.
5267 if (rpointee->isVoidType()) {
5268 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5269 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type)
5270 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5271 return QualType();
5272 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005273
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005274 ComplainAboutVoid = true;
5275 } else if (rpointee->isFunctionType()) {
5276 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5277 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005278 << rex->getType() << rex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005279 return QualType();
5280 }
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005281
5282 // GNU extension: arithmetic on pointer to function
5283 if (!ComplainAboutFunc)
5284 ComplainAboutFunc = rex;
5285 } else if (!rpointee->isDependentType() &&
5286 RequireCompleteType(Loc, rpointee,
Anders Carlssond497ba72009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005287 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_sub_ptr_object)
5288 << rex->getSourceRange()
5289 << rex->getType()))
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005290 return QualType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005291
Eli Friedman88d936b2009-05-16 13:54:38 +00005292 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5293 // Pointee types must be the same: C++ [expr.add]
5294 if (!Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(lpointee, rpointee)) {
5295 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_sub_ptr_compatible)
5296 << lex->getType() << rex->getType()
5297 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5298 return QualType();
5299 }
5300 } else {
5301 // Pointee types must be compatible C99 6.5.6p3
5302 if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(
5303 Context.getCanonicalType(lpointee).getUnqualifiedType(),
5304 Context.getCanonicalType(rpointee).getUnqualifiedType())) {
5305 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_sub_ptr_compatible)
5306 << lex->getType() << rex->getType()
5307 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5308 return QualType();
5309 }
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005310 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005311
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005312 if (ComplainAboutVoid)
5313 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr)
5314 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5315 if (ComplainAboutFunc)
5316 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith)
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005317 << ComplainAboutFunc->getType()
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005318 << ComplainAboutFunc->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005319
5320 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = lex->getType();
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005321 return Context.getPointerDiffType();
5322 }
5323 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005324
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005325 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005326}
5327
Chris Lattnereca7be62008-04-07 05:30:13 +00005328// C99 6.5.7
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005329QualType Sema::CheckShiftOperands(Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc,
Chris Lattnereca7be62008-04-07 05:30:13 +00005330 bool isCompAssign) {
Chris Lattnerca5eede2007-12-12 05:47:28 +00005331 // C99 6.5.7p2: Each of the operands shall have integer type.
Douglas Gregorf6094622010-07-23 15:58:24 +00005332 if (!lex->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation() ||
5333 !rex->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation())
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005334 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005335
Nate Begeman2207d792009-10-25 02:26:48 +00005336 // Vector shifts promote their scalar inputs to vector type.
5337 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType())
5338 return CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5339
Chris Lattnerca5eede2007-12-12 05:47:28 +00005340 // Shifts don't perform usual arithmetic conversions, they just do integer
5341 // promotions on each operand. C99 6.5.7p3
Eli Friedman04e83572009-08-20 04:21:42 +00005342 QualType LHSTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(lex);
5343 if (LHSTy.isNull()) {
5344 LHSTy = lex->getType();
5345 if (LHSTy->isPromotableIntegerType())
5346 LHSTy = Context.getPromotedIntegerType(LHSTy);
Douglas Gregor2d833e32009-05-02 00:36:19 +00005347 }
Chris Lattner1dcf2c82007-12-13 07:28:16 +00005348 if (!isCompAssign)
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005349 ImpCastExprToType(lex, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_IntegralCast);
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005350
Chris Lattnerca5eede2007-12-12 05:47:28 +00005351 UsualUnaryConversions(rex);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005352
Ryan Flynnd0439682009-08-07 16:20:20 +00005353 // Sanity-check shift operands
5354 llvm::APSInt Right;
5355 // Check right/shifter operand
Daniel Dunbar3f180c62009-09-17 06:31:27 +00005356 if (!rex->isValueDependent() &&
5357 rex->isIntegerConstantExpr(Right, Context)) {
Ryan Flynn8045c732009-08-08 19:18:23 +00005358 if (Right.isNegative())
Ryan Flynnd0439682009-08-07 16:20:20 +00005359 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_shift_negative) << rex->getSourceRange();
5360 else {
5361 llvm::APInt LeftBits(Right.getBitWidth(),
5362 Context.getTypeSize(lex->getType()));
5363 if (Right.uge(LeftBits))
5364 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_shift_gt_typewidth) << rex->getSourceRange();
5365 }
5366 }
5367
Chris Lattnerca5eede2007-12-12 05:47:28 +00005368 // "The type of the result is that of the promoted left operand."
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005369 return LHSTy;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005370}
5371
Chandler Carruth99919472010-07-10 12:30:03 +00005372static bool IsWithinTemplateSpecialization(Decl *D) {
5373 if (DeclContext *DC = D->getDeclContext()) {
5374 if (isa<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(DC))
5375 return true;
5376 if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(DC))
5377 return FD->isFunctionTemplateSpecialization();
5378 }
5379 return false;
5380}
5381
Douglas Gregor0c6db942009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005382// C99 6.5.8, C++ [expr.rel]
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005383QualType Sema::CheckCompareOperands(Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc,
Douglas Gregora86b8322009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005384 unsigned OpaqueOpc, bool isRelational) {
5385 BinaryOperator::Opcode Opc = (BinaryOperator::Opcode)OpaqueOpc;
5386
Chris Lattner02dd4b12009-12-05 05:40:13 +00005387 // Handle vector comparisons separately.
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005388 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType())
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005389 return CheckVectorCompareOperands(lex, rex, Loc, isRelational);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005390
Steve Naroffc80b4ee2007-07-16 21:54:35 +00005391 QualType lType = lex->getType();
5392 QualType rType = rex->getType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005393
Douglas Gregor8eee1192010-06-22 22:12:46 +00005394 if (!lType->hasFloatingRepresentation() &&
5395 !(lType->isBlockPointerType() && isRelational)) {
Chris Lattner55660a72009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005396 // For non-floating point types, check for self-comparisons of the form
5397 // x == x, x != x, x < x, etc. These always evaluate to a constant, and
5398 // often indicate logic errors in the program.
Chandler Carruth64d092c2010-07-12 06:23:38 +00005399 //
5400 // NOTE: Don't warn about comparison expressions resulting from macro
5401 // expansion. Also don't warn about comparisons which are only self
5402 // comparisons within a template specialization. The warnings should catch
5403 // obvious cases in the definition of the template anyways. The idea is to
5404 // warn when the typed comparison operator will always evaluate to the same
5405 // result.
Chris Lattner55660a72009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005406 Expr *LHSStripped = lex->IgnoreParens();
5407 Expr *RHSStripped = rex->IgnoreParens();
Chandler Carruth99919472010-07-10 12:30:03 +00005408 if (DeclRefExpr* DRL = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(LHSStripped)) {
Douglas Gregord64fdd02010-06-08 19:50:34 +00005409 if (DeclRefExpr* DRR = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(RHSStripped)) {
Chandler Carruth64d092c2010-07-12 06:23:38 +00005410 if (DRL->getDecl() == DRR->getDecl() && !Loc.isMacroID() &&
Chandler Carruth99919472010-07-10 12:30:03 +00005411 !IsWithinTemplateSpecialization(DRL->getDecl())) {
Douglas Gregord64fdd02010-06-08 19:50:34 +00005412 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, PDiag(diag::warn_comparison_always)
5413 << 0 // self-
5414 << (Opc == BinaryOperator::EQ
5415 || Opc == BinaryOperator::LE
5416 || Opc == BinaryOperator::GE));
5417 } else if (lType->isArrayType() && rType->isArrayType() &&
5418 !DRL->getDecl()->getType()->isReferenceType() &&
5419 !DRR->getDecl()->getType()->isReferenceType()) {
5420 // what is it always going to eval to?
5421 char always_evals_to;
5422 switch(Opc) {
5423 case BinaryOperator::EQ: // e.g. array1 == array2
5424 always_evals_to = 0; // false
5425 break;
5426 case BinaryOperator::NE: // e.g. array1 != array2
5427 always_evals_to = 1; // true
5428 break;
5429 default:
5430 // best we can say is 'a constant'
5431 always_evals_to = 2; // e.g. array1 <= array2
5432 break;
5433 }
5434 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, PDiag(diag::warn_comparison_always)
5435 << 1 // array
5436 << always_evals_to);
5437 }
5438 }
Chandler Carruth99919472010-07-10 12:30:03 +00005439 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005440
Chris Lattner55660a72009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005441 if (isa<CastExpr>(LHSStripped))
5442 LHSStripped = LHSStripped->IgnoreParenCasts();
5443 if (isa<CastExpr>(RHSStripped))
5444 RHSStripped = RHSStripped->IgnoreParenCasts();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005445
Chris Lattner55660a72009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005446 // Warn about comparisons against a string constant (unless the other
5447 // operand is null), the user probably wants strcmp.
Douglas Gregora86b8322009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005448 Expr *literalString = 0;
5449 Expr *literalStringStripped = 0;
Chris Lattner55660a72009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005450 if ((isa<StringLiteral>(LHSStripped) || isa<ObjCEncodeExpr>(LHSStripped)) &&
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005451 !RHSStripped->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00005452 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Douglas Gregora86b8322009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005453 literalString = lex;
5454 literalStringStripped = LHSStripped;
Mike Stumpac5fc7c2009-08-04 21:02:39 +00005455 } else if ((isa<StringLiteral>(RHSStripped) ||
5456 isa<ObjCEncodeExpr>(RHSStripped)) &&
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005457 !LHSStripped->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00005458 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Douglas Gregora86b8322009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005459 literalString = rex;
5460 literalStringStripped = RHSStripped;
5461 }
5462
5463 if (literalString) {
5464 std::string resultComparison;
5465 switch (Opc) {
5466 case BinaryOperator::LT: resultComparison = ") < 0"; break;
5467 case BinaryOperator::GT: resultComparison = ") > 0"; break;
5468 case BinaryOperator::LE: resultComparison = ") <= 0"; break;
5469 case BinaryOperator::GE: resultComparison = ") >= 0"; break;
5470 case BinaryOperator::EQ: resultComparison = ") == 0"; break;
5471 case BinaryOperator::NE: resultComparison = ") != 0"; break;
5472 default: assert(false && "Invalid comparison operator");
5473 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005474
Douglas Gregord1e4d9b2010-01-12 23:18:54 +00005475 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc,
5476 PDiag(diag::warn_stringcompare)
5477 << isa<ObjCEncodeExpr>(literalStringStripped)
Ted Kremenek03a4bee2010-04-09 20:26:53 +00005478 << literalString->getSourceRange());
Douglas Gregora86b8322009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005479 }
Ted Kremenek3ca0bf22007-10-29 16:58:49 +00005480 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005481
Douglas Gregord64fdd02010-06-08 19:50:34 +00005482 // C99 6.5.8p3 / C99 6.5.9p4
5483 if (lex->getType()->isArithmeticType() && rex->getType()->isArithmeticType())
5484 UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex);
5485 else {
5486 UsualUnaryConversions(lex);
5487 UsualUnaryConversions(rex);
5488 }
5489
5490 lType = lex->getType();
5491 rType = rex->getType();
5492
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005493 // The result of comparisons is 'bool' in C++, 'int' in C.
Chris Lattner02dd4b12009-12-05 05:40:13 +00005494 QualType ResultTy = getLangOptions().CPlusPlus ? Context.BoolTy:Context.IntTy;
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005495
Chris Lattnera5937dd2007-08-26 01:18:55 +00005496 if (isRelational) {
5497 if (lType->isRealType() && rType->isRealType())
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005498 return ResultTy;
Chris Lattnera5937dd2007-08-26 01:18:55 +00005499 } else {
Ted Kremenek72cb1ae2007-10-29 17:13:39 +00005500 // Check for comparisons of floating point operands using != and ==.
Douglas Gregor8eee1192010-06-22 22:12:46 +00005501 if (lType->hasFloatingRepresentation())
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005502 CheckFloatComparison(Loc,lex,rex);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005503
Chris Lattnera5937dd2007-08-26 01:18:55 +00005504 if (lType->isArithmeticType() && rType->isArithmeticType())
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005505 return ResultTy;
Chris Lattnera5937dd2007-08-26 01:18:55 +00005506 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005507
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005508 bool LHSIsNull = lex->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00005509 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005510 bool RHSIsNull = rex->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00005511 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005512
Douglas Gregor6e5122c2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005513 // All of the following pointer-related warnings are GCC extensions, except
5514 // when handling null pointer constants.
Steve Naroff77878cc2007-08-27 04:08:11 +00005515 if (lType->isPointerType() && rType->isPointerType()) { // C99 6.5.8p2
Chris Lattnerbc896f52008-04-03 05:07:25 +00005516 QualType LCanPointeeTy =
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005517 Context.getCanonicalType(lType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType());
Chris Lattnerbc896f52008-04-03 05:07:25 +00005518 QualType RCanPointeeTy =
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005519 Context.getCanonicalType(rType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType());
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005520
Douglas Gregor0c6db942009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005521 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
Eli Friedman3075e762009-08-23 00:27:47 +00005522 if (LCanPointeeTy == RCanPointeeTy)
5523 return ResultTy;
Fariborz Jahanian51874dd2009-12-21 18:19:17 +00005524 if (!isRelational &&
5525 (LCanPointeeTy->isVoidType() || RCanPointeeTy->isVoidType())) {
5526 // Valid unless comparison between non-null pointer and function pointer
5527 // This is a gcc extension compatibility comparison.
Douglas Gregor6e5122c2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005528 // In a SFINAE context, we treat this as a hard error to maintain
5529 // conformance with the C++ standard.
Fariborz Jahanian51874dd2009-12-21 18:19:17 +00005530 if ((LCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType() || RCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType())
5531 && !LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull) {
Douglas Gregor6e5122c2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005532 Diag(Loc,
5533 isSFINAEContext()?
5534 diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_fptr_to_void
5535 : diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_fptr_to_void)
Fariborz Jahanian51874dd2009-12-21 18:19:17 +00005536 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor6e5122c2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005537
5538 if (isSFINAEContext())
5539 return QualType();
5540
Fariborz Jahanian51874dd2009-12-21 18:19:17 +00005541 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
5542 return ResultTy;
5543 }
5544 }
Douglas Gregor0c6db942009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005545 // C++ [expr.rel]p2:
5546 // [...] Pointer conversions (4.10) and qualification
5547 // conversions (4.4) are performed on pointer operands (or on
5548 // a pointer operand and a null pointer constant) to bring
5549 // them to their composite pointer type. [...]
5550 //
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005551 // C++ [expr.eq]p1 uses the same notion for (in)equality
Douglas Gregor0c6db942009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005552 // comparisons of pointers.
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005553 bool NonStandardCompositeType = false;
Douglas Gregor8f00dcf2010-04-16 23:20:25 +00005554 QualType T = FindCompositePointerType(Loc, lex, rex,
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005555 isSFINAEContext()? 0 : &NonStandardCompositeType);
Douglas Gregor0c6db942009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005556 if (T.isNull()) {
5557 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
5558 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5559 return QualType();
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005560 } else if (NonStandardCompositeType) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005561 Diag(Loc,
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005562 diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers_nonstandard)
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005563 << lType << rType << T
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005564 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor0c6db942009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005565 }
5566
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005567 ImpCastExprToType(lex, T, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
5568 ImpCastExprToType(rex, T, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor0c6db942009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005569 return ResultTy;
5570 }
Eli Friedman3075e762009-08-23 00:27:47 +00005571 // C99 6.5.9p2 and C99 6.5.8p2
5572 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(LCanPointeeTy.getUnqualifiedType(),
5573 RCanPointeeTy.getUnqualifiedType())) {
5574 // Valid unless a relational comparison of function pointers
5575 if (isRelational && LCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType()) {
5576 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_ordered_comparison_of_function_pointers)
5577 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5578 }
5579 } else if (!isRelational &&
5580 (LCanPointeeTy->isVoidType() || RCanPointeeTy->isVoidType())) {
5581 // Valid unless comparison between non-null pointer and function pointer
5582 if ((LCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType() || RCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType())
5583 && !LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull) {
5584 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_fptr_to_void)
5585 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5586 }
5587 } else {
5588 // Invalid
Chris Lattnerc9c7c4e2008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005589 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005590 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005591 }
Eli Friedman3075e762009-08-23 00:27:47 +00005592 if (LCanPointeeTy != RCanPointeeTy)
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005593 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005594 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroffe77fd3c2007-08-16 21:48:38 +00005595 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005596
Sebastian Redl6e8ed162009-05-10 18:38:11 +00005597 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005598 // Comparison of pointers with null pointer constants and equality
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005599 // comparisons of member pointers to null pointer constants.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005600 if (RHSIsNull &&
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005601 (lType->isPointerType() ||
5602 (!isRelational && lType->isMemberPointerType()))) {
Douglas Gregor443c2122010-08-07 13:36:37 +00005603 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType,
5604 lType->isMemberPointerType()
5605 ? CastExpr::CK_NullToMemberPointer
5606 : CastExpr::CK_IntegralToPointer);
Sebastian Redl6e8ed162009-05-10 18:38:11 +00005607 return ResultTy;
5608 }
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005609 if (LHSIsNull &&
5610 (rType->isPointerType() ||
5611 (!isRelational && rType->isMemberPointerType()))) {
Douglas Gregor443c2122010-08-07 13:36:37 +00005612 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rType,
5613 rType->isMemberPointerType()
5614 ? CastExpr::CK_NullToMemberPointer
5615 : CastExpr::CK_IntegralToPointer);
Sebastian Redl6e8ed162009-05-10 18:38:11 +00005616 return ResultTy;
5617 }
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005618
5619 // Comparison of member pointers.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005620 if (!isRelational &&
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005621 lType->isMemberPointerType() && rType->isMemberPointerType()) {
5622 // C++ [expr.eq]p2:
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005623 // In addition, pointers to members can be compared, or a pointer to
5624 // member and a null pointer constant. Pointer to member conversions
5625 // (4.11) and qualification conversions (4.4) are performed to bring
5626 // them to a common type. If one operand is a null pointer constant,
5627 // the common type is the type of the other operand. Otherwise, the
5628 // common type is a pointer to member type similar (4.4) to the type
5629 // of one of the operands, with a cv-qualification signature (4.4)
5630 // that is the union of the cv-qualification signatures of the operand
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005631 // types.
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005632 bool NonStandardCompositeType = false;
Douglas Gregor8f00dcf2010-04-16 23:20:25 +00005633 QualType T = FindCompositePointerType(Loc, lex, rex,
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005634 isSFINAEContext()? 0 : &NonStandardCompositeType);
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005635 if (T.isNull()) {
5636 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005637 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005638 return QualType();
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005639 } else if (NonStandardCompositeType) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005640 Diag(Loc,
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005641 diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers_nonstandard)
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005642 << lType << rType << T
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005643 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005644 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005645
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005646 ImpCastExprToType(lex, T, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
5647 ImpCastExprToType(rex, T, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005648 return ResultTy;
5649 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005650
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005651 // Comparison of nullptr_t with itself.
Sebastian Redl6e8ed162009-05-10 18:38:11 +00005652 if (lType->isNullPtrType() && rType->isNullPtrType())
5653 return ResultTy;
5654 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005655
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005656 // Handle block pointer types.
Mike Stumpdd3e1662009-05-07 03:14:14 +00005657 if (!isRelational && lType->isBlockPointerType() && rType->isBlockPointerType()) {
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005658 QualType lpointee = lType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
5659 QualType rpointee = rType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005660
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005661 if (!LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull &&
Eli Friedman26784c12009-06-08 05:08:54 +00005662 !Context.typesAreCompatible(lpointee, rpointee)) {
Chris Lattnerc9c7c4e2008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005663 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_blocks)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005664 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005665 }
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005666 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005667 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005668 }
Steve Naroff59f53942008-09-28 01:11:11 +00005669 // Allow block pointers to be compared with null pointer constants.
Mike Stumpdd3e1662009-05-07 03:14:14 +00005670 if (!isRelational
5671 && ((lType->isBlockPointerType() && rType->isPointerType())
5672 || (lType->isPointerType() && rType->isBlockPointerType()))) {
Steve Naroff59f53942008-09-28 01:11:11 +00005673 if (!LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull) {
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005674 if (!((rType->isPointerType() && rType->getAs<PointerType>()
Mike Stumpdd3e1662009-05-07 03:14:14 +00005675 ->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005676 || (lType->isPointerType() && lType->getAs<PointerType>()
Mike Stumpdd3e1662009-05-07 03:14:14 +00005677 ->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())))
5678 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_blocks)
5679 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff59f53942008-09-28 01:11:11 +00005680 }
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005681 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005682 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff59f53942008-09-28 01:11:11 +00005683 }
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005684
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005685 if ((lType->isObjCObjectPointerType() || rType->isObjCObjectPointerType())) {
Steve Naroffa5ad8632008-10-27 10:33:19 +00005686 if (lType->isPointerType() || rType->isPointerType()) {
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005687 const PointerType *LPT = lType->getAs<PointerType>();
5688 const PointerType *RPT = rType->getAs<PointerType>();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005689 bool LPtrToVoid = LPT ?
Steve Naroffa8069f12008-11-17 19:49:16 +00005690 Context.getCanonicalType(LPT->getPointeeType())->isVoidType() : false;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005691 bool RPtrToVoid = RPT ?
Steve Naroffa8069f12008-11-17 19:49:16 +00005692 Context.getCanonicalType(RPT->getPointeeType())->isVoidType() : false;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005693
Steve Naroffa8069f12008-11-17 19:49:16 +00005694 if (!LPtrToVoid && !RPtrToVoid &&
5695 !Context.typesAreCompatible(lType, rType)) {
Chris Lattnerc9c7c4e2008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005696 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005697 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroffa5ad8632008-10-27 10:33:19 +00005698 }
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005699 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005700 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff87f3b932008-10-20 18:19:10 +00005701 }
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005702 if (lType->isObjCObjectPointerType() && rType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
Chris Lattner6365e3e2009-08-22 18:58:31 +00005703 if (!Context.areComparableObjCPointerTypes(lType, rType))
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005704 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
5705 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005706 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005707 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff20373222008-06-03 14:04:54 +00005708 }
Fariborz Jahanian7359f042007-12-20 01:06:58 +00005709 }
Douglas Gregor6e5122c2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005710 if ((lType->isAnyPointerType() && rType->isIntegerType()) ||
5711 (lType->isIntegerType() && rType->isAnyPointerType())) {
Chris Lattner06c0f5b2009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005712 unsigned DiagID = 0;
Douglas Gregor6e5122c2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005713 bool isError = false;
5714 if ((LHSIsNull && lType->isIntegerType()) ||
5715 (RHSIsNull && rType->isIntegerType())) {
5716 if (isRelational && !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
Chris Lattner06c0f5b2009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005717 DiagID = diag::ext_typecheck_ordered_comparison_of_pointer_and_zero;
Douglas Gregor6e5122c2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005718 } else if (isRelational && !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
Chris Lattner06c0f5b2009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005719 DiagID = diag::ext_typecheck_ordered_comparison_of_pointer_integer;
Douglas Gregor6e5122c2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005720 else if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5721 DiagID = diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_pointer_integer;
5722 isError = true;
5723 } else
Chris Lattner06c0f5b2009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005724 DiagID = diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_pointer_integer;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005725
Chris Lattner06c0f5b2009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005726 if (DiagID) {
Chris Lattner6365e3e2009-08-22 18:58:31 +00005727 Diag(Loc, DiagID)
Chris Lattner149f1382009-06-30 06:24:05 +00005728 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor6e5122c2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005729 if (isError)
5730 return QualType();
Chris Lattner6365e3e2009-08-22 18:58:31 +00005731 }
Douglas Gregor6e5122c2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005732
5733 if (lType->isIntegerType())
5734 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rType, CastExpr::CK_IntegralToPointer);
Chris Lattner06c0f5b2009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005735 else
Douglas Gregor6e5122c2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005736 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CastExpr::CK_IntegralToPointer);
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005737 return ResultTy;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005738 }
Douglas Gregor6e5122c2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005739
Steve Naroff39218df2008-09-04 16:56:14 +00005740 // Handle block pointers.
Mike Stumpaf199f32009-05-07 18:43:07 +00005741 if (!isRelational && RHSIsNull
5742 && lType->isBlockPointerType() && rType->isIntegerType()) {
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005743 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CastExpr::CK_IntegralToPointer);
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005744 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff39218df2008-09-04 16:56:14 +00005745 }
Mike Stumpaf199f32009-05-07 18:43:07 +00005746 if (!isRelational && LHSIsNull
5747 && lType->isIntegerType() && rType->isBlockPointerType()) {
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005748 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rType, CastExpr::CK_IntegralToPointer);
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005749 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff39218df2008-09-04 16:56:14 +00005750 }
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005751 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005752}
5753
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005754/// CheckVectorCompareOperands - vector comparisons are a clang extension that
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005755/// operates on extended vector types. Instead of producing an IntTy result,
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005756/// like a scalar comparison, a vector comparison produces a vector of integer
5757/// types.
5758QualType Sema::CheckVectorCompareOperands(Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex,
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005759 SourceLocation Loc,
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005760 bool isRelational) {
5761 // Check to make sure we're operating on vectors of the same type and width,
5762 // Allowing one side to be a scalar of element type.
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005763 QualType vType = CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005764 if (vType.isNull())
5765 return vType;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005766
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005767 QualType lType = lex->getType();
5768 QualType rType = rex->getType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005769
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005770 // For non-floating point types, check for self-comparisons of the form
5771 // x == x, x != x, x < x, etc. These always evaluate to a constant, and
5772 // often indicate logic errors in the program.
Douglas Gregor8eee1192010-06-22 22:12:46 +00005773 if (!lType->hasFloatingRepresentation()) {
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005774 if (DeclRefExpr* DRL = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(lex->IgnoreParens()))
5775 if (DeclRefExpr* DRR = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(rex->IgnoreParens()))
5776 if (DRL->getDecl() == DRR->getDecl())
Douglas Gregord64fdd02010-06-08 19:50:34 +00005777 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc,
5778 PDiag(diag::warn_comparison_always)
5779 << 0 // self-
5780 << 2 // "a constant"
5781 );
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005782 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005783
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005784 // Check for comparisons of floating point operands using != and ==.
Douglas Gregor8eee1192010-06-22 22:12:46 +00005785 if (!isRelational && lType->hasFloatingRepresentation()) {
5786 assert (rType->hasFloatingRepresentation());
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005787 CheckFloatComparison(Loc,lex,rex);
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005788 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005789
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005790 // Return the type for the comparison, which is the same as vector type for
5791 // integer vectors, or an integer type of identical size and number of
5792 // elements for floating point vectors.
Douglas Gregorf6094622010-07-23 15:58:24 +00005793 if (lType->hasIntegerRepresentation())
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005794 return lType;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005795
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00005796 const VectorType *VTy = lType->getAs<VectorType>();
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005797 unsigned TypeSize = Context.getTypeSize(VTy->getElementType());
Nate Begeman59b5da62009-01-18 03:20:47 +00005798 if (TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.IntTy))
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005799 return Context.getExtVectorType(Context.IntTy, VTy->getNumElements());
Chris Lattnerd013aa12009-03-31 07:46:52 +00005800 if (TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.LongTy))
Nate Begeman59b5da62009-01-18 03:20:47 +00005801 return Context.getExtVectorType(Context.LongTy, VTy->getNumElements());
5802
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005803 assert(TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.LongLongTy) &&
Nate Begeman59b5da62009-01-18 03:20:47 +00005804 "Unhandled vector element size in vector compare");
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005805 return Context.getExtVectorType(Context.LongLongTy, VTy->getNumElements());
5806}
5807
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005808inline QualType Sema::CheckBitwiseOperands(
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005809 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, bool isCompAssign) {
Douglas Gregorf6094622010-07-23 15:58:24 +00005810 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType()) {
5811 if (lex->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation() &&
5812 rex->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation())
5813 return CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5814
5815 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5816 }
Steve Naroff90045e82007-07-13 23:32:42 +00005817
Steve Naroff9f5fa9b2007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005818 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, isCompAssign);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005819
Steve Naroffa4332e22007-07-17 00:58:39 +00005820 if (lex->getType()->isIntegerType() && rex->getType()->isIntegerType())
Steve Naroff9f5fa9b2007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005821 return compType;
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005822 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005823}
5824
5825inline QualType Sema::CheckLogicalOperands( // C99 6.5.[13,14]
Chris Lattner90a8f272010-07-13 19:41:32 +00005826 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, unsigned Opc) {
5827
5828 // Diagnose cases where the user write a logical and/or but probably meant a
5829 // bitwise one. We do this when the LHS is a non-bool integer and the RHS
5830 // is a constant.
5831 if (lex->getType()->isIntegerType() && !lex->getType()->isBooleanType() &&
Eli Friedman787b0942010-07-27 19:14:53 +00005832 rex->getType()->isIntegerType() && !rex->isValueDependent() &&
Chris Lattner23ef3e42010-07-15 00:26:43 +00005833 // Don't warn in macros.
Chris Lattnerb7690b42010-07-24 01:10:11 +00005834 !Loc.isMacroID()) {
5835 // If the RHS can be constant folded, and if it constant folds to something
5836 // that isn't 0 or 1 (which indicate a potential logical operation that
5837 // happened to fold to true/false) then warn.
5838 Expr::EvalResult Result;
5839 if (rex->Evaluate(Result, Context) && !Result.HasSideEffects &&
5840 Result.Val.getInt() != 0 && Result.Val.getInt() != 1) {
5841 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_logical_instead_of_bitwise)
5842 << rex->getSourceRange()
5843 << (Opc == BinaryOperator::LAnd ? "&&" : "||")
5844 << (Opc == BinaryOperator::LAnd ? "&" : "|");
5845 }
5846 }
Chris Lattner90a8f272010-07-13 19:41:32 +00005847
Anders Carlssona4c98cd2009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005848 if (!Context.getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5849 UsualUnaryConversions(lex);
5850 UsualUnaryConversions(rex);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005851
Anders Carlssona4c98cd2009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005852 if (!lex->getType()->isScalarType() || !rex->getType()->isScalarType())
5853 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005854
Anders Carlssona4c98cd2009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005855 return Context.IntTy;
Anders Carlsson04905012009-10-16 01:44:21 +00005856 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005857
John McCall75f7c0f2010-06-04 00:29:51 +00005858 // The following is safe because we only use this method for
5859 // non-overloadable operands.
5860
Anders Carlssona4c98cd2009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005861 // C++ [expr.log.and]p1
5862 // C++ [expr.log.or]p1
John McCall75f7c0f2010-06-04 00:29:51 +00005863 // The operands are both contextually converted to type bool.
5864 if (PerformContextuallyConvertToBool(lex) ||
5865 PerformContextuallyConvertToBool(rex))
Anders Carlssona4c98cd2009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005866 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005867
Anders Carlssona4c98cd2009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005868 // C++ [expr.log.and]p2
5869 // C++ [expr.log.or]p2
5870 // The result is a bool.
5871 return Context.BoolTy;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005872}
5873
Fariborz Jahaniand1fa6442009-01-12 19:55:42 +00005874/// IsReadonlyProperty - Verify that otherwise a valid l-value expression
5875/// is a read-only property; return true if so. A readonly property expression
5876/// depends on various declarations and thus must be treated specially.
5877///
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005878static bool IsReadonlyProperty(Expr *E, Sema &S) {
Fariborz Jahaniand1fa6442009-01-12 19:55:42 +00005879 if (E->getStmtClass() == Expr::ObjCPropertyRefExprClass) {
5880 const ObjCPropertyRefExpr* PropExpr = cast<ObjCPropertyRefExpr>(E);
5881 if (ObjCPropertyDecl *PDecl = PropExpr->getProperty()) {
5882 QualType BaseType = PropExpr->getBase()->getType();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005883 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT =
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005884 BaseType->getAsObjCInterfacePointerType())
5885 if (ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = OPT->getInterfaceDecl())
5886 if (S.isPropertyReadonly(PDecl, IFace))
5887 return true;
Fariborz Jahaniand1fa6442009-01-12 19:55:42 +00005888 }
5889 }
5890 return false;
5891}
5892
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005893/// CheckForModifiableLvalue - Verify that E is a modifiable lvalue. If not,
5894/// emit an error and return true. If so, return false.
5895static bool CheckForModifiableLvalue(Expr *E, SourceLocation Loc, Sema &S) {
Daniel Dunbar44e35f72009-04-15 00:08:05 +00005896 SourceLocation OrigLoc = Loc;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005897 Expr::isModifiableLvalueResult IsLV = E->isModifiableLvalue(S.Context,
Daniel Dunbar44e35f72009-04-15 00:08:05 +00005898 &Loc);
Fariborz Jahaniand1fa6442009-01-12 19:55:42 +00005899 if (IsLV == Expr::MLV_Valid && IsReadonlyProperty(E, S))
5900 IsLV = Expr::MLV_ReadonlyProperty;
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005901 if (IsLV == Expr::MLV_Valid)
5902 return false;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005903
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005904 unsigned Diag = 0;
5905 bool NeedType = false;
5906 switch (IsLV) { // C99 6.5.16p2
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005907 case Expr::MLV_ConstQualified: Diag = diag::err_typecheck_assign_const; break;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005908 case Expr::MLV_ArrayType:
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005909 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_array_not_modifiable_lvalue;
5910 NeedType = true;
5911 break;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005912 case Expr::MLV_NotObjectType:
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005913 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_non_object_not_modifiable_lvalue;
5914 NeedType = true;
5915 break;
Chris Lattnerca354fa2008-11-17 19:51:54 +00005916 case Expr::MLV_LValueCast:
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005917 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_lvalue_casts_not_supported;
5918 break;
Douglas Gregore873fb72010-02-16 21:39:57 +00005919 case Expr::MLV_Valid:
5920 llvm_unreachable("did not take early return for MLV_Valid");
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005921 case Expr::MLV_InvalidExpression:
Douglas Gregore873fb72010-02-16 21:39:57 +00005922 case Expr::MLV_MemberFunction:
5923 case Expr::MLV_ClassTemporary:
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005924 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_expression_not_modifiable_lvalue;
5925 break;
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005926 case Expr::MLV_IncompleteType:
5927 case Expr::MLV_IncompleteVoidType:
Douglas Gregor86447ec2009-03-09 16:13:40 +00005928 return S.RequireCompleteType(Loc, E->getType(),
Douglas Gregorfe6b2d42010-03-29 23:34:08 +00005929 S.PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_incomplete_type_not_modifiable_lvalue)
Anders Carlssonb7906612009-08-26 23:45:07 +00005930 << E->getSourceRange());
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005931 case Expr::MLV_DuplicateVectorComponents:
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005932 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_duplicate_vector_components_not_mlvalue;
5933 break;
Steve Naroff4f6a7d72008-09-26 14:41:28 +00005934 case Expr::MLV_NotBlockQualified:
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005935 Diag = diag::err_block_decl_ref_not_modifiable_lvalue;
5936 break;
Fariborz Jahanian5daf5702008-11-22 18:39:36 +00005937 case Expr::MLV_ReadonlyProperty:
5938 Diag = diag::error_readonly_property_assignment;
5939 break;
Fariborz Jahanianba8d2d62008-11-22 20:25:50 +00005940 case Expr::MLV_NoSetterProperty:
5941 Diag = diag::error_nosetter_property_assignment;
5942 break;
Fariborz Jahanian2514a302009-12-15 23:59:41 +00005943 case Expr::MLV_SubObjCPropertySetting:
5944 Diag = diag::error_no_subobject_property_setting;
5945 break;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005946 }
Steve Naroffd1861fd2007-07-31 12:34:36 +00005947
Daniel Dunbar44e35f72009-04-15 00:08:05 +00005948 SourceRange Assign;
5949 if (Loc != OrigLoc)
5950 Assign = SourceRange(OrigLoc, OrigLoc);
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005951 if (NeedType)
Daniel Dunbar44e35f72009-04-15 00:08:05 +00005952 S.Diag(Loc, Diag) << E->getType() << E->getSourceRange() << Assign;
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005953 else
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005954 S.Diag(Loc, Diag) << E->getSourceRange() << Assign;
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005955 return true;
5956}
5957
5958
5959
5960// C99 6.5.16.1
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005961QualType Sema::CheckAssignmentOperands(Expr *LHS, Expr *&RHS,
5962 SourceLocation Loc,
5963 QualType CompoundType) {
5964 // Verify that LHS is a modifiable lvalue, and emit error if not.
5965 if (CheckForModifiableLvalue(LHS, Loc, *this))
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005966 return QualType();
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005967
5968 QualType LHSType = LHS->getType();
5969 QualType RHSType = CompoundType.isNull() ? RHS->getType() : CompoundType;
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005970 AssignConvertType ConvTy;
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005971 if (CompoundType.isNull()) {
Fariborz Jahaniane2a901a2010-06-07 22:02:01 +00005972 QualType LHSTy(LHSType);
Chris Lattner2c156472008-08-21 18:04:13 +00005973 // Simple assignment "x = y".
Fariborz Jahaniane2a901a2010-06-07 22:02:01 +00005974 if (const ObjCImplicitSetterGetterRefExpr *OISGE =
5975 dyn_cast<ObjCImplicitSetterGetterRefExpr>(LHS)) {
5976 // If using property-dot syntax notation for assignment, and there is a
5977 // setter, RHS expression is being passed to the setter argument. So,
5978 // type conversion (and comparison) is RHS to setter's argument type.
5979 if (const ObjCMethodDecl *SetterMD = OISGE->getSetterMethod()) {
5980 ObjCMethodDecl::param_iterator P = SetterMD->param_begin();
5981 LHSTy = (*P)->getType();
5982 }
5983 }
5984
5985 ConvTy = CheckSingleAssignmentConstraints(LHSTy, RHS);
Fariborz Jahanianfa23c1d2009-01-13 23:34:40 +00005986 // Special case of NSObject attributes on c-style pointer types.
5987 if (ConvTy == IncompatiblePointer &&
5988 ((Context.isObjCNSObjectType(LHSType) &&
Steve Narofff4954562009-07-16 15:41:00 +00005989 RHSType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) ||
Fariborz Jahanianfa23c1d2009-01-13 23:34:40 +00005990 (Context.isObjCNSObjectType(RHSType) &&
Steve Narofff4954562009-07-16 15:41:00 +00005991 LHSType->isObjCObjectPointerType())))
Fariborz Jahanianfa23c1d2009-01-13 23:34:40 +00005992 ConvTy = Compatible;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005993
Chris Lattner2c156472008-08-21 18:04:13 +00005994 // If the RHS is a unary plus or minus, check to see if they = and + are
5995 // right next to each other. If so, the user may have typo'd "x =+ 4"
5996 // instead of "x += 4".
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005997 Expr *RHSCheck = RHS;
Chris Lattner2c156472008-08-21 18:04:13 +00005998 if (ImplicitCastExpr *ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(RHSCheck))
5999 RHSCheck = ICE->getSubExpr();
6000 if (UnaryOperator *UO = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(RHSCheck)) {
6001 if ((UO->getOpcode() == UnaryOperator::Plus ||
6002 UO->getOpcode() == UnaryOperator::Minus) &&
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006003 Loc.isFileID() && UO->getOperatorLoc().isFileID() &&
Chris Lattner2c156472008-08-21 18:04:13 +00006004 // Only if the two operators are exactly adjacent.
Chris Lattner399bd1b2009-03-08 06:51:10 +00006005 Loc.getFileLocWithOffset(1) == UO->getOperatorLoc() &&
6006 // And there is a space or other character before the subexpr of the
6007 // unary +/-. We don't want to warn on "x=-1".
Chris Lattner3e872092009-03-09 07:11:10 +00006008 Loc.getFileLocWithOffset(2) != UO->getSubExpr()->getLocStart() &&
6009 UO->getSubExpr()->getLocStart().isFileID()) {
Chris Lattnerd3a94e22008-11-20 06:06:08 +00006010 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_not_compound_assign)
6011 << (UO->getOpcode() == UnaryOperator::Plus ? "+" : "-")
6012 << SourceRange(UO->getOperatorLoc(), UO->getOperatorLoc());
Chris Lattner399bd1b2009-03-08 06:51:10 +00006013 }
Chris Lattner2c156472008-08-21 18:04:13 +00006014 }
6015 } else {
6016 // Compound assignment "x += y"
Eli Friedman623712b2009-05-16 05:56:02 +00006017 ConvTy = CheckAssignmentConstraints(LHSType, RHSType);
Chris Lattner2c156472008-08-21 18:04:13 +00006018 }
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00006019
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006020 if (DiagnoseAssignmentResult(ConvTy, Loc, LHSType, RHSType,
Douglas Gregor68647482009-12-16 03:45:30 +00006021 RHS, AA_Assigning))
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00006022 return QualType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006023
Chris Lattner8b5dec32010-07-07 06:14:23 +00006024
6025 // Check to see if the destination operand is a dereferenced null pointer. If
6026 // so, and if not volatile-qualified, this is undefined behavior that the
6027 // optimizer will delete, so warn about it. People sometimes try to use this
6028 // to get a deterministic trap and are surprised by clang's behavior. This
6029 // only handles the pattern "*null = whatever", which is a very syntactic
6030 // check.
6031 if (UnaryOperator *UO = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(LHS->IgnoreParenCasts()))
6032 if (UO->getOpcode() == UnaryOperator::Deref &&
6033 UO->getSubExpr()->IgnoreParenCasts()->
6034 isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull) &&
6035 !UO->getType().isVolatileQualified()) {
6036 Diag(UO->getOperatorLoc(), diag::warn_indirection_through_null)
6037 << UO->getSubExpr()->getSourceRange();
6038 Diag(UO->getOperatorLoc(), diag::note_indirection_through_null);
6039 }
6040
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006041 // C99 6.5.16p3: The type of an assignment expression is the type of the
6042 // left operand unless the left operand has qualified type, in which case
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006043 // it is the unqualified version of the type of the left operand.
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006044 // C99 6.5.16.1p2: In simple assignment, the value of the right operand
6045 // is converted to the type of the assignment expression (above).
Chris Lattner73d0d4f2007-08-30 17:45:32 +00006046 // C++ 5.17p1: the type of the assignment expression is that of its left
Douglas Gregor2d833e32009-05-02 00:36:19 +00006047 // operand.
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006048 return LHSType.getUnqualifiedType();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006049}
6050
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006051// C99 6.5.17
6052QualType Sema::CheckCommaOperands(Expr *LHS, Expr *&RHS, SourceLocation Loc) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidis25973452010-06-30 10:53:14 +00006053 DiagnoseUnusedExprResult(LHS);
6054
Chris Lattner53fcaa92008-07-25 20:54:07 +00006055 // Comma performs lvalue conversion (C99 6.3.2.1), but not unary conversions.
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +00006056 // C++ does not perform this conversion (C++ [expr.comma]p1).
6057 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
6058 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(RHS);
Eli Friedmanb1d796d2009-03-23 00:24:07 +00006059
6060 // FIXME: Check that RHS type is complete in C mode (it's legal for it to be
6061 // incomplete in C++).
6062
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006063 return RHS->getType();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006064}
6065
Steve Naroff49b45262007-07-13 16:58:59 +00006066/// CheckIncrementDecrementOperand - unlike most "Check" methods, this routine
6067/// doesn't need to call UsualUnaryConversions or UsualArithmeticConversions.
Sebastian Redle6d5a4a2008-12-20 09:35:34 +00006068QualType Sema::CheckIncrementDecrementOperand(Expr *Op, SourceLocation OpLoc,
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00006069 bool isInc, bool isPrefix) {
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006070 if (Op->isTypeDependent())
6071 return Context.DependentTy;
6072
Chris Lattner3528d352008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006073 QualType ResType = Op->getType();
6074 assert(!ResType.isNull() && "no type for increment/decrement expression");
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006075
Sebastian Redle6d5a4a2008-12-20 09:35:34 +00006076 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && ResType->isBooleanType()) {
6077 // Decrement of bool is not allowed.
6078 if (!isInc) {
6079 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_decrement_bool) << Op->getSourceRange();
6080 return QualType();
6081 }
6082 // Increment of bool sets it to true, but is deprecated.
6083 Diag(OpLoc, diag::warn_increment_bool) << Op->getSourceRange();
6084 } else if (ResType->isRealType()) {
Chris Lattner3528d352008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006085 // OK!
Steve Naroff58f9f2c2009-07-14 18:25:06 +00006086 } else if (ResType->isAnyPointerType()) {
6087 QualType PointeeTy = ResType->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006088
Chris Lattner3528d352008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006089 // C99 6.5.2.4p2, 6.5.6p2
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006090 if (PointeeTy->isVoidType()) {
Douglas Gregorc983b862009-01-23 00:36:41 +00006091 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
6092 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type)
6093 << Op->getSourceRange();
6094 return QualType();
6095 }
6096
6097 // Pointer to void is a GNU extension in C.
Chris Lattner3528d352008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006098 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr) << Op->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006099 } else if (PointeeTy->isFunctionType()) {
Douglas Gregorc983b862009-01-23 00:36:41 +00006100 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
6101 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type)
6102 << Op->getType() << Op->getSourceRange();
6103 return QualType();
6104 }
6105
6106 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00006107 << ResType << Op->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006108 } else if (RequireCompleteType(OpLoc, PointeeTy,
Anders Carlssond497ba72009-08-26 22:59:12 +00006109 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_arithmetic_incomplete_type)
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006110 << Op->getSourceRange()
Anders Carlssond497ba72009-08-26 22:59:12 +00006111 << ResType))
Douglas Gregor4ec339f2009-01-19 19:26:10 +00006112 return QualType();
Fariborz Jahanian9f8a04f2009-07-16 17:59:14 +00006113 // Diagnose bad cases where we step over interface counts.
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00006114 else if (PointeeTy->isObjCObjectType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
Fariborz Jahanian9f8a04f2009-07-16 17:59:14 +00006115 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_arithmetic_nonfragile_interface)
6116 << PointeeTy << Op->getSourceRange();
6117 return QualType();
6118 }
Eli Friedman5b088a12010-01-03 00:20:48 +00006119 } else if (ResType->isAnyComplexType()) {
Chris Lattner3528d352008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006120 // C99 does not support ++/-- on complex types, we allow as an extension.
6121 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_integer_increment_complex)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00006122 << ResType << Op->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner3528d352008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006123 } else {
6124 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_illegal_increment_decrement)
Douglas Gregor5cc07df2009-12-15 16:44:32 +00006125 << ResType << int(isInc) << Op->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner3528d352008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006126 return QualType();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006127 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006128 // At this point, we know we have a real, complex or pointer type.
Steve Naroffdd10e022007-08-23 21:37:33 +00006129 // Now make sure the operand is a modifiable lvalue.
Chris Lattner3528d352008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006130 if (CheckForModifiableLvalue(Op, OpLoc, *this))
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006131 return QualType();
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00006132 // In C++, a prefix increment is the same type as the operand. Otherwise
6133 // (in C or with postfix), the increment is the unqualified type of the
6134 // operand.
6135 return isPrefix && getLangOptions().CPlusPlus
6136 ? ResType : ResType.getUnqualifiedType();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006137}
6138
Anders Carlsson369dee42008-02-01 07:15:58 +00006139/// getPrimaryDecl - Helper function for CheckAddressOfOperand().
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006140/// This routine allows us to typecheck complex/recursive expressions
Daniel Dunbar1e76ce62008-08-04 20:02:37 +00006141/// where the declaration is needed for type checking. We only need to
6142/// handle cases when the expression references a function designator
6143/// or is an lvalue. Here are some examples:
6144/// - &(x) => x
6145/// - &*****f => f for f a function designator.
6146/// - &s.xx => s
6147/// - &s.zz[1].yy -> s, if zz is an array
6148/// - *(x + 1) -> x, if x is an array
6149/// - &"123"[2] -> 0
6150/// - & __real__ x -> x
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00006151static NamedDecl *getPrimaryDecl(Expr *E) {
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00006152 switch (E->getStmtClass()) {
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006153 case Stmt::DeclRefExprClass:
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00006154 return cast<DeclRefExpr>(E)->getDecl();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006155 case Stmt::MemberExprClass:
Eli Friedman23d58ce2009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006156 // If this is an arrow operator, the address is an offset from
6157 // the base's value, so the object the base refers to is
6158 // irrelevant.
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00006159 if (cast<MemberExpr>(E)->isArrow())
Chris Lattnerf82228f2007-11-16 17:46:48 +00006160 return 0;
Eli Friedman23d58ce2009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006161 // Otherwise, the expression refers to a part of the base
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00006162 return getPrimaryDecl(cast<MemberExpr>(E)->getBase());
Anders Carlsson369dee42008-02-01 07:15:58 +00006163 case Stmt::ArraySubscriptExprClass: {
Mike Stump390b4cc2009-05-16 07:39:55 +00006164 // FIXME: This code shouldn't be necessary! We should catch the implicit
6165 // promotion of register arrays earlier.
Eli Friedman23d58ce2009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006166 Expr* Base = cast<ArraySubscriptExpr>(E)->getBase();
6167 if (ImplicitCastExpr* ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(Base)) {
6168 if (ICE->getSubExpr()->getType()->isArrayType())
6169 return getPrimaryDecl(ICE->getSubExpr());
6170 }
6171 return 0;
Anders Carlsson369dee42008-02-01 07:15:58 +00006172 }
Daniel Dunbar1e76ce62008-08-04 20:02:37 +00006173 case Stmt::UnaryOperatorClass: {
6174 UnaryOperator *UO = cast<UnaryOperator>(E);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006175
Daniel Dunbar1e76ce62008-08-04 20:02:37 +00006176 switch(UO->getOpcode()) {
Daniel Dunbar1e76ce62008-08-04 20:02:37 +00006177 case UnaryOperator::Real:
6178 case UnaryOperator::Imag:
6179 case UnaryOperator::Extension:
6180 return getPrimaryDecl(UO->getSubExpr());
6181 default:
6182 return 0;
6183 }
6184 }
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006185 case Stmt::ParenExprClass:
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00006186 return getPrimaryDecl(cast<ParenExpr>(E)->getSubExpr());
Chris Lattnerf82228f2007-11-16 17:46:48 +00006187 case Stmt::ImplicitCastExprClass:
Eli Friedman23d58ce2009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006188 // If the result of an implicit cast is an l-value, we care about
6189 // the sub-expression; otherwise, the result here doesn't matter.
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00006190 return getPrimaryDecl(cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(E)->getSubExpr());
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006191 default:
6192 return 0;
6193 }
6194}
6195
6196/// CheckAddressOfOperand - The operand of & must be either a function
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006197/// designator or an lvalue designating an object. If it is an lvalue, the
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006198/// object cannot be declared with storage class register or be a bit field.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006199/// Note: The usual conversions are *not* applied to the operand of the &
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006200/// operator (C99 6.3.2.1p[2-4]), and its result is never an lvalue.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006201/// In C++, the operand might be an overloaded function name, in which case
Douglas Gregor904eed32008-11-10 20:40:00 +00006202/// we allow the '&' but retain the overloaded-function type.
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006203QualType Sema::CheckAddressOfOperand(Expr *op, SourceLocation OpLoc) {
Eli Friedman23d58ce2009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006204 // Make sure to ignore parentheses in subsequent checks
6205 op = op->IgnoreParens();
6206
Douglas Gregor9103bb22008-12-17 22:52:20 +00006207 if (op->isTypeDependent())
6208 return Context.DependentTy;
6209
Steve Naroff08f19672008-01-13 17:10:08 +00006210 if (getLangOptions().C99) {
6211 // Implement C99-only parts of addressof rules.
6212 if (UnaryOperator* uOp = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(op)) {
6213 if (uOp->getOpcode() == UnaryOperator::Deref)
6214 // Per C99 6.5.3.2, the address of a deref always returns a valid result
6215 // (assuming the deref expression is valid).
6216 return uOp->getSubExpr()->getType();
6217 }
6218 // Technically, there should be a check for array subscript
6219 // expressions here, but the result of one is always an lvalue anyway.
6220 }
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00006221 NamedDecl *dcl = getPrimaryDecl(op);
Chris Lattner28be73f2008-07-26 21:30:36 +00006222 Expr::isLvalueResult lval = op->isLvalue(Context);
Nuno Lopes6b6609f2008-12-16 22:59:47 +00006223
Sebastian Redle27d87f2010-01-11 15:56:56 +00006224 MemberExpr *ME = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(op);
6225 if (lval == Expr::LV_MemberFunction && ME &&
6226 isa<CXXMethodDecl>(ME->getMemberDecl())) {
6227 ValueDecl *dcl = cast<MemberExpr>(op)->getMemberDecl();
6228 // &f where f is a member of the current object, or &o.f, or &p->f
6229 // All these are not allowed, and we need to catch them before the dcl
6230 // branch of the if, below.
6231 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_unqualified_pointer_member_function)
6232 << dcl;
6233 // FIXME: Improve this diagnostic and provide a fixit.
6234
6235 // Now recover by acting as if the function had been accessed qualified.
6236 return Context.getMemberPointerType(op->getType(),
6237 Context.getTypeDeclType(cast<RecordDecl>(dcl->getDeclContext()))
6238 .getTypePtr());
Chris Lattnerfd79a9d2010-07-05 19:17:26 +00006239 }
6240
6241 if (lval == Expr::LV_ClassTemporary) {
Douglas Gregore873fb72010-02-16 21:39:57 +00006242 Diag(OpLoc, isSFINAEContext()? diag::err_typecheck_addrof_class_temporary
6243 : diag::ext_typecheck_addrof_class_temporary)
6244 << op->getType() << op->getSourceRange();
6245 if (isSFINAEContext())
6246 return QualType();
Chris Lattnerc721ae82010-07-05 19:36:34 +00006247 } else if (isa<ObjCSelectorExpr>(op))
Chris Lattnerfd79a9d2010-07-05 19:17:26 +00006248 return Context.getPointerType(op->getType());
Chris Lattnerc721ae82010-07-05 19:36:34 +00006249 else if (lval != Expr::LV_Valid && lval != Expr::LV_IncompleteVoidType) {
Eli Friedman441cf102009-05-16 23:27:50 +00006250 // C99 6.5.3.2p1
Eli Friedman23d58ce2009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006251 // The operand must be either an l-value or a function designator
Eli Friedman441cf102009-05-16 23:27:50 +00006252 if (!op->getType()->isFunctionType()) {
Chris Lattnerf82228f2007-11-16 17:46:48 +00006253 // FIXME: emit more specific diag...
Chris Lattnerdcd5ef12008-11-19 05:27:50 +00006254 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_invalid_lvalue_addrof)
6255 << op->getSourceRange();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006256 return QualType();
6257 }
Douglas Gregor33bbbc52009-05-02 02:18:30 +00006258 } else if (op->getBitField()) { // C99 6.5.3.2p1
Eli Friedman23d58ce2009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006259 // The operand cannot be a bit-field
6260 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_address_of)
6261 << "bit-field" << op->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor86f19402008-12-20 23:49:58 +00006262 return QualType();
Anders Carlsson09380262010-01-31 17:18:49 +00006263 } else if (op->refersToVectorElement()) {
Eli Friedman23d58ce2009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006264 // The operand cannot be an element of a vector
Chris Lattnerd3a94e22008-11-20 06:06:08 +00006265 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_address_of)
Nate Begemanb104b1f2009-02-15 22:45:20 +00006266 << "vector element" << op->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroffbcb2b612008-02-29 23:30:25 +00006267 return QualType();
Fariborz Jahanian0337f212009-07-07 18:50:52 +00006268 } else if (isa<ObjCPropertyRefExpr>(op)) {
6269 // cannot take address of a property expression.
6270 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_address_of)
6271 << "property expression" << op->getSourceRange();
6272 return QualType();
Anders Carlsson1d524c32009-09-14 23:15:26 +00006273 } else if (ConditionalOperator *CO = dyn_cast<ConditionalOperator>(op)) {
6274 // FIXME: Can LHS ever be null here?
Anders Carlsson474e1022009-09-15 16:03:44 +00006275 if (!CheckAddressOfOperand(CO->getTrueExpr(), OpLoc).isNull())
6276 return CheckAddressOfOperand(CO->getFalseExpr(), OpLoc);
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00006277 } else if (isa<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(op)) {
6278 return Context.OverloadTy;
Steve Naroffbcb2b612008-02-29 23:30:25 +00006279 } else if (dcl) { // C99 6.5.3.2p1
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006280 // We have an lvalue with a decl. Make sure the decl is not declared
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006281 // with the register storage-class specifier.
6282 if (const VarDecl *vd = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(dcl)) {
6283 if (vd->getStorageClass() == VarDecl::Register) {
Chris Lattnerd3a94e22008-11-20 06:06:08 +00006284 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_address_of)
6285 << "register variable" << op->getSourceRange();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006286 return QualType();
6287 }
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00006288 } else if (isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(dcl)) {
Douglas Gregor904eed32008-11-10 20:40:00 +00006289 return Context.OverloadTy;
Anders Carlssonf9e48bd2009-07-08 21:45:58 +00006290 } else if (FieldDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(dcl)) {
Douglas Gregor29882052008-12-10 21:26:49 +00006291 // Okay: we can take the address of a field.
Sebastian Redlebc07d52009-02-03 20:19:35 +00006292 // Could be a pointer to member, though, if there is an explicit
6293 // scope qualifier for the class.
Douglas Gregora2813ce2009-10-23 18:54:35 +00006294 if (isa<DeclRefExpr>(op) && cast<DeclRefExpr>(op)->getQualifier()) {
Sebastian Redlebc07d52009-02-03 20:19:35 +00006295 DeclContext *Ctx = dcl->getDeclContext();
Anders Carlssonf9e48bd2009-07-08 21:45:58 +00006296 if (Ctx && Ctx->isRecord()) {
6297 if (FD->getType()->isReferenceType()) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006298 Diag(OpLoc,
Anders Carlssonf9e48bd2009-07-08 21:45:58 +00006299 diag::err_cannot_form_pointer_to_member_of_reference_type)
6300 << FD->getDeclName() << FD->getType();
6301 return QualType();
6302 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006303
Sebastian Redlebc07d52009-02-03 20:19:35 +00006304 return Context.getMemberPointerType(op->getType(),
6305 Context.getTypeDeclType(cast<RecordDecl>(Ctx)).getTypePtr());
Anders Carlssonf9e48bd2009-07-08 21:45:58 +00006306 }
Sebastian Redlebc07d52009-02-03 20:19:35 +00006307 }
Anders Carlsson196f7d02009-05-16 21:43:42 +00006308 } else if (CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(dcl)) {
Nuno Lopes6fea8d22008-12-16 22:58:26 +00006309 // Okay: we can take the address of a function.
Sebastian Redl33b399a2009-02-04 21:23:32 +00006310 // As above.
Douglas Gregora2813ce2009-10-23 18:54:35 +00006311 if (isa<DeclRefExpr>(op) && cast<DeclRefExpr>(op)->getQualifier() &&
6312 MD->isInstance())
Anders Carlsson196f7d02009-05-16 21:43:42 +00006313 return Context.getMemberPointerType(op->getType(),
6314 Context.getTypeDeclType(MD->getParent()).getTypePtr());
6315 } else if (!isa<FunctionDecl>(dcl))
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006316 assert(0 && "Unknown/unexpected decl type");
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006317 }
Sebastian Redl33b399a2009-02-04 21:23:32 +00006318
Eli Friedman441cf102009-05-16 23:27:50 +00006319 if (lval == Expr::LV_IncompleteVoidType) {
6320 // Taking the address of a void variable is technically illegal, but we
6321 // allow it in cases which are otherwise valid.
6322 // Example: "extern void x; void* y = &x;".
6323 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_typecheck_addrof_void) << op->getSourceRange();
6324 }
6325
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006326 // If the operand has type "type", the result has type "pointer to type".
Douglas Gregor8f70ddb2010-07-29 16:05:45 +00006327 if (op->getType()->isObjCObjectType())
6328 return Context.getObjCObjectPointerType(op->getType());
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006329 return Context.getPointerType(op->getType());
6330}
6331
Chris Lattnerfd79a9d2010-07-05 19:17:26 +00006332/// CheckIndirectionOperand - Type check unary indirection (prefix '*').
Chris Lattner22caddc2008-11-23 09:13:29 +00006333QualType Sema::CheckIndirectionOperand(Expr *Op, SourceLocation OpLoc) {
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006334 if (Op->isTypeDependent())
6335 return Context.DependentTy;
6336
Chris Lattner22caddc2008-11-23 09:13:29 +00006337 UsualUnaryConversions(Op);
Chris Lattnerfd79a9d2010-07-05 19:17:26 +00006338 QualType OpTy = Op->getType();
6339 QualType Result;
6340
6341 // Note that per both C89 and C99, indirection is always legal, even if OpTy
6342 // is an incomplete type or void. It would be possible to warn about
6343 // dereferencing a void pointer, but it's completely well-defined, and such a
6344 // warning is unlikely to catch any mistakes.
6345 if (const PointerType *PT = OpTy->getAs<PointerType>())
6346 Result = PT->getPointeeType();
6347 else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT =
6348 OpTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>())
6349 Result = OPT->getPointeeType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006350
Chris Lattnerfd79a9d2010-07-05 19:17:26 +00006351 if (Result.isNull()) {
6352 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_indirection_requires_pointer)
6353 << OpTy << Op->getSourceRange();
6354 return QualType();
6355 }
6356
6357 return Result;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006358}
6359
6360static inline BinaryOperator::Opcode ConvertTokenKindToBinaryOpcode(
6361 tok::TokenKind Kind) {
6362 BinaryOperator::Opcode Opc;
6363 switch (Kind) {
6364 default: assert(0 && "Unknown binop!");
Sebastian Redl22460502009-02-07 00:15:38 +00006365 case tok::periodstar: Opc = BinaryOperator::PtrMemD; break;
6366 case tok::arrowstar: Opc = BinaryOperator::PtrMemI; break;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006367 case tok::star: Opc = BinaryOperator::Mul; break;
6368 case tok::slash: Opc = BinaryOperator::Div; break;
6369 case tok::percent: Opc = BinaryOperator::Rem; break;
6370 case tok::plus: Opc = BinaryOperator::Add; break;
6371 case tok::minus: Opc = BinaryOperator::Sub; break;
6372 case tok::lessless: Opc = BinaryOperator::Shl; break;
6373 case tok::greatergreater: Opc = BinaryOperator::Shr; break;
6374 case tok::lessequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::LE; break;
6375 case tok::less: Opc = BinaryOperator::LT; break;
6376 case tok::greaterequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::GE; break;
6377 case tok::greater: Opc = BinaryOperator::GT; break;
6378 case tok::exclaimequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::NE; break;
6379 case tok::equalequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::EQ; break;
6380 case tok::amp: Opc = BinaryOperator::And; break;
6381 case tok::caret: Opc = BinaryOperator::Xor; break;
6382 case tok::pipe: Opc = BinaryOperator::Or; break;
6383 case tok::ampamp: Opc = BinaryOperator::LAnd; break;
6384 case tok::pipepipe: Opc = BinaryOperator::LOr; break;
6385 case tok::equal: Opc = BinaryOperator::Assign; break;
6386 case tok::starequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::MulAssign; break;
6387 case tok::slashequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::DivAssign; break;
6388 case tok::percentequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::RemAssign; break;
6389 case tok::plusequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::AddAssign; break;
6390 case tok::minusequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::SubAssign; break;
6391 case tok::lesslessequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::ShlAssign; break;
6392 case tok::greatergreaterequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::ShrAssign; break;
6393 case tok::ampequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::AndAssign; break;
6394 case tok::caretequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::XorAssign; break;
6395 case tok::pipeequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::OrAssign; break;
6396 case tok::comma: Opc = BinaryOperator::Comma; break;
6397 }
6398 return Opc;
6399}
6400
6401static inline UnaryOperator::Opcode ConvertTokenKindToUnaryOpcode(
6402 tok::TokenKind Kind) {
6403 UnaryOperator::Opcode Opc;
6404 switch (Kind) {
6405 default: assert(0 && "Unknown unary op!");
6406 case tok::plusplus: Opc = UnaryOperator::PreInc; break;
6407 case tok::minusminus: Opc = UnaryOperator::PreDec; break;
6408 case tok::amp: Opc = UnaryOperator::AddrOf; break;
6409 case tok::star: Opc = UnaryOperator::Deref; break;
6410 case tok::plus: Opc = UnaryOperator::Plus; break;
6411 case tok::minus: Opc = UnaryOperator::Minus; break;
6412 case tok::tilde: Opc = UnaryOperator::Not; break;
6413 case tok::exclaim: Opc = UnaryOperator::LNot; break;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006414 case tok::kw___real: Opc = UnaryOperator::Real; break;
6415 case tok::kw___imag: Opc = UnaryOperator::Imag; break;
6416 case tok::kw___extension__: Opc = UnaryOperator::Extension; break;
6417 }
6418 return Opc;
6419}
6420
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006421/// CreateBuiltinBinOp - Creates a new built-in binary operation with
6422/// operator @p Opc at location @c TokLoc. This routine only supports
6423/// built-in operations; ActOnBinOp handles overloaded operators.
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00006424Action::OwningExprResult Sema::CreateBuiltinBinOp(SourceLocation OpLoc,
6425 unsigned Op,
6426 Expr *lhs, Expr *rhs) {
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006427 QualType ResultTy; // Result type of the binary operator.
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006428 BinaryOperator::Opcode Opc = (BinaryOperator::Opcode)Op;
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006429 // The following two variables are used for compound assignment operators
6430 QualType CompLHSTy; // Type of LHS after promotions for computation
6431 QualType CompResultTy; // Type of computation result
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006432
6433 switch (Opc) {
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006434 case BinaryOperator::Assign:
6435 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, QualType());
6436 break;
Sebastian Redl22460502009-02-07 00:15:38 +00006437 case BinaryOperator::PtrMemD:
6438 case BinaryOperator::PtrMemI:
6439 ResultTy = CheckPointerToMemberOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc,
6440 Opc == BinaryOperator::PtrMemI);
6441 break;
6442 case BinaryOperator::Mul:
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006443 case BinaryOperator::Div:
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00006444 ResultTy = CheckMultiplyDivideOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, false,
6445 Opc == BinaryOperator::Div);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006446 break;
6447 case BinaryOperator::Rem:
6448 ResultTy = CheckRemainderOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6449 break;
6450 case BinaryOperator::Add:
6451 ResultTy = CheckAdditionOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6452 break;
6453 case BinaryOperator::Sub:
6454 ResultTy = CheckSubtractionOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6455 break;
Sebastian Redl22460502009-02-07 00:15:38 +00006456 case BinaryOperator::Shl:
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006457 case BinaryOperator::Shr:
6458 ResultTy = CheckShiftOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6459 break;
6460 case BinaryOperator::LE:
6461 case BinaryOperator::LT:
6462 case BinaryOperator::GE:
6463 case BinaryOperator::GT:
Douglas Gregora86b8322009-04-06 18:45:53 +00006464 ResultTy = CheckCompareOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, Opc, true);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006465 break;
6466 case BinaryOperator::EQ:
6467 case BinaryOperator::NE:
Douglas Gregora86b8322009-04-06 18:45:53 +00006468 ResultTy = CheckCompareOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, Opc, false);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006469 break;
6470 case BinaryOperator::And:
6471 case BinaryOperator::Xor:
6472 case BinaryOperator::Or:
6473 ResultTy = CheckBitwiseOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6474 break;
6475 case BinaryOperator::LAnd:
6476 case BinaryOperator::LOr:
Chris Lattner90a8f272010-07-13 19:41:32 +00006477 ResultTy = CheckLogicalOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, Opc);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006478 break;
6479 case BinaryOperator::MulAssign:
6480 case BinaryOperator::DivAssign:
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00006481 CompResultTy = CheckMultiplyDivideOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, true,
6482 Opc == BinaryOperator::DivAssign);
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006483 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
6484 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6485 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006486 break;
6487 case BinaryOperator::RemAssign:
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006488 CompResultTy = CheckRemainderOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, true);
6489 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
6490 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6491 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006492 break;
6493 case BinaryOperator::AddAssign:
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006494 CompResultTy = CheckAdditionOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, &CompLHSTy);
6495 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6496 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006497 break;
6498 case BinaryOperator::SubAssign:
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006499 CompResultTy = CheckSubtractionOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, &CompLHSTy);
6500 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6501 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006502 break;
6503 case BinaryOperator::ShlAssign:
6504 case BinaryOperator::ShrAssign:
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006505 CompResultTy = CheckShiftOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, true);
6506 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
6507 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6508 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006509 break;
6510 case BinaryOperator::AndAssign:
6511 case BinaryOperator::XorAssign:
6512 case BinaryOperator::OrAssign:
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006513 CompResultTy = CheckBitwiseOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, true);
6514 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
6515 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6516 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006517 break;
6518 case BinaryOperator::Comma:
6519 ResultTy = CheckCommaOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6520 break;
6521 }
6522 if (ResultTy.isNull())
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00006523 return ExprError();
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006524 if (CompResultTy.isNull())
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00006525 return Owned(new (Context) BinaryOperator(lhs, rhs, Opc, ResultTy, OpLoc));
6526 else
6527 return Owned(new (Context) CompoundAssignOperator(lhs, rhs, Opc, ResultTy,
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006528 CompLHSTy, CompResultTy,
6529 OpLoc));
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006530}
6531
Sebastian Redlaee3c932009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006532/// SuggestParentheses - Emit a diagnostic together with a fixit hint that wraps
6533/// ParenRange in parentheses.
Sebastian Redl6b169ac2009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006534static void SuggestParentheses(Sema &Self, SourceLocation Loc,
6535 const PartialDiagnostic &PD,
Douglas Gregor55b38842010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006536 const PartialDiagnostic &FirstNote,
6537 SourceRange FirstParenRange,
6538 const PartialDiagnostic &SecondNote,
Douglas Gregorfe6b2d42010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006539 SourceRange SecondParenRange) {
Douglas Gregor55b38842010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006540 Self.Diag(Loc, PD);
6541
6542 if (!FirstNote.getDiagID())
6543 return;
6544
6545 SourceLocation EndLoc = Self.PP.getLocForEndOfToken(FirstParenRange.getEnd());
6546 if (!FirstParenRange.getEnd().isFileID() || EndLoc.isInvalid()) {
6547 // We can't display the parentheses, so just return.
Sebastian Redl6b169ac2009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006548 return;
6549 }
6550
Douglas Gregor55b38842010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006551 Self.Diag(Loc, FirstNote)
6552 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(FirstParenRange.getBegin(), "(")
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00006553 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(EndLoc, ")");
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006554
Douglas Gregor55b38842010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006555 if (!SecondNote.getDiagID())
Douglas Gregor827feec2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006556 return;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006557
Douglas Gregor827feec2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006558 EndLoc = Self.PP.getLocForEndOfToken(SecondParenRange.getEnd());
6559 if (!SecondParenRange.getEnd().isFileID() || EndLoc.isInvalid()) {
6560 // We can't display the parentheses, so just dig the
6561 // warning/error and return.
Douglas Gregor55b38842010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006562 Self.Diag(Loc, SecondNote);
Douglas Gregor827feec2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006563 return;
6564 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006565
Douglas Gregor55b38842010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006566 Self.Diag(Loc, SecondNote)
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00006567 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(SecondParenRange.getBegin(), "(")
6568 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(EndLoc, ")");
Sebastian Redl6b169ac2009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006569}
6570
Sebastian Redlaee3c932009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006571/// DiagnoseBitwisePrecedence - Emit a warning when bitwise and comparison
6572/// operators are mixed in a way that suggests that the programmer forgot that
6573/// comparison operators have higher precedence. The most typical example of
6574/// such code is "flags & 0x0020 != 0", which is equivalent to "flags & 1".
Sebastian Redl9e1d29b2009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006575static void DiagnoseBitwisePrecedence(Sema &Self, BinaryOperator::Opcode Opc,
6576 SourceLocation OpLoc,Expr *lhs,Expr *rhs){
Sebastian Redlaee3c932009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006577 typedef BinaryOperator BinOp;
6578 BinOp::Opcode lhsopc = static_cast<BinOp::Opcode>(-1),
6579 rhsopc = static_cast<BinOp::Opcode>(-1);
6580 if (BinOp *BO = dyn_cast<BinOp>(lhs))
Sebastian Redl9e1d29b2009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006581 lhsopc = BO->getOpcode();
Sebastian Redlaee3c932009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006582 if (BinOp *BO = dyn_cast<BinOp>(rhs))
Sebastian Redl9e1d29b2009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006583 rhsopc = BO->getOpcode();
6584
6585 // Subs are not binary operators.
6586 if (lhsopc == -1 && rhsopc == -1)
6587 return;
6588
6589 // Bitwise operations are sometimes used as eager logical ops.
6590 // Don't diagnose this.
Sebastian Redlaee3c932009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006591 if ((BinOp::isComparisonOp(lhsopc) || BinOp::isBitwiseOp(lhsopc)) &&
6592 (BinOp::isComparisonOp(rhsopc) || BinOp::isBitwiseOp(rhsopc)))
Sebastian Redl9e1d29b2009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006593 return;
6594
Sebastian Redlaee3c932009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006595 if (BinOp::isComparisonOp(lhsopc))
Sebastian Redl6b169ac2009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006596 SuggestParentheses(Self, OpLoc,
Douglas Gregorfe6b2d42010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006597 Self.PDiag(diag::warn_precedence_bitwise_rel)
Sebastian Redlaee3c932009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006598 << SourceRange(lhs->getLocStart(), OpLoc)
6599 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(Opc) << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(lhsopc),
Douglas Gregorfe6b2d42010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006600 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_bitwise_first)
Douglas Gregor827feec2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006601 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(Opc),
Douglas Gregor55b38842010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006602 SourceRange(cast<BinOp>(lhs)->getRHS()->getLocStart(), rhs->getLocEnd()),
6603 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_bitwise_silence)
6604 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(lhsopc),
6605 lhs->getSourceRange());
Sebastian Redlaee3c932009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006606 else if (BinOp::isComparisonOp(rhsopc))
Sebastian Redl6b169ac2009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006607 SuggestParentheses(Self, OpLoc,
Douglas Gregorfe6b2d42010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006608 Self.PDiag(diag::warn_precedence_bitwise_rel)
Sebastian Redlaee3c932009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006609 << SourceRange(OpLoc, rhs->getLocEnd())
6610 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(Opc) << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(rhsopc),
Douglas Gregorfe6b2d42010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006611 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_bitwise_first)
Douglas Gregor827feec2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006612 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(Opc),
Douglas Gregor55b38842010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006613 SourceRange(lhs->getLocEnd(), cast<BinOp>(rhs)->getLHS()->getLocStart()),
6614 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_bitwise_silence)
6615 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(rhsopc),
6616 rhs->getSourceRange());
Sebastian Redl9e1d29b2009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006617}
6618
6619/// DiagnoseBinOpPrecedence - Emit warnings for expressions with tricky
6620/// precedence. This currently diagnoses only "arg1 'bitwise' arg2 'eq' arg3".
6621/// But it could also warn about arg1 && arg2 || arg3, as GCC 4.3+ does.
6622static void DiagnoseBinOpPrecedence(Sema &Self, BinaryOperator::Opcode Opc,
6623 SourceLocation OpLoc, Expr *lhs, Expr *rhs){
Sebastian Redlaee3c932009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006624 if (BinaryOperator::isBitwiseOp(Opc))
Sebastian Redl9e1d29b2009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006625 DiagnoseBitwisePrecedence(Self, Opc, OpLoc, lhs, rhs);
6626}
6627
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006628// Binary Operators. 'Tok' is the token for the operator.
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00006629Action::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnBinOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation TokLoc,
6630 tok::TokenKind Kind,
6631 ExprArg LHS, ExprArg RHS) {
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006632 BinaryOperator::Opcode Opc = ConvertTokenKindToBinaryOpcode(Kind);
Anders Carlssone9146f22009-05-01 19:49:17 +00006633 Expr *lhs = LHS.takeAs<Expr>(), *rhs = RHS.takeAs<Expr>();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006634
Steve Narofff69936d2007-09-16 03:34:24 +00006635 assert((lhs != 0) && "ActOnBinOp(): missing left expression");
6636 assert((rhs != 0) && "ActOnBinOp(): missing right expression");
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006637
Sebastian Redl9e1d29b2009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006638 // Emit warnings for tricky precedence issues, e.g. "bitfield & 0x4 == 0"
6639 DiagnoseBinOpPrecedence(*this, Opc, TokLoc, lhs, rhs);
6640
Douglas Gregor6ca7cfb2009-11-05 00:51:44 +00006641 return BuildBinOp(S, TokLoc, Opc, lhs, rhs);
6642}
6643
6644Action::OwningExprResult Sema::BuildBinOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
6645 BinaryOperator::Opcode Opc,
6646 Expr *lhs, Expr *rhs) {
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +00006647 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006648 (lhs->getType()->isOverloadableType() ||
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +00006649 rhs->getType()->isOverloadableType())) {
6650 // Find all of the overloaded operators visible from this
6651 // point. We perform both an operator-name lookup from the local
6652 // scope and an argument-dependent lookup based on the types of
6653 // the arguments.
John McCall6e266892010-01-26 03:27:55 +00006654 UnresolvedSet<16> Functions;
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +00006655 OverloadedOperatorKind OverOp = BinaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc);
John McCall6e266892010-01-26 03:27:55 +00006656 if (S && OverOp != OO_None)
6657 LookupOverloadedOperatorName(OverOp, S, lhs->getType(), rhs->getType(),
6658 Functions);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006659
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +00006660 // Build the (potentially-overloaded, potentially-dependent)
6661 // binary operation.
Douglas Gregor6ca7cfb2009-11-05 00:51:44 +00006662 return CreateOverloadedBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Functions, lhs, rhs);
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00006663 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006664
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006665 // Build a built-in binary operation.
Douglas Gregor6ca7cfb2009-11-05 00:51:44 +00006666 return CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, lhs, rhs);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006667}
6668
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006669Action::OwningExprResult Sema::CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(SourceLocation OpLoc,
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006670 unsigned OpcIn,
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006671 ExprArg InputArg) {
6672 UnaryOperator::Opcode Opc = static_cast<UnaryOperator::Opcode>(OpcIn);
Douglas Gregor74253732008-11-19 15:42:04 +00006673
Mike Stump390b4cc2009-05-16 07:39:55 +00006674 // FIXME: Input is modified below, but InputArg is not updated appropriately.
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006675 Expr *Input = (Expr *)InputArg.get();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006676 QualType resultType;
6677 switch (Opc) {
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006678 case UnaryOperator::OffsetOf:
6679 assert(false && "Invalid unary operator");
6680 break;
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006681
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006682 case UnaryOperator::PreInc:
6683 case UnaryOperator::PreDec:
Eli Friedmande99a452009-07-22 22:25:00 +00006684 case UnaryOperator::PostInc:
6685 case UnaryOperator::PostDec:
Sebastian Redle6d5a4a2008-12-20 09:35:34 +00006686 resultType = CheckIncrementDecrementOperand(Input, OpLoc,
Eli Friedmande99a452009-07-22 22:25:00 +00006687 Opc == UnaryOperator::PreInc ||
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00006688 Opc == UnaryOperator::PostInc,
6689 Opc == UnaryOperator::PreInc ||
6690 Opc == UnaryOperator::PreDec);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006691 break;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006692 case UnaryOperator::AddrOf:
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006693 resultType = CheckAddressOfOperand(Input, OpLoc);
6694 break;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006695 case UnaryOperator::Deref:
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +00006696 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Input);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006697 resultType = CheckIndirectionOperand(Input, OpLoc);
6698 break;
6699 case UnaryOperator::Plus:
6700 case UnaryOperator::Minus:
Steve Naroffc80b4ee2007-07-16 21:54:35 +00006701 UsualUnaryConversions(Input);
6702 resultType = Input->getType();
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006703 if (resultType->isDependentType())
6704 break;
Douglas Gregor00619622010-06-22 23:41:02 +00006705 if (resultType->isArithmeticType() || // C99 6.5.3.3p1
6706 resultType->isVectorType())
Douglas Gregor74253732008-11-19 15:42:04 +00006707 break;
6708 else if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && // C++ [expr.unary.op]p6-7
6709 resultType->isEnumeralType())
6710 break;
6711 else if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && // C++ [expr.unary.op]p6
6712 Opc == UnaryOperator::Plus &&
6713 resultType->isPointerType())
6714 break;
6715
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00006716 return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr)
6717 << resultType << Input->getSourceRange());
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006718 case UnaryOperator::Not: // bitwise complement
Steve Naroffc80b4ee2007-07-16 21:54:35 +00006719 UsualUnaryConversions(Input);
6720 resultType = Input->getType();
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006721 if (resultType->isDependentType())
6722 break;
Chris Lattner02a65142008-07-25 23:52:49 +00006723 // C99 6.5.3.3p1. We allow complex int and float as a GCC extension.
6724 if (resultType->isComplexType() || resultType->isComplexIntegerType())
6725 // C99 does not support '~' for complex conjugation.
Chris Lattnerd3a94e22008-11-20 06:06:08 +00006726 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_integer_complement_complex)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00006727 << resultType << Input->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregorf6094622010-07-23 15:58:24 +00006728 else if (!resultType->hasIntegerRepresentation())
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00006729 return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr)
6730 << resultType << Input->getSourceRange());
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006731 break;
6732 case UnaryOperator::LNot: // logical negation
6733 // Unlike +/-/~, integer promotions aren't done here (C99 6.5.3.3p5).
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +00006734 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Input);
Steve Naroffc80b4ee2007-07-16 21:54:35 +00006735 resultType = Input->getType();
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006736 if (resultType->isDependentType())
6737 break;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006738 if (!resultType->isScalarType()) // C99 6.5.3.3p1
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00006739 return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr)
6740 << resultType << Input->getSourceRange());
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006741 // LNot always has type int. C99 6.5.3.3p5.
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00006742 // In C++, it's bool. C++ 5.3.1p8
6743 resultType = getLangOptions().CPlusPlus ? Context.BoolTy : Context.IntTy;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006744 break;
Chris Lattnerdbb36972007-08-24 21:16:53 +00006745 case UnaryOperator::Real:
Chris Lattnerdbb36972007-08-24 21:16:53 +00006746 case UnaryOperator::Imag:
Chris Lattnerba27e2a2009-02-17 08:12:06 +00006747 resultType = CheckRealImagOperand(Input, OpLoc, Opc == UnaryOperator::Real);
Chris Lattnerdbb36972007-08-24 21:16:53 +00006748 break;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006749 case UnaryOperator::Extension:
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006750 resultType = Input->getType();
6751 break;
6752 }
6753 if (resultType.isNull())
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00006754 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006755
6756 InputArg.release();
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00006757 return Owned(new (Context) UnaryOperator(Input, Opc, resultType, OpLoc));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006758}
6759
Douglas Gregor6ca7cfb2009-11-05 00:51:44 +00006760Action::OwningExprResult Sema::BuildUnaryOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
6761 UnaryOperator::Opcode Opc,
6762 ExprArg input) {
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006763 Expr *Input = (Expr*)input.get();
Anders Carlssona8a1e3d2009-11-14 21:26:41 +00006764 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && Input->getType()->isOverloadableType() &&
6765 Opc != UnaryOperator::Extension) {
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006766 // Find all of the overloaded operators visible from this
6767 // point. We perform both an operator-name lookup from the local
6768 // scope and an argument-dependent lookup based on the types of
6769 // the arguments.
John McCall6e266892010-01-26 03:27:55 +00006770 UnresolvedSet<16> Functions;
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006771 OverloadedOperatorKind OverOp = UnaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc);
John McCall6e266892010-01-26 03:27:55 +00006772 if (S && OverOp != OO_None)
6773 LookupOverloadedOperatorName(OverOp, S, Input->getType(), QualType(),
6774 Functions);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006775
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006776 return CreateOverloadedUnaryOp(OpLoc, Opc, Functions, move(input));
6777 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006778
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006779 return CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(OpLoc, Opc, move(input));
6780}
6781
Douglas Gregor6ca7cfb2009-11-05 00:51:44 +00006782// Unary Operators. 'Tok' is the token for the operator.
6783Action::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnUnaryOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
6784 tok::TokenKind Op, ExprArg input) {
6785 return BuildUnaryOp(S, OpLoc, ConvertTokenKindToUnaryOpcode(Op), move(input));
6786}
6787
Steve Naroff1b273c42007-09-16 14:56:35 +00006788/// ActOnAddrLabel - Parse the GNU address of label extension: "&&foo".
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006789Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnAddrLabel(SourceLocation OpLoc,
6790 SourceLocation LabLoc,
6791 IdentifierInfo *LabelII) {
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006792 // Look up the record for this label identifier.
Chris Lattnerea29a3a2009-04-18 20:01:55 +00006793 LabelStmt *&LabelDecl = getLabelMap()[LabelII];
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006794
Daniel Dunbar0ffb1252008-08-04 16:51:22 +00006795 // If we haven't seen this label yet, create a forward reference. It
6796 // will be validated and/or cleaned up in ActOnFinishFunctionBody.
Steve Naroffcaaacec2009-03-13 15:38:40 +00006797 if (LabelDecl == 0)
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00006798 LabelDecl = new (Context) LabelStmt(LabLoc, LabelII, 0);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006799
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006800 // Create the AST node. The address of a label always has type 'void*'.
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006801 return Owned(new (Context) AddrLabelExpr(OpLoc, LabLoc, LabelDecl,
6802 Context.getPointerType(Context.VoidTy)));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006803}
6804
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006805Sema::OwningExprResult
6806Sema::ActOnStmtExpr(SourceLocation LPLoc, StmtArg substmt,
6807 SourceLocation RPLoc) { // "({..})"
6808 Stmt *SubStmt = static_cast<Stmt*>(substmt.get());
Chris Lattnerab18c4c2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00006809 assert(SubStmt && isa<CompoundStmt>(SubStmt) && "Invalid action invocation!");
6810 CompoundStmt *Compound = cast<CompoundStmt>(SubStmt);
6811
Douglas Gregordd8f5692010-03-10 04:54:39 +00006812 bool isFileScope
6813 = (getCurFunctionOrMethodDecl() == 0) && (getCurBlock() == 0);
Chris Lattner4a049f02009-04-25 19:11:05 +00006814 if (isFileScope)
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006815 return ExprError(Diag(LPLoc, diag::err_stmtexpr_file_scope));
Eli Friedmandca2b732009-01-24 23:09:00 +00006816
Chris Lattnerab18c4c2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00006817 // FIXME: there are a variety of strange constraints to enforce here, for
6818 // example, it is not possible to goto into a stmt expression apparently.
6819 // More semantic analysis is needed.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006820
Chris Lattnerab18c4c2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00006821 // If there are sub stmts in the compound stmt, take the type of the last one
6822 // as the type of the stmtexpr.
6823 QualType Ty = Context.VoidTy;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006824
Chris Lattner611b2ec2008-07-26 19:51:01 +00006825 if (!Compound->body_empty()) {
6826 Stmt *LastStmt = Compound->body_back();
6827 // If LastStmt is a label, skip down through into the body.
6828 while (LabelStmt *Label = dyn_cast<LabelStmt>(LastStmt))
6829 LastStmt = Label->getSubStmt();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006830
Chris Lattner611b2ec2008-07-26 19:51:01 +00006831 if (Expr *LastExpr = dyn_cast<Expr>(LastStmt))
Chris Lattnerab18c4c2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00006832 Ty = LastExpr->getType();
Chris Lattner611b2ec2008-07-26 19:51:01 +00006833 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006834
Eli Friedmanb1d796d2009-03-23 00:24:07 +00006835 // FIXME: Check that expression type is complete/non-abstract; statement
6836 // expressions are not lvalues.
6837
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006838 substmt.release();
6839 return Owned(new (Context) StmtExpr(Compound, Ty, LPLoc, RPLoc));
Chris Lattnerab18c4c2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00006840}
Steve Naroffd34e9152007-08-01 22:05:33 +00006841
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006842Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::BuildBuiltinOffsetOf(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
6843 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006844 OffsetOfComponent *CompPtr,
6845 unsigned NumComponents,
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006846 SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
6847 QualType ArgTy = TInfo->getType();
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006848 bool Dependent = ArgTy->isDependentType();
Abramo Bagnarabd054db2010-05-20 10:00:11 +00006849 SourceRange TypeRange = TInfo->getTypeLoc().getLocalSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006850
Chris Lattner73d0d4f2007-08-30 17:45:32 +00006851 // We must have at least one component that refers to the type, and the first
6852 // one is known to be a field designator. Verify that the ArgTy represents
6853 // a struct/union/class.
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006854 if (!Dependent && !ArgTy->isRecordType())
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006855 return ExprError(Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::err_offsetof_record_type)
6856 << ArgTy << TypeRange);
6857
6858 // Type must be complete per C99 7.17p3 because a declaring a variable
6859 // with an incomplete type would be ill-formed.
6860 if (!Dependent
6861 && RequireCompleteType(BuiltinLoc, ArgTy,
6862 PDiag(diag::err_offsetof_incomplete_type)
6863 << TypeRange))
6864 return ExprError();
6865
Chris Lattner9e2b75c2007-08-31 21:49:13 +00006866 // offsetof with non-identifier designators (e.g. "offsetof(x, a.b[c])") are a
6867 // GCC extension, diagnose them.
Eli Friedman35183ac2009-02-27 06:44:11 +00006868 // FIXME: This diagnostic isn't actually visible because the location is in
6869 // a system header!
Chris Lattner9e2b75c2007-08-31 21:49:13 +00006870 if (NumComponents != 1)
Chris Lattnerdcd5ef12008-11-19 05:27:50 +00006871 Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::ext_offsetof_extended_field_designator)
6872 << SourceRange(CompPtr[1].LocStart, CompPtr[NumComponents-1].LocEnd);
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006873
6874 bool DidWarnAboutNonPOD = false;
6875 QualType CurrentType = ArgTy;
6876 typedef OffsetOfExpr::OffsetOfNode OffsetOfNode;
6877 llvm::SmallVector<OffsetOfNode, 4> Comps;
6878 llvm::SmallVector<Expr*, 4> Exprs;
6879 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumComponents; ++i) {
6880 const OffsetOfComponent &OC = CompPtr[i];
6881 if (OC.isBrackets) {
6882 // Offset of an array sub-field. TODO: Should we allow vector elements?
6883 if (!CurrentType->isDependentType()) {
6884 const ArrayType *AT = Context.getAsArrayType(CurrentType);
6885 if(!AT)
6886 return ExprError(Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_array_type)
6887 << CurrentType);
6888 CurrentType = AT->getElementType();
6889 } else
6890 CurrentType = Context.DependentTy;
6891
6892 // The expression must be an integral expression.
6893 // FIXME: An integral constant expression?
6894 Expr *Idx = static_cast<Expr*>(OC.U.E);
6895 if (!Idx->isTypeDependent() && !Idx->isValueDependent() &&
6896 !Idx->getType()->isIntegerType())
6897 return ExprError(Diag(Idx->getLocStart(),
6898 diag::err_typecheck_subscript_not_integer)
6899 << Idx->getSourceRange());
6900
6901 // Record this array index.
6902 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, Exprs.size(), OC.LocEnd));
6903 Exprs.push_back(Idx);
6904 continue;
6905 }
6906
6907 // Offset of a field.
6908 if (CurrentType->isDependentType()) {
6909 // We have the offset of a field, but we can't look into the dependent
6910 // type. Just record the identifier of the field.
6911 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, OC.U.IdentInfo, OC.LocEnd));
6912 CurrentType = Context.DependentTy;
6913 continue;
6914 }
6915
6916 // We need to have a complete type to look into.
6917 if (RequireCompleteType(OC.LocStart, CurrentType,
6918 diag::err_offsetof_incomplete_type))
6919 return ExprError();
6920
6921 // Look for the designated field.
6922 const RecordType *RC = CurrentType->getAs<RecordType>();
6923 if (!RC)
6924 return ExprError(Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_record_type)
6925 << CurrentType);
6926 RecordDecl *RD = RC->getDecl();
6927
6928 // C++ [lib.support.types]p5:
6929 // The macro offsetof accepts a restricted set of type arguments in this
6930 // International Standard. type shall be a POD structure or a POD union
6931 // (clause 9).
6932 if (CXXRecordDecl *CRD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD)) {
6933 if (!CRD->isPOD() && !DidWarnAboutNonPOD &&
6934 DiagRuntimeBehavior(BuiltinLoc,
6935 PDiag(diag::warn_offsetof_non_pod_type)
6936 << SourceRange(CompPtr[0].LocStart, OC.LocEnd)
6937 << CurrentType))
6938 DidWarnAboutNonPOD = true;
6939 }
6940
6941 // Look for the field.
6942 LookupResult R(*this, OC.U.IdentInfo, OC.LocStart, LookupMemberName);
6943 LookupQualifiedName(R, RD);
6944 FieldDecl *MemberDecl = R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>();
6945 if (!MemberDecl)
6946 return ExprError(Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::err_no_member)
6947 << OC.U.IdentInfo << RD << SourceRange(OC.LocStart,
6948 OC.LocEnd));
6949
Douglas Gregor9d5d60f2010-04-28 22:36:06 +00006950 // C99 7.17p3:
6951 // (If the specified member is a bit-field, the behavior is undefined.)
6952 //
6953 // We diagnose this as an error.
6954 if (MemberDecl->getBitWidth()) {
6955 Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_bitfield)
6956 << MemberDecl->getDeclName()
6957 << SourceRange(BuiltinLoc, RParenLoc);
6958 Diag(MemberDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_bitfield_decl);
6959 return ExprError();
6960 }
Eli Friedman19410a72010-08-05 10:11:36 +00006961
6962 RecordDecl *Parent = MemberDecl->getParent();
6963 bool AnonStructUnion = Parent->isAnonymousStructOrUnion();
6964 if (AnonStructUnion) {
6965 do {
6966 Parent = cast<RecordDecl>(Parent->getParent());
6967 } while (Parent->isAnonymousStructOrUnion());
6968 }
6969
Douglas Gregorcc8a5d52010-04-29 00:18:15 +00006970 // If the member was found in a base class, introduce OffsetOfNodes for
6971 // the base class indirections.
6972 CXXBasePaths Paths(/*FindAmbiguities=*/true, /*RecordPaths=*/true,
6973 /*DetectVirtual=*/false);
Eli Friedman19410a72010-08-05 10:11:36 +00006974 if (IsDerivedFrom(CurrentType, Context.getTypeDeclType(Parent), Paths)) {
Douglas Gregorcc8a5d52010-04-29 00:18:15 +00006975 CXXBasePath &Path = Paths.front();
6976 for (CXXBasePath::iterator B = Path.begin(), BEnd = Path.end();
6977 B != BEnd; ++B)
6978 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(B->Base));
6979 }
Eli Friedman19410a72010-08-05 10:11:36 +00006980
6981 if (AnonStructUnion) {
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006982 llvm::SmallVector<FieldDecl*, 4> Path;
6983 BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberPath(MemberDecl, Path);
6984 unsigned n = Path.size();
6985 for (int j = n - 1; j > -1; --j)
6986 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, Path[j], OC.LocEnd));
6987 } else {
6988 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, MemberDecl, OC.LocEnd));
6989 }
6990 CurrentType = MemberDecl->getType().getNonReferenceType();
6991 }
6992
6993 return Owned(OffsetOfExpr::Create(Context, Context.getSizeType(), BuiltinLoc,
6994 TInfo, Comps.data(), Comps.size(),
6995 Exprs.data(), Exprs.size(), RParenLoc));
6996}
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006997
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006998Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnBuiltinOffsetOf(Scope *S,
6999 SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
7000 SourceLocation TypeLoc,
7001 TypeTy *argty,
7002 OffsetOfComponent *CompPtr,
7003 unsigned NumComponents,
7004 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
7005
7006 TypeSourceInfo *ArgTInfo;
7007 QualType ArgTy = GetTypeFromParser(argty, &ArgTInfo);
7008 if (ArgTy.isNull())
7009 return ExprError();
7010
Eli Friedman5a15dc12010-08-05 10:15:45 +00007011 if (!ArgTInfo)
7012 ArgTInfo = Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(ArgTy, TypeLoc);
7013
7014 return BuildBuiltinOffsetOf(BuiltinLoc, ArgTInfo, CompPtr, NumComponents,
7015 RPLoc);
Chris Lattner73d0d4f2007-08-30 17:45:32 +00007016}
7017
7018
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007019Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnTypesCompatibleExpr(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
7020 TypeTy *arg1,TypeTy *arg2,
7021 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
Abramo Bagnara3fcb73d2010-08-10 08:50:03 +00007022 TypeSourceInfo *argTInfo1;
7023 QualType argT1 = GetTypeFromParser(arg1, &argTInfo1);
7024 TypeSourceInfo *argTInfo2;
7025 QualType argT2 = GetTypeFromParser(arg2, &argTInfo2);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007026
Steve Naroffd34e9152007-08-01 22:05:33 +00007027 assert((!argT1.isNull() && !argT2.isNull()) && "Missing type argument(s)");
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007028
Abramo Bagnara3fcb73d2010-08-10 08:50:03 +00007029 return BuildTypesCompatibleExpr(BuiltinLoc, argTInfo1, argTInfo2, RPLoc);
7030}
7031
7032Sema::OwningExprResult
7033Sema::BuildTypesCompatibleExpr(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
7034 TypeSourceInfo *argTInfo1,
7035 TypeSourceInfo *argTInfo2,
7036 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
Douglas Gregorc12a9c52009-05-19 22:28:02 +00007037 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
7038 Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::err_types_compatible_p_in_cplusplus)
7039 << SourceRange(BuiltinLoc, RPLoc);
7040 return ExprError();
7041 }
7042
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007043 return Owned(new (Context) TypesCompatibleExpr(Context.IntTy, BuiltinLoc,
Abramo Bagnara3fcb73d2010-08-10 08:50:03 +00007044 argTInfo1, argTInfo2, RPLoc));
Steve Naroffd34e9152007-08-01 22:05:33 +00007045}
7046
Abramo Bagnara3fcb73d2010-08-10 08:50:03 +00007047
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007048Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnChooseExpr(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
7049 ExprArg cond,
7050 ExprArg expr1, ExprArg expr2,
7051 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
7052 Expr *CondExpr = static_cast<Expr*>(cond.get());
7053 Expr *LHSExpr = static_cast<Expr*>(expr1.get());
7054 Expr *RHSExpr = static_cast<Expr*>(expr2.get());
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007055
Steve Naroffd04fdd52007-08-03 21:21:27 +00007056 assert((CondExpr && LHSExpr && RHSExpr) && "Missing type argument(s)");
7057
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007058 QualType resType;
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00007059 bool ValueDependent = false;
Douglas Gregorc9ecc572009-05-19 22:43:30 +00007060 if (CondExpr->isTypeDependent() || CondExpr->isValueDependent()) {
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007061 resType = Context.DependentTy;
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00007062 ValueDependent = true;
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007063 } else {
7064 // The conditional expression is required to be a constant expression.
7065 llvm::APSInt condEval(32);
7066 SourceLocation ExpLoc;
7067 if (!CondExpr->isIntegerConstantExpr(condEval, Context, &ExpLoc))
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007068 return ExprError(Diag(ExpLoc,
7069 diag::err_typecheck_choose_expr_requires_constant)
7070 << CondExpr->getSourceRange());
Steve Naroffd04fdd52007-08-03 21:21:27 +00007071
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007072 // If the condition is > zero, then the AST type is the same as the LSHExpr.
7073 resType = condEval.getZExtValue() ? LHSExpr->getType() : RHSExpr->getType();
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00007074 ValueDependent = condEval.getZExtValue() ? LHSExpr->isValueDependent()
7075 : RHSExpr->isValueDependent();
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007076 }
7077
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007078 cond.release(); expr1.release(); expr2.release();
7079 return Owned(new (Context) ChooseExpr(BuiltinLoc, CondExpr, LHSExpr, RHSExpr,
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00007080 resType, RPLoc,
7081 resType->isDependentType(),
7082 ValueDependent));
Steve Naroffd04fdd52007-08-03 21:21:27 +00007083}
7084
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007085//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
7086// Clang Extensions.
7087//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
7088
7089/// ActOnBlockStart - This callback is invoked when a block literal is started.
Steve Naroff090276f2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007090void Sema::ActOnBlockStart(SourceLocation CaretLoc, Scope *BlockScope) {
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007091 BlockDecl *Block = BlockDecl::Create(Context, CurContext, CaretLoc);
7092 PushBlockScope(BlockScope, Block);
7093 CurContext->addDecl(Block);
Fariborz Jahaniana729da22010-07-09 18:44:02 +00007094 if (BlockScope)
7095 PushDeclContext(BlockScope, Block);
7096 else
7097 CurContext = Block;
Steve Naroff090276f2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007098}
7099
Mike Stump98eb8a72009-02-04 22:31:32 +00007100void Sema::ActOnBlockArguments(Declarator &ParamInfo, Scope *CurScope) {
Mike Stumpaf199f32009-05-07 18:43:07 +00007101 assert(ParamInfo.getIdentifier()==0 && "block-id should have no identifier!");
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007102 BlockScopeInfo *CurBlock = getCurBlock();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007103
John McCallbf1a0282010-06-04 23:28:52 +00007104 TypeSourceInfo *Sig = GetTypeForDeclarator(ParamInfo, CurScope);
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007105 CurBlock->TheDecl->setSignatureAsWritten(Sig);
John McCallbf1a0282010-06-04 23:28:52 +00007106 QualType T = Sig->getType();
Mike Stump98eb8a72009-02-04 22:31:32 +00007107
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007108 bool isVariadic;
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007109 QualType RetTy;
7110 if (const FunctionType *Fn = T->getAs<FunctionType>()) {
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007111 CurBlock->FunctionType = T;
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007112 RetTy = Fn->getResultType();
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007113 isVariadic =
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007114 !isa<FunctionProtoType>(Fn) || cast<FunctionProtoType>(Fn)->isVariadic();
7115 } else {
7116 RetTy = T;
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007117 isVariadic = false;
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007118 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007119
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007120 CurBlock->TheDecl->setIsVariadic(isVariadic);
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +00007121
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007122 // Don't allow returning an array by value.
7123 if (RetTy->isArrayType()) {
7124 Diag(ParamInfo.getSourceRange().getBegin(), diag::err_block_returns_array);
Mike Stump98eb8a72009-02-04 22:31:32 +00007125 return;
7126 }
7127
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007128 // Don't allow returning a objc interface by value.
7129 if (RetTy->isObjCObjectType()) {
7130 Diag(ParamInfo.getSourceRange().getBegin(),
7131 diag::err_object_cannot_be_passed_returned_by_value) << 0 << RetTy;
7132 return;
7133 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007134
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007135 // Context.DependentTy is used as a placeholder for a missing block
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007136 // return type. TODO: what should we do with declarators like:
7137 // ^ * { ... }
7138 // If the answer is "apply template argument deduction"....
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007139 if (RetTy != Context.DependentTy)
7140 CurBlock->ReturnType = RetTy;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007141
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007142 // Push block parameters from the declarator if we had them.
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007143 llvm::SmallVector<ParmVarDecl*, 8> Params;
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007144 if (isa<FunctionProtoType>(T)) {
7145 FunctionProtoTypeLoc TL = cast<FunctionProtoTypeLoc>(Sig->getTypeLoc());
7146 for (unsigned I = 0, E = TL.getNumArgs(); I != E; ++I) {
7147 ParmVarDecl *Param = TL.getArg(I);
Fariborz Jahanian9a66c302010-02-12 21:53:14 +00007148 if (Param->getIdentifier() == 0 &&
7149 !Param->isImplicit() &&
7150 !Param->isInvalidDecl() &&
7151 !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
7152 Diag(Param->getLocation(), diag::err_parameter_name_omitted);
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007153 Params.push_back(Param);
Fariborz Jahanian9a66c302010-02-12 21:53:14 +00007154 }
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007155
7156 // Fake up parameter variables if we have a typedef, like
7157 // ^ fntype { ... }
7158 } else if (const FunctionProtoType *Fn = T->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) {
7159 for (FunctionProtoType::arg_type_iterator
7160 I = Fn->arg_type_begin(), E = Fn->arg_type_end(); I != E; ++I) {
7161 ParmVarDecl *Param =
7162 BuildParmVarDeclForTypedef(CurBlock->TheDecl,
7163 ParamInfo.getSourceRange().getBegin(),
7164 *I);
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007165 Params.push_back(Param);
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007166 }
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007167 }
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007168
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007169 // Set the parameters on the block decl.
7170 if (!Params.empty())
7171 CurBlock->TheDecl->setParams(Params.data(), Params.size());
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007172
7173 // Finally we can process decl attributes.
Douglas Gregor9cdda0c2009-06-17 21:51:59 +00007174 ProcessDeclAttributes(CurScope, CurBlock->TheDecl, ParamInfo);
John McCall053f4bd2010-03-22 09:20:08 +00007175
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007176 if (!isVariadic && CurBlock->TheDecl->getAttr<SentinelAttr>()) {
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007177 Diag(ParamInfo.getAttributes()->getLoc(),
7178 diag::warn_attribute_sentinel_not_variadic) << 1;
7179 // FIXME: remove the attribute.
7180 }
7181
7182 // Put the parameter variables in scope. We can bail out immediately
7183 // if we don't have any.
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007184 if (Params.empty())
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007185 return;
7186
John McCall053f4bd2010-03-22 09:20:08 +00007187 bool ShouldCheckShadow =
7188 Diags.getDiagnosticLevel(diag::warn_decl_shadow) != Diagnostic::Ignored;
7189
Steve Naroff090276f2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007190 for (BlockDecl::param_iterator AI = CurBlock->TheDecl->param_begin(),
John McCall7a9813c2010-01-22 00:28:27 +00007191 E = CurBlock->TheDecl->param_end(); AI != E; ++AI) {
7192 (*AI)->setOwningFunction(CurBlock->TheDecl);
7193
Steve Naroff090276f2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007194 // If this has an identifier, add it to the scope stack.
John McCall053f4bd2010-03-22 09:20:08 +00007195 if ((*AI)->getIdentifier()) {
7196 if (ShouldCheckShadow)
7197 CheckShadow(CurBlock->TheScope, *AI);
7198
Steve Naroff090276f2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007199 PushOnScopeChains(*AI, CurBlock->TheScope);
John McCall053f4bd2010-03-22 09:20:08 +00007200 }
John McCall7a9813c2010-01-22 00:28:27 +00007201 }
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007202}
7203
7204/// ActOnBlockError - If there is an error parsing a block, this callback
7205/// is invoked to pop the information about the block from the action impl.
7206void Sema::ActOnBlockError(SourceLocation CaretLoc, Scope *CurScope) {
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007207 // Pop off CurBlock, handle nested blocks.
Chris Lattner5c59e2b2009-04-21 22:38:46 +00007208 PopDeclContext();
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007209 PopFunctionOrBlockScope();
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007210 // FIXME: Delete the ParmVarDecl objects as well???
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007211}
7212
7213/// ActOnBlockStmtExpr - This is called when the body of a block statement
7214/// literal was successfully completed. ^(int x){...}
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007215Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnBlockStmtExpr(SourceLocation CaretLoc,
7216 StmtArg body, Scope *CurScope) {
Chris Lattner9af55002009-03-27 04:18:06 +00007217 // If blocks are disabled, emit an error.
7218 if (!LangOpts.Blocks)
7219 Diag(CaretLoc, diag::err_blocks_disable);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007220
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007221 BlockScopeInfo *BSI = cast<BlockScopeInfo>(FunctionScopes.back());
Fariborz Jahaniana729da22010-07-09 18:44:02 +00007222
Steve Naroff090276f2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007223 PopDeclContext();
7224
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007225 QualType RetTy = Context.VoidTy;
Fariborz Jahanian7d5c74e2009-06-19 23:37:08 +00007226 if (!BSI->ReturnType.isNull())
7227 RetTy = BSI->ReturnType;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007228
Mike Stump56925862009-07-28 22:04:01 +00007229 bool NoReturn = BSI->TheDecl->getAttr<NoReturnAttr>();
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007230 QualType BlockTy;
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007231
7232 // If the user wrote a function type in some form, try to use that.
7233 if (!BSI->FunctionType.isNull()) {
7234 const FunctionType *FTy = BSI->FunctionType->getAs<FunctionType>();
7235
7236 FunctionType::ExtInfo Ext = FTy->getExtInfo();
7237 if (NoReturn && !Ext.getNoReturn()) Ext = Ext.withNoReturn(true);
7238
7239 // Turn protoless block types into nullary block types.
7240 if (isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(FTy)) {
7241 BlockTy = Context.getFunctionType(RetTy, 0, 0, false, 0,
7242 false, false, 0, 0, Ext);
7243
7244 // Otherwise, if we don't need to change anything about the function type,
7245 // preserve its sugar structure.
7246 } else if (FTy->getResultType() == RetTy &&
7247 (!NoReturn || FTy->getNoReturnAttr())) {
7248 BlockTy = BSI->FunctionType;
7249
7250 // Otherwise, make the minimal modifications to the function type.
7251 } else {
7252 const FunctionProtoType *FPT = cast<FunctionProtoType>(FTy);
7253 BlockTy = Context.getFunctionType(RetTy,
7254 FPT->arg_type_begin(),
7255 FPT->getNumArgs(),
7256 FPT->isVariadic(),
7257 /*quals*/ 0,
7258 FPT->hasExceptionSpec(),
7259 FPT->hasAnyExceptionSpec(),
7260 FPT->getNumExceptions(),
7261 FPT->exception_begin(),
7262 Ext);
7263 }
7264
7265 // If we don't have a function type, just build one from nothing.
7266 } else {
7267 BlockTy = Context.getFunctionType(RetTy, 0, 0, false, 0,
7268 false, false, 0, 0,
7269 FunctionType::ExtInfo(NoReturn, 0, CC_Default));
7270 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007271
Eli Friedmanb1d796d2009-03-23 00:24:07 +00007272 // FIXME: Check that return/parameter types are complete/non-abstract
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007273 DiagnoseUnusedParameters(BSI->TheDecl->param_begin(),
7274 BSI->TheDecl->param_end());
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007275 BlockTy = Context.getBlockPointerType(BlockTy);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007276
Chris Lattner17a78302009-04-19 05:28:12 +00007277 // If needed, diagnose invalid gotos and switches in the block.
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007278 if (FunctionNeedsScopeChecking() && !hasAnyErrorsInThisFunction())
Chris Lattner17a78302009-04-19 05:28:12 +00007279 DiagnoseInvalidJumps(static_cast<CompoundStmt*>(body.get()));
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007280
Anders Carlssone9146f22009-05-01 19:49:17 +00007281 BSI->TheDecl->setBody(body.takeAs<CompoundStmt>());
Mike Stumpa3899eb2010-01-19 23:08:01 +00007282
7283 bool Good = true;
7284 // Check goto/label use.
7285 for (llvm::DenseMap<IdentifierInfo*, LabelStmt*>::iterator
7286 I = BSI->LabelMap.begin(), E = BSI->LabelMap.end(); I != E; ++I) {
7287 LabelStmt *L = I->second;
7288
7289 // Verify that we have no forward references left. If so, there was a goto
7290 // or address of a label taken, but no definition of it.
7291 if (L->getSubStmt() != 0)
7292 continue;
7293
7294 // Emit error.
7295 Diag(L->getIdentLoc(), diag::err_undeclared_label_use) << L->getName();
7296 Good = false;
7297 }
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007298 if (!Good) {
7299 PopFunctionOrBlockScope();
Mike Stumpa3899eb2010-01-19 23:08:01 +00007300 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007301 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007302
Ted Kremenekdbdbaaf2010-03-20 21:06:02 +00007303 // Issue any analysis-based warnings.
Ted Kremenekd064fdc2010-03-23 00:13:23 +00007304 const sema::AnalysisBasedWarnings::Policy &WP =
7305 AnalysisWarnings.getDefaultPolicy();
7306 AnalysisWarnings.IssueWarnings(WP, BSI->TheDecl, BlockTy);
Ted Kremenekdbdbaaf2010-03-20 21:06:02 +00007307
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007308 Expr *Result = new (Context) BlockExpr(BSI->TheDecl, BlockTy,
7309 BSI->hasBlockDeclRefExprs);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007310 PopFunctionOrBlockScope();
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007311 return Owned(Result);
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007312}
7313
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007314Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnVAArg(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
7315 ExprArg expr, TypeTy *type,
7316 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
Abramo Bagnara2cad9002010-08-10 10:06:15 +00007317 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo;
7318 QualType T = GetTypeFromParser(type, &TInfo);
7319 return BuildVAArgExpr(BuiltinLoc, move(expr), TInfo, RPLoc);
7320}
7321
7322Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::BuildVAArgExpr(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
7323 ExprArg expr, TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
7324 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
Chris Lattner0d20b8a2009-04-05 15:49:53 +00007325 Expr *E = static_cast<Expr*>(expr.get());
7326 Expr *OrigExpr = E;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007327
Anders Carlsson7c50aca2007-10-15 20:28:48 +00007328 InitBuiltinVaListType();
Eli Friedmanc34bcde2008-08-09 23:32:40 +00007329
7330 // Get the va_list type
7331 QualType VaListType = Context.getBuiltinVaListType();
Eli Friedman5c091ba2009-05-16 12:46:54 +00007332 if (VaListType->isArrayType()) {
7333 // Deal with implicit array decay; for example, on x86-64,
7334 // va_list is an array, but it's supposed to decay to
7335 // a pointer for va_arg.
Eli Friedmanc34bcde2008-08-09 23:32:40 +00007336 VaListType = Context.getArrayDecayedType(VaListType);
Eli Friedman5c091ba2009-05-16 12:46:54 +00007337 // Make sure the input expression also decays appropriately.
7338 UsualUnaryConversions(E);
7339 } else {
7340 // Otherwise, the va_list argument must be an l-value because
7341 // it is modified by va_arg.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007342 if (!E->isTypeDependent() &&
Douglas Gregordd027302009-05-19 23:10:31 +00007343 CheckForModifiableLvalue(E, BuiltinLoc, *this))
Eli Friedman5c091ba2009-05-16 12:46:54 +00007344 return ExprError();
7345 }
Eli Friedmanc34bcde2008-08-09 23:32:40 +00007346
Douglas Gregordd027302009-05-19 23:10:31 +00007347 if (!E->isTypeDependent() &&
7348 !Context.hasSameType(VaListType, E->getType())) {
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007349 return ExprError(Diag(E->getLocStart(),
7350 diag::err_first_argument_to_va_arg_not_of_type_va_list)
Chris Lattner0d20b8a2009-04-05 15:49:53 +00007351 << OrigExpr->getType() << E->getSourceRange());
Chris Lattner9dc8f192009-04-05 00:59:53 +00007352 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007353
Eli Friedmanb1d796d2009-03-23 00:24:07 +00007354 // FIXME: Check that type is complete/non-abstract
Anders Carlsson7c50aca2007-10-15 20:28:48 +00007355 // FIXME: Warn if a non-POD type is passed in.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007356
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007357 expr.release();
Abramo Bagnara2cad9002010-08-10 10:06:15 +00007358 QualType T = TInfo->getType().getNonLValueExprType(Context);
7359 return Owned(new (Context) VAArgExpr(BuiltinLoc, E, TInfo, RPLoc, T));
Anders Carlsson7c50aca2007-10-15 20:28:48 +00007360}
7361
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007362Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnGNUNullExpr(SourceLocation TokenLoc) {
Douglas Gregor2d8b2732008-11-29 04:51:27 +00007363 // The type of __null will be int or long, depending on the size of
7364 // pointers on the target.
7365 QualType Ty;
7366 if (Context.Target.getPointerWidth(0) == Context.Target.getIntWidth())
7367 Ty = Context.IntTy;
7368 else
7369 Ty = Context.LongTy;
7370
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007371 return Owned(new (Context) GNUNullExpr(Ty, TokenLoc));
Douglas Gregor2d8b2732008-11-29 04:51:27 +00007372}
7373
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00007374static void MakeObjCStringLiteralFixItHint(Sema& SemaRef, QualType DstType,
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00007375 Expr *SrcExpr, FixItHint &Hint) {
Anders Carlssonb76cd3d2009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007376 if (!SemaRef.getLangOptions().ObjC1)
7377 return;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007378
Anders Carlssonb76cd3d2009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007379 const ObjCObjectPointerType *PT = DstType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
7380 if (!PT)
7381 return;
7382
7383 // Check if the destination is of type 'id'.
7384 if (!PT->isObjCIdType()) {
7385 // Check if the destination is the 'NSString' interface.
7386 const ObjCInterfaceDecl *ID = PT->getInterfaceDecl();
7387 if (!ID || !ID->getIdentifier()->isStr("NSString"))
7388 return;
7389 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007390
Anders Carlssonb76cd3d2009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007391 // Strip off any parens and casts.
7392 StringLiteral *SL = dyn_cast<StringLiteral>(SrcExpr->IgnoreParenCasts());
7393 if (!SL || SL->isWide())
7394 return;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007395
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00007396 Hint = FixItHint::CreateInsertion(SL->getLocStart(), "@");
Anders Carlssonb76cd3d2009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007397}
7398
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007399bool Sema::DiagnoseAssignmentResult(AssignConvertType ConvTy,
7400 SourceLocation Loc,
7401 QualType DstType, QualType SrcType,
Douglas Gregora41a8c52010-04-22 00:20:18 +00007402 Expr *SrcExpr, AssignmentAction Action,
7403 bool *Complained) {
7404 if (Complained)
7405 *Complained = false;
7406
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007407 // Decode the result (notice that AST's are still created for extensions).
7408 bool isInvalid = false;
7409 unsigned DiagKind;
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00007410 FixItHint Hint;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007411
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007412 switch (ConvTy) {
7413 default: assert(0 && "Unknown conversion type");
7414 case Compatible: return false;
Chris Lattnerb7b61152008-01-04 18:22:42 +00007415 case PointerToInt:
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007416 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_pointer_int;
7417 break;
Chris Lattnerb7b61152008-01-04 18:22:42 +00007418 case IntToPointer:
7419 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_int_pointer;
7420 break;
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007421 case IncompatiblePointer:
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00007422 MakeObjCStringLiteralFixItHint(*this, DstType, SrcExpr, Hint);
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007423 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_incompatible_pointer;
7424 break;
Eli Friedmanf05c05d2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00007425 case IncompatiblePointerSign:
7426 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_incompatible_pointer_sign;
7427 break;
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007428 case FunctionVoidPointer:
7429 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_pointer_void_func;
7430 break;
7431 case CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers:
Douglas Gregor77a52232008-09-12 00:47:35 +00007432 // If the qualifiers lost were because we were applying the
7433 // (deprecated) C++ conversion from a string literal to a char*
7434 // (or wchar_t*), then there was no error (C++ 4.2p2). FIXME:
7435 // Ideally, this check would be performed in
7436 // CheckPointerTypesForAssignment. However, that would require a
7437 // bit of refactoring (so that the second argument is an
7438 // expression, rather than a type), which should be done as part
7439 // of a larger effort to fix CheckPointerTypesForAssignment for
7440 // C++ semantics.
7441 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
7442 IsStringLiteralToNonConstPointerConversion(SrcExpr, DstType))
7443 return false;
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007444 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_discards_qualifiers;
7445 break;
Sean Huntc9132b62009-11-08 07:46:34 +00007446 case IncompatibleNestedPointerQualifiers:
Fariborz Jahanian3451e922009-11-09 22:16:37 +00007447 DiagKind = diag::ext_nested_pointer_qualifier_mismatch;
Fariborz Jahanian36a862f2009-11-07 20:20:40 +00007448 break;
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00007449 case IntToBlockPointer:
7450 DiagKind = diag::err_int_to_block_pointer;
7451 break;
7452 case IncompatibleBlockPointer:
Mike Stump25efa102009-04-21 22:51:42 +00007453 DiagKind = diag::err_typecheck_convert_incompatible_block_pointer;
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00007454 break;
Steve Naroff39579072008-10-14 22:18:38 +00007455 case IncompatibleObjCQualifiedId:
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007456 // FIXME: Diagnose the problem in ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible, since
Steve Naroff39579072008-10-14 22:18:38 +00007457 // it can give a more specific diagnostic.
7458 DiagKind = diag::warn_incompatible_qualified_id;
7459 break;
Anders Carlssonb0f90cc2009-01-30 23:17:46 +00007460 case IncompatibleVectors:
7461 DiagKind = diag::warn_incompatible_vectors;
7462 break;
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007463 case Incompatible:
7464 DiagKind = diag::err_typecheck_convert_incompatible;
7465 isInvalid = true;
7466 break;
7467 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007468
Douglas Gregord4eea832010-04-09 00:35:39 +00007469 QualType FirstType, SecondType;
7470 switch (Action) {
7471 case AA_Assigning:
7472 case AA_Initializing:
7473 // The destination type comes first.
7474 FirstType = DstType;
7475 SecondType = SrcType;
7476 break;
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00007477
Douglas Gregord4eea832010-04-09 00:35:39 +00007478 case AA_Returning:
7479 case AA_Passing:
7480 case AA_Converting:
7481 case AA_Sending:
7482 case AA_Casting:
7483 // The source type comes first.
7484 FirstType = SrcType;
7485 SecondType = DstType;
7486 break;
7487 }
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00007488
Douglas Gregord4eea832010-04-09 00:35:39 +00007489 Diag(Loc, DiagKind) << FirstType << SecondType << Action
Anders Carlssonb76cd3d2009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007490 << SrcExpr->getSourceRange() << Hint;
Douglas Gregora41a8c52010-04-22 00:20:18 +00007491 if (Complained)
7492 *Complained = true;
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007493 return isInvalid;
7494}
Anders Carlssone21555e2008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007495
Chris Lattner3bf68932009-04-25 21:59:05 +00007496bool Sema::VerifyIntegerConstantExpression(const Expr *E, llvm::APSInt *Result){
Eli Friedman3b5ccca2009-04-25 22:26:58 +00007497 llvm::APSInt ICEResult;
7498 if (E->isIntegerConstantExpr(ICEResult, Context)) {
7499 if (Result)
7500 *Result = ICEResult;
7501 return false;
7502 }
7503
Anders Carlssone21555e2008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007504 Expr::EvalResult EvalResult;
7505
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007506 if (!E->Evaluate(EvalResult, Context) || !EvalResult.Val.isInt() ||
Anders Carlssone21555e2008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007507 EvalResult.HasSideEffects) {
7508 Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_expr_not_ice) << E->getSourceRange();
7509
7510 if (EvalResult.Diag) {
7511 // We only show the note if it's not the usual "invalid subexpression"
7512 // or if it's actually in a subexpression.
7513 if (EvalResult.Diag != diag::note_invalid_subexpr_in_ice ||
7514 E->IgnoreParens() != EvalResult.DiagExpr->IgnoreParens())
7515 Diag(EvalResult.DiagLoc, EvalResult.Diag);
7516 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007517
Anders Carlssone21555e2008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007518 return true;
7519 }
7520
Eli Friedman3b5ccca2009-04-25 22:26:58 +00007521 Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::ext_expr_not_ice) <<
7522 E->getSourceRange();
Anders Carlssone21555e2008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007523
Eli Friedman3b5ccca2009-04-25 22:26:58 +00007524 if (EvalResult.Diag &&
7525 Diags.getDiagnosticLevel(diag::ext_expr_not_ice) != Diagnostic::Ignored)
7526 Diag(EvalResult.DiagLoc, EvalResult.Diag);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007527
Anders Carlssone21555e2008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007528 if (Result)
7529 *Result = EvalResult.Val.getInt();
7530 return false;
7531}
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007532
Douglas Gregor2afce722009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007533void
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007534Sema::PushExpressionEvaluationContext(ExpressionEvaluationContext NewContext) {
Douglas Gregor2afce722009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007535 ExprEvalContexts.push_back(
7536 ExpressionEvaluationContextRecord(NewContext, ExprTemporaries.size()));
Douglas Gregorac7610d2009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007537}
7538
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007539void
Douglas Gregor2afce722009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007540Sema::PopExpressionEvaluationContext() {
7541 // Pop the current expression evaluation context off the stack.
7542 ExpressionEvaluationContextRecord Rec = ExprEvalContexts.back();
7543 ExprEvalContexts.pop_back();
Douglas Gregorac7610d2009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007544
Douglas Gregor06d33692009-12-12 07:57:52 +00007545 if (Rec.Context == PotentiallyPotentiallyEvaluated) {
7546 if (Rec.PotentiallyReferenced) {
7547 // Mark any remaining declarations in the current position of the stack
7548 // as "referenced". If they were not meant to be referenced, semantic
7549 // analysis would have eliminated them (e.g., in ActOnCXXTypeId).
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007550 for (PotentiallyReferencedDecls::iterator
Douglas Gregor06d33692009-12-12 07:57:52 +00007551 I = Rec.PotentiallyReferenced->begin(),
7552 IEnd = Rec.PotentiallyReferenced->end();
7553 I != IEnd; ++I)
7554 MarkDeclarationReferenced(I->first, I->second);
7555 }
7556
7557 if (Rec.PotentiallyDiagnosed) {
7558 // Emit any pending diagnostics.
7559 for (PotentiallyEmittedDiagnostics::iterator
7560 I = Rec.PotentiallyDiagnosed->begin(),
7561 IEnd = Rec.PotentiallyDiagnosed->end();
7562 I != IEnd; ++I)
7563 Diag(I->first, I->second);
7564 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007565 }
Douglas Gregor2afce722009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007566
7567 // When are coming out of an unevaluated context, clear out any
7568 // temporaries that we may have created as part of the evaluation of
7569 // the expression in that context: they aren't relevant because they
7570 // will never be constructed.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007571 if (Rec.Context == Unevaluated &&
Douglas Gregor2afce722009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007572 ExprTemporaries.size() > Rec.NumTemporaries)
7573 ExprTemporaries.erase(ExprTemporaries.begin() + Rec.NumTemporaries,
7574 ExprTemporaries.end());
7575
7576 // Destroy the popped expression evaluation record.
7577 Rec.Destroy();
Douglas Gregorac7610d2009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007578}
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007579
7580/// \brief Note that the given declaration was referenced in the source code.
7581///
7582/// This routine should be invoke whenever a given declaration is referenced
7583/// in the source code, and where that reference occurred. If this declaration
7584/// reference means that the the declaration is used (C++ [basic.def.odr]p2,
7585/// C99 6.9p3), then the declaration will be marked as used.
7586///
7587/// \param Loc the location where the declaration was referenced.
7588///
7589/// \param D the declaration that has been referenced by the source code.
7590void Sema::MarkDeclarationReferenced(SourceLocation Loc, Decl *D) {
7591 assert(D && "No declaration?");
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007592
Douglas Gregorc070cc62010-06-17 23:14:26 +00007593 if (D->isUsed(false))
Douglas Gregord7f37bf2009-06-22 23:06:13 +00007594 return;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007595
Douglas Gregorb5352cf2009-10-08 21:35:42 +00007596 // Mark a parameter or variable declaration "used", regardless of whether we're in a
7597 // template or not. The reason for this is that unevaluated expressions
7598 // (e.g. (void)sizeof()) constitute a use for warning purposes (-Wunused-variables and
7599 // -Wunused-parameters)
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007600 if (isa<ParmVarDecl>(D) ||
Douglas Gregorfc2ca562010-04-07 20:29:57 +00007601 (isa<VarDecl>(D) && D->getDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod())) {
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007602 D->setUsed(true);
Douglas Gregorfc2ca562010-04-07 20:29:57 +00007603 return;
7604 }
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00007605
Douglas Gregorfc2ca562010-04-07 20:29:57 +00007606 if (!isa<VarDecl>(D) && !isa<FunctionDecl>(D))
7607 return;
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00007608
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007609 // Do not mark anything as "used" within a dependent context; wait for
7610 // an instantiation.
7611 if (CurContext->isDependentContext())
7612 return;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007613
Douglas Gregor2afce722009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007614 switch (ExprEvalContexts.back().Context) {
Douglas Gregorac7610d2009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007615 case Unevaluated:
7616 // We are in an expression that is not potentially evaluated; do nothing.
7617 return;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007618
Douglas Gregorac7610d2009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007619 case PotentiallyEvaluated:
7620 // We are in a potentially-evaluated expression, so this declaration is
7621 // "used"; handle this below.
7622 break;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007623
Douglas Gregorac7610d2009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007624 case PotentiallyPotentiallyEvaluated:
7625 // We are in an expression that may be potentially evaluated; queue this
7626 // declaration reference until we know whether the expression is
7627 // potentially evaluated.
Douglas Gregor2afce722009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007628 ExprEvalContexts.back().addReferencedDecl(Loc, D);
Douglas Gregorac7610d2009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007629 return;
7630 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007631
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007632 // Note that this declaration has been used.
Fariborz Jahanianb7f4cc02009-06-22 17:30:33 +00007633 if (CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(D)) {
Fariborz Jahanian485f0872009-06-22 23:34:40 +00007634 unsigned TypeQuals;
Fariborz Jahanian05a5c452009-06-22 20:37:23 +00007635 if (Constructor->isImplicit() && Constructor->isDefaultConstructor()) {
Douglas Gregorc070cc62010-06-17 23:14:26 +00007636 if (!Constructor->isUsed(false))
Fariborz Jahanian05a5c452009-06-22 20:37:23 +00007637 DefineImplicitDefaultConstructor(Loc, Constructor);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007638 } else if (Constructor->isImplicit() &&
Douglas Gregor9e9199d2009-12-22 00:34:07 +00007639 Constructor->isCopyConstructor(TypeQuals)) {
Douglas Gregorc070cc62010-06-17 23:14:26 +00007640 if (!Constructor->isUsed(false))
Fariborz Jahanian485f0872009-06-22 23:34:40 +00007641 DefineImplicitCopyConstructor(Loc, Constructor, TypeQuals);
7642 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007643
Douglas Gregor6fb745b2010-05-13 16:44:06 +00007644 MarkVTableUsed(Loc, Constructor->getParent());
Fariborz Jahanian8d2b3562009-06-26 23:49:16 +00007645 } else if (CXXDestructorDecl *Destructor = dyn_cast<CXXDestructorDecl>(D)) {
Douglas Gregorc070cc62010-06-17 23:14:26 +00007646 if (Destructor->isImplicit() && !Destructor->isUsed(false))
Fariborz Jahanian8d2b3562009-06-26 23:49:16 +00007647 DefineImplicitDestructor(Loc, Destructor);
Douglas Gregor6fb745b2010-05-13 16:44:06 +00007648 if (Destructor->isVirtual())
7649 MarkVTableUsed(Loc, Destructor->getParent());
Fariborz Jahanianc75bc2d2009-06-25 21:45:19 +00007650 } else if (CXXMethodDecl *MethodDecl = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(D)) {
7651 if (MethodDecl->isImplicit() && MethodDecl->isOverloadedOperator() &&
7652 MethodDecl->getOverloadedOperator() == OO_Equal) {
Douglas Gregorc070cc62010-06-17 23:14:26 +00007653 if (!MethodDecl->isUsed(false))
Douglas Gregor39957dc2010-05-01 15:04:51 +00007654 DefineImplicitCopyAssignment(Loc, MethodDecl);
Douglas Gregor6fb745b2010-05-13 16:44:06 +00007655 } else if (MethodDecl->isVirtual())
7656 MarkVTableUsed(Loc, MethodDecl->getParent());
Fariborz Jahanianc75bc2d2009-06-25 21:45:19 +00007657 }
Fariborz Jahanianf5ed9e02009-06-24 22:09:44 +00007658 if (FunctionDecl *Function = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007659 // Implicit instantiation of function templates and member functions of
Douglas Gregor1637be72009-06-26 00:10:03 +00007660 // class templates.
Douglas Gregor6cfacfe2010-05-17 17:34:56 +00007661 if (Function->isImplicitlyInstantiable()) {
Douglas Gregorb3ae4fc2009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007662 bool AlreadyInstantiated = false;
7663 if (FunctionTemplateSpecializationInfo *SpecInfo
7664 = Function->getTemplateSpecializationInfo()) {
7665 if (SpecInfo->getPointOfInstantiation().isInvalid())
7666 SpecInfo->setPointOfInstantiation(Loc);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007667 else if (SpecInfo->getTemplateSpecializationKind()
Douglas Gregor3b846b62009-10-27 20:53:28 +00007668 == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
Douglas Gregorb3ae4fc2009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007669 AlreadyInstantiated = true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007670 } else if (MemberSpecializationInfo *MSInfo
Douglas Gregorb3ae4fc2009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007671 = Function->getMemberSpecializationInfo()) {
7672 if (MSInfo->getPointOfInstantiation().isInvalid())
7673 MSInfo->setPointOfInstantiation(Loc);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007674 else if (MSInfo->getTemplateSpecializationKind()
Douglas Gregor3b846b62009-10-27 20:53:28 +00007675 == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
Douglas Gregorb3ae4fc2009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007676 AlreadyInstantiated = true;
7677 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007678
Douglas Gregor60406be2010-01-16 22:29:39 +00007679 if (!AlreadyInstantiated) {
7680 if (isa<CXXRecordDecl>(Function->getDeclContext()) &&
7681 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Function->getDeclContext())->isLocalClass())
7682 PendingLocalImplicitInstantiations.push_back(std::make_pair(Function,
7683 Loc));
7684 else
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007685 PendingImplicitInstantiations.push_back(std::make_pair(Function,
Douglas Gregor60406be2010-01-16 22:29:39 +00007686 Loc));
7687 }
Douglas Gregorb3ae4fc2009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007688 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007689
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007690 // FIXME: keep track of references to static functions
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007691 Function->setUsed(true);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007692
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007693 return;
Douglas Gregord7f37bf2009-06-22 23:06:13 +00007694 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007695
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007696 if (VarDecl *Var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
Douglas Gregor7caa6822009-07-24 20:34:43 +00007697 // Implicit instantiation of static data members of class templates.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007698 if (Var->isStaticDataMember() &&
Douglas Gregorb3ae4fc2009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007699 Var->getInstantiatedFromStaticDataMember()) {
7700 MemberSpecializationInfo *MSInfo = Var->getMemberSpecializationInfo();
7701 assert(MSInfo && "Missing member specialization information?");
7702 if (MSInfo->getPointOfInstantiation().isInvalid() &&
7703 MSInfo->getTemplateSpecializationKind()== TSK_ImplicitInstantiation) {
7704 MSInfo->setPointOfInstantiation(Loc);
7705 PendingImplicitInstantiations.push_back(std::make_pair(Var, Loc));
7706 }
7707 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007708
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007709 // FIXME: keep track of references to static data?
Douglas Gregor7caa6822009-07-24 20:34:43 +00007710
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007711 D->setUsed(true);
Douglas Gregor7caa6822009-07-24 20:34:43 +00007712 return;
Sam Weinigcce6ebc2009-09-11 03:29:30 +00007713 }
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007714}
Anders Carlsson8c8d9192009-10-09 23:51:55 +00007715
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007716namespace {
Chandler Carruthdfc35e32010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007717 // Mark all of the declarations referenced
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007718 // FIXME: Not fully implemented yet! We need to have a better understanding
Chandler Carruthdfc35e32010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007719 // of when we're entering
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007720 class MarkReferencedDecls : public RecursiveASTVisitor<MarkReferencedDecls> {
7721 Sema &S;
7722 SourceLocation Loc;
Chandler Carruthdfc35e32010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007723
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007724 public:
7725 typedef RecursiveASTVisitor<MarkReferencedDecls> Inherited;
Chandler Carruthdfc35e32010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007726
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007727 MarkReferencedDecls(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc) : S(S), Loc(Loc) { }
Chandler Carruthdfc35e32010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007728
7729 bool TraverseTemplateArgument(const TemplateArgument &Arg);
7730 bool TraverseRecordType(RecordType *T);
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007731 };
7732}
7733
Chandler Carruthdfc35e32010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007734bool MarkReferencedDecls::TraverseTemplateArgument(
7735 const TemplateArgument &Arg) {
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007736 if (Arg.getKind() == TemplateArgument::Declaration) {
7737 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, Arg.getAsDecl());
7738 }
Chandler Carruthdfc35e32010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007739
7740 return Inherited::TraverseTemplateArgument(Arg);
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007741}
7742
Chandler Carruthdfc35e32010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007743bool MarkReferencedDecls::TraverseRecordType(RecordType *T) {
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007744 if (ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl *Spec
7745 = dyn_cast<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(T->getDecl())) {
7746 const TemplateArgumentList &Args = Spec->getTemplateArgs();
Chandler Carruthdfc35e32010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007747 return TraverseTemplateArguments(Args.getFlatArgumentList(),
7748 Args.flat_size());
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007749 }
7750
Chandler Carruthe3e210c2010-06-10 10:31:57 +00007751 return true;
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007752}
7753
7754void Sema::MarkDeclarationsReferencedInType(SourceLocation Loc, QualType T) {
7755 MarkReferencedDecls Marker(*this, Loc);
Chandler Carruthdfc35e32010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007756 Marker.TraverseType(Context.getCanonicalType(T));
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007757}
7758
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007759/// \brief Emit a diagnostic that describes an effect on the run-time behavior
7760/// of the program being compiled.
7761///
7762/// This routine emits the given diagnostic when the code currently being
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007763/// type-checked is "potentially evaluated", meaning that there is a
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007764/// possibility that the code will actually be executable. Code in sizeof()
7765/// expressions, code used only during overload resolution, etc., are not
7766/// potentially evaluated. This routine will suppress such diagnostics or,
7767/// in the absolutely nutty case of potentially potentially evaluated
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007768/// expressions (C++ typeid), queue the diagnostic to potentially emit it
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007769/// later.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007770///
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007771/// This routine should be used for all diagnostics that describe the run-time
7772/// behavior of a program, such as passing a non-POD value through an ellipsis.
7773/// Failure to do so will likely result in spurious diagnostics or failures
7774/// during overload resolution or within sizeof/alignof/typeof/typeid.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007775bool Sema::DiagRuntimeBehavior(SourceLocation Loc,
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007776 const PartialDiagnostic &PD) {
7777 switch (ExprEvalContexts.back().Context ) {
7778 case Unevaluated:
7779 // The argument will never be evaluated, so don't complain.
7780 break;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007781
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007782 case PotentiallyEvaluated:
7783 Diag(Loc, PD);
7784 return true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007785
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007786 case PotentiallyPotentiallyEvaluated:
7787 ExprEvalContexts.back().addDiagnostic(Loc, PD);
7788 break;
7789 }
7790
7791 return false;
7792}
7793
Anders Carlsson8c8d9192009-10-09 23:51:55 +00007794bool Sema::CheckCallReturnType(QualType ReturnType, SourceLocation Loc,
7795 CallExpr *CE, FunctionDecl *FD) {
7796 if (ReturnType->isVoidType() || !ReturnType->isIncompleteType())
7797 return false;
7798
7799 PartialDiagnostic Note =
7800 FD ? PDiag(diag::note_function_with_incomplete_return_type_declared_here)
7801 << FD->getDeclName() : PDiag();
7802 SourceLocation NoteLoc = FD ? FD->getLocation() : SourceLocation();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007803
Anders Carlsson8c8d9192009-10-09 23:51:55 +00007804 if (RequireCompleteType(Loc, ReturnType,
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007805 FD ?
Anders Carlsson8c8d9192009-10-09 23:51:55 +00007806 PDiag(diag::err_call_function_incomplete_return)
7807 << CE->getSourceRange() << FD->getDeclName() :
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007808 PDiag(diag::err_call_incomplete_return)
Anders Carlsson8c8d9192009-10-09 23:51:55 +00007809 << CE->getSourceRange(),
7810 std::make_pair(NoteLoc, Note)))
7811 return true;
7812
7813 return false;
7814}
7815
John McCall5a881bb2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00007816// Diagnose the common s/=/==/ typo. Note that adding parentheses
7817// will prevent this condition from triggering, which is what we want.
7818void Sema::DiagnoseAssignmentAsCondition(Expr *E) {
7819 SourceLocation Loc;
7820
John McCalla52ef082009-11-11 02:41:58 +00007821 unsigned diagnostic = diag::warn_condition_is_assignment;
7822
John McCall5a881bb2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00007823 if (isa<BinaryOperator>(E)) {
7824 BinaryOperator *Op = cast<BinaryOperator>(E);
7825 if (Op->getOpcode() != BinaryOperator::Assign)
7826 return;
7827
John McCallc8d8ac52009-11-12 00:06:05 +00007828 // Greylist some idioms by putting them into a warning subcategory.
7829 if (ObjCMessageExpr *ME
7830 = dyn_cast<ObjCMessageExpr>(Op->getRHS()->IgnoreParenCasts())) {
7831 Selector Sel = ME->getSelector();
7832
John McCallc8d8ac52009-11-12 00:06:05 +00007833 // self = [<foo> init...]
7834 if (isSelfExpr(Op->getLHS())
7835 && Sel.getIdentifierInfoForSlot(0)->getName().startswith("init"))
7836 diagnostic = diag::warn_condition_is_idiomatic_assignment;
7837
7838 // <foo> = [<bar> nextObject]
7839 else if (Sel.isUnarySelector() &&
7840 Sel.getIdentifierInfoForSlot(0)->getName() == "nextObject")
7841 diagnostic = diag::warn_condition_is_idiomatic_assignment;
7842 }
John McCalla52ef082009-11-11 02:41:58 +00007843
John McCall5a881bb2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00007844 Loc = Op->getOperatorLoc();
7845 } else if (isa<CXXOperatorCallExpr>(E)) {
7846 CXXOperatorCallExpr *Op = cast<CXXOperatorCallExpr>(E);
7847 if (Op->getOperator() != OO_Equal)
7848 return;
7849
7850 Loc = Op->getOperatorLoc();
7851 } else {
7852 // Not an assignment.
7853 return;
7854 }
7855
John McCall5a881bb2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00007856 SourceLocation Open = E->getSourceRange().getBegin();
John McCall2d152152009-10-12 22:25:59 +00007857 SourceLocation Close = PP.getLocForEndOfToken(E->getSourceRange().getEnd());
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007858
Douglas Gregor55b38842010-04-14 16:09:52 +00007859 Diag(Loc, diagnostic) << E->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor827feec2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00007860 Diag(Loc, diag::note_condition_assign_to_comparison)
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00007861 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(Loc, "==");
Douglas Gregor55b38842010-04-14 16:09:52 +00007862 Diag(Loc, diag::note_condition_assign_silence)
7863 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Open, "(")
7864 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Close, ")");
John McCall5a881bb2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00007865}
7866
7867bool Sema::CheckBooleanCondition(Expr *&E, SourceLocation Loc) {
7868 DiagnoseAssignmentAsCondition(E);
7869
7870 if (!E->isTypeDependent()) {
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +00007871 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(E);
John McCall5a881bb2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00007872
7873 QualType T = E->getType();
7874
7875 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
7876 if (CheckCXXBooleanCondition(E)) // C++ 6.4p4
7877 return true;
7878 } else if (!T->isScalarType()) { // C99 6.8.4.1p1
7879 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_statement_requires_scalar)
7880 << T << E->getSourceRange();
7881 return true;
7882 }
7883 }
7884
7885 return false;
7886}
Douglas Gregor586596f2010-05-06 17:25:47 +00007887
7888Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnBooleanCondition(Scope *S, SourceLocation Loc,
7889 ExprArg SubExpr) {
Douglas Gregoreecf38f2010-05-06 21:39:56 +00007890 Expr *Sub = SubExpr.takeAs<Expr>();
7891 if (!Sub)
Douglas Gregor586596f2010-05-06 17:25:47 +00007892 return ExprError();
7893
Douglas Gregorff331c12010-07-25 18:17:45 +00007894 if (CheckBooleanCondition(Sub, Loc))
Douglas Gregor586596f2010-05-06 17:25:47 +00007895 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor586596f2010-05-06 17:25:47 +00007896
7897 return Owned(Sub);
7898}